xvEPA
            United States
            Environmental Protection
            Agency
            Environmental Monitoring
            Systems Laboratory
            P.O. Box 15027
            Las Vegas NV 89114-5027
EPA/600/8-87/005
January. 1987
Pre-lssuance Copy
            Research and Development
National Surface
Water Survey
Stream Survey (Pilot,
Middle-Atlantic Phase I,
Southeast Screening,
and Middle-Atlantic
Episode Pilot)
  ™             •

Analytical  Methods Manual

-------
              NATIONAL SURFACE WATER SURVEY
      STREAM SURVEY (PILOT, MIDDLE-ATLANTIC PHASE I,
 SOUTHEAST SCREENING,  AND MIDDLE-ATLANTIC EPISODE PILOT)

                ANALYTICAL METHODS MANUAL

                            by

                D. C.  Hillman, S.  H. Pia,
                     and S. J. Simon
Lockheed-Engineering and Management Services Company,  Inc.
                 Las Vegas, Nevada  89114
                 Contract No.  68-03-3249
                     Project Officer

                     R.  D.  Schonbrod
          Exposure Assessment Research  Division
       Environmental  Monitoring Systems Laboratory
                 Las  Vegas,  Nevada  89114
       ENVIRONMENTAL  MONITORING  SYSTEMS  LABORATORY
            OFFICE  OF RESEARCH AND DEVELOPMENT
          U. S.  ENVIRONMENTAL PROTECTION AGENCY
                 LAS  VEGAS,  NEVADA   89114

-------
                                     NOTICE
     This document is a preliminary draft.   It has not been  formally released
by the U.S. Environmental Protection Agency and should not at this stage  be
construed to represent Agency policy.  It is being circulated for  comments on
its technical merit and policy implications.

     The mention of trade names or commercial  products in this manual  is  for
illustration purposes, and does not constitute endorsement or recommendation
for use.
                                       ii

-------
                                    ABSTRACT
     The National Surface Water Survey of the National  Acid Precipitation
Assessment Program is a three-phase project to evaluate the current water
chemistry of lakes and streams, determine the status of fisheries and other
biotic resources, and select regionally representative  surface waters for a
long-term monitoring program to study changes in aquatic resources.

     The U.S. Environmental Protection Agency requires  that data collection
activities be based on a program which ensures that the resulting data are
of known quality and are suitable for the purpose for which they are intended.
In addition, it is necessary that the data obtained be  consistent and compar-
able.  For these reasons, the same reliable, detailed analytical methodology
must be available to and used by all  analysts participating in the study.

     This manual provides details of the analytical methods and internal  qual-
ity control used to process and analyze samples for the National Stream Survey
(NSS).  The determinations and methods described are the following:
          Parameter

1.  Base-Neutralizing Capacity
2.  Acid-Neutralizing Capacity
3.  Aluminum, total
4.  Aluminum, total extractable

5.  Aluminum, Nonexchangeable
      Pyrocatechol Violet (PCV)
      Reactive and Total  PCV Reactive
6.  Ammonium, dissolved
7.  Calcium, dissolved
8.  Chloride, dissolved
9.  Fluoride, total dissolved
10. Inorganic carbon, dissolved

11. Iron, dissolved
12. Magnesium, dissolved
13. Manganese, dissolved
14. Nitrate, dissolved
15. Organic carbon, dissolved

16. pH
17. Phosphorus, total dissolved

18. Potassium, dissolved
           Method

Titration with Gran analysis
Titration with Gran analysis
202.2 AAS (furnace)
Extraction with 8-hydroxyquinoline
  into MIBK followed by AAS (furnace)
Automated Colorimetric Pyrocatechol
  Violet (PCV)

Automated colorimetry (phenate)
AAS (flame) or ICPES
Ion chromatography
Ion-selective electrode and meter
Instrument (acidification,  C02
  generation, IR detection)
AAS (flame) or ICPES
AAS (flame) or ICPES
AAS (flame) or ICPES
Ion chromatography
Instrument (uv-promoted oxidation,
  CO? generation, IR detection)
pH electrode and meter
Automated colorimetry
  (Molybdate blue)
AAS (flame)
                                      iii

-------
          Parameter                                    Method

19. Silica, dissolved                       Automated colorimetry
                                              (molybdate blue)
20. Sodium, dissolved                       AAS (flame)
21. Sulfate, dissolved                      Ion chromatography
22. Specific conductance                    Conductivity cell and meter
23. True color                              Comparison to platinum-cobalt
                                              color standards
24. Turbidity                               Instrument (nephelometer)
                                       iv

-------
                                 ACKNOWLEDGMENT
     Contributions provided by the following individuals  were  essential  to
the completion of this methods manual  and are gratefully  acknowledged:   Mark
Peden (Illinois State Water Survey), Kevin Cabbie,  Lynn Creel man,  Sevda
Drouse, D. Mericus, Janice Engels (Lockheed Engineering and Management Services
Company, Inc.), James Kramer (McMaster University), John  Lawrence  (National
Water Research Institute), Bruce LaZerte (Ontario Ministry of  the  Environment),
John Nims (State of Maine, Department of Environmental  Protection),  Charles
Driscoll and Gary Schafron (Syracuse University), J.  Messer (U.S.  EPA),  Howard
May (U.S. Geological Survey), Peter Campbell (University  of Quebec),  Richard
Wright (University of Virginia), David Brakke (Western  Washington  University),
and R. Kent Schreiber (U.S. Dept. of the Interior).

-------
                                                                Section  T of C
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 1  of 9
                               TABLE OF CONTENTS
Section                                                     Page       Revision

1.0     INTRODUCTION	    1 of 6         2

        1.1  Background of the National  Stream Survey.      1 of 6         2

        1.2  Physical Parameters and Analytes Measured      3 of 6         2

             1.2.1  Base-Neutralizing Capacity (BNC)  .  .    3 of 6         2
             1.2.2  Acid-Neutralizing Capacity (ANC)  .  .    3 of 6         2
             1.2.3  Aluminum, Total Extractable	    3 of 6         2
             1.2.4  Aluminum, Total	    5 of 6         2
             1.2.5  Aluminum, Nonexchangeable Pyrocatechol
                      Violet (PCV) and Total  PCV Reactive  5 of 6         2
             1.2.6  Dissolved Inorganic Carbon 	    5 of 6         2
             1.2.7  Dissolved Ions (Na,  K, Ca, Mg, Fe,
                      Mn, NH4, F, Cl, $04, N03	    5 of 6         2
             1.2.8  Dissolved Organic Carbon	    5 of 6         2
             1.2.9  Dissolved Silica (Si02)	    5 of 6         2
             1.2.10 pH	    5 of 6         2
             1.2.11 Specific Conductance 	    6 of 6         2
             1.2.12 Total Dissolved Phosphorus 	    6 of 6         2
             1.2.13 True Color	    6 of 6         2
             1.2.14 Turbidity	    6 of 6         2

        1.3  References	    6 of 6         2

2.0     FIELD OPERATIONS	    1 of 45        2

        2.1  Personnel	    1 of 45        2

        2.2  Daily Operations	    1 of 45        2

             2.2.1  Activities Before Sample  Arrival  .  .    1 of 45        2
             2.2.2  Activities Following Sample Arrival.    1 of 45        2

        2.3  Determination of DIC	12 of 45        2

             2.3.1  Scope and Application	12 of 45        2
             2.3.2  Summary of Method	15 of 45        2
             2.3.3  Interferences	15 of 45        2
             2.3.4  Safety	   15 of 45        2
             2.3.5  Apparatus and Equipment	15 of 45        2
             2.3.6  Reagents and Consumable Materials.  .   15 of 45        2

-------
                                                                Section T of C
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 2 of 9
                          TABLE OF CONTENTS (Continued)
Section                                                     Page       Revision

             2.3.7  Sample Collection, Preservation,
                      and Storage	16 of 45        2
             2.3.8  Calibration and Standardization.  ..   16 of 45        2
             2.3.9  Quality Control	16 of 45        2
             2.3.10 Procedure	18 of 45        2
             2.3.11 Calculations	19 of 45        2
             2.3.12 Reporting	19 of 45        2

        2.4  Determination of pH	19 of 45        2

             2.4.1  Scope and Application	19 of 45        2
             2.4.2  Summary of Method	19 of 45        2
             2.4.3  Interferences	19 of 45        2
             2.4.4  Safety .	19 of 45        2
             2.4.5  Apparatus and Equipment	19 of 45        2
             2.4.6  Reagents  and Consumable Materials.  .   22 of 45        2
             2.4.7  Sample Collection, Preservation,
                      and Storage	22 of 45        2
             2.4.8  Calibration and Standardization.  ..   22 of 45        2
             2.4.9  Quality Control	23 of 45        2
             2.4.10 Procedure	23 of 45        2
             2.4.11 Calculations	25 of 45        2
             2.4.12 Reporting	25 of 45        2

        2.5  Determination of Turbidity	25 of 45        2

             2.5.1  Scope and Application	25 of 45        2
             2.5.2  Summary of Method	25 of 45        2
             2.5.3  Interferences	25 of 45        2
             2.5.4  Safety	25 of 45        2
             2.5.5  Apparatus and Equipment	25 of 45        2
             2.5.6  Reagents  and Consumable Materials.  .   26 of 45        2
             2.5.7  Sample Collection, Preservation,
                      and Storage	26 of 45        2
             2.5.8  Calibration and Standardization.  ..   26 of 45        2
             2.5.9  Quality Control	26 of 45        2
             2.5.10 Procedure	26 of 45        2
             2.5.11 Calculations	27 of 45        2
             2.5.12 Reporting	27 of 45        2

        2.6  Determination of True Color	27 of 45        2

             2.6.1  Scope and Application	27 of 45        2

-------
                                                                Section  T of C
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 3  of 9
                          TABLE OF CONTENTS (Continued)
Section                                                     Page       Revision

             2.6.2  Summary of Method	29 of 45         2
             2.6.3  Interferences	29 of 45         2
             2.6.4  Safety	29 of 45         2
             2.6.5  Apparatus and Equipment	29 of 45         2
             2.6.6  Reagents and Consumable Materials.  .   29 of 45         2
             2.6.7  Sample Collection,  Preservation,
                      and Storage	29 of 45         2
             2.6.8  Calibration and Standardization.  ..   29 of 45         2
             2.6.9  Quality Control	29 of 45         2
             2.6.10 Procedure	29 of 45         2
             2.6.11 Calculations	30 of 45         2
             2.6.12 Reporting	30 of 45         2

        2.7  Determination of Nonexchangeable Pyrocatechol
               Violet (PCV) Reactive and Total  PCV
               Reactive Aluminum	30 of 45         2

             2.7.1  Scope and Application	30 of 45         2
             2.7.2  Summary of Method	30 of 45         2
             2.7.3  Definitions	31 of 45         2
             2.7.4  Interferences	31 of 45         2
             2.7.5  Safety	31 of 45         2
             2.7.6  Apparatus and Equipment	31 of 45         2
             2.7.7  Reagents and Consumable Materials.  .   32 of 45         2
             2.7.8  Sample Collection,  Preservation,  and
                      Storage	34 of 45         2
             2.7.9  Calibration and Standardization.  ..   34 of 45         2
             2.7.10 Quality Control	35 of 45         2
             2.7.11 Procedure	35 of 45         2
             2.7.12 Calculations	38 of 45         2
             2.7.13 Precision and Accuracy	38 of 45         2

        2.8  Aliquot Preparation	38 of 45         2

             2.8.1  Summary	38 of 45         2
             2.8.2  Safety	40 of 45         2
             2.8.3  Apparatus and Equipment	40 of 45         2
             2.8.4  Reagents and Consumable Materials.  .   40 of 45         2
             2.8.5  Procedure	   41 of 45         2

        2.9  References	44 of 45         2

-------
                                                                Section T of C
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page 4 of 9
                          TABLE OF CONTENTS (Continued)
Section                                                      Page     Revision

3.0     ANALYTICAL LABORATORY OPERATIONS 	   1 of 17        2

        3.1  Summary of Operations	   1 of 17        2
        3.2  Sample Receipt and Handling	   1 of 17        2
        3.3  Sample Analysis	   1 of 17        2
        3.4  Internal Quality Control Requirements ...   1 of 17        2

             3.4.1  Method Quality Control	 .   5 of 17        2
             3.4.2  Overall Internal  Quality Control  . .  10 of 17        2

        3.5  Data Reporting	14 of 17        2
        3.6  References	14 of 17        2

4.0     DETERMINATION OF BASE-NEUTRALIZING CAPACITY,
          ACID-NEUTRALIZING CAPACITY, AND pH	   1 of 27        2

        4.1  Scope and Application	   1 of 27        2
        4.2  Summary of Method	   1 of 27        2
        4.3  Interferences	   1 of 27        2
        4.4  Safety	   1 of 27        2
        4.5  Apparatus and Equipment	   2 of 27        2
        4.6  Reagents and Consumable Materials	   2 of 27        2
        4.7  Sample Collection, Preservation, and
               Storage	   3 of 27        2
        4.8  Calibration and Standardization	   3 of 27        2
        4.9  Quality Control	14 of 27        2
        4.10 Procedure	17 of 27        2
        4.11 Calculations	20 of 27        2
        4.12 References	26 of 27        2

5.0  DETERMINATION OF AMMONIUM	   1 of 7         2

        5.1  Scope and Application	   1 of 7         2
        5.2  Summary of Method	   1 of 7         2
        5.3  Interferences	   1 of 7         2
        5.4  Safety	   1 of 7         2
        5.5  Apparatus and Equipment	   1 of 7         2
        5.6  Reagents and Consumable Materials	   2 of 7         2
        5.7  Sample Collection, Preservation, and
               Storage	   3 of 7         2
        5.8  Calibration and Standardization	   3 of 7         2
        5.9  Quality Control	   3 of 7         2
        5.10 Procedure	   4 of 7         2

-------
                                                                Section  T  of  C
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page  5 of  9
                          TABLE OF CONTENTS (Continued)
   Section                                                   Page      Revision

        5.11 Calculations	    4 of 7          2
        5.12 Precision and Accuracy	    4 of 7          2
        5.13 References	    5 of 7          2

6.0  DETERMINATION OF CHLORIDE, NITRATE,  AND SULFATE
       BY ION CHROMATOGRAPHY	    1 of 6          2

        6.1  Scope and Application	    1 of 6          2
        6.2  Summary of Method	    1 of 6          2
        6.3  Interferences	    2 of 6          2
        6.4  Safety	    2 of 6          2
        6.5  Apparatus and Equipment	    2 of 6          2
        6.6  Reagents and Consumable Materials	    3 of 6          2
        6.7  Sample Collection, Preservation,  and
               Storage	    4 of 6          2
        6.8  Calibration and Standardization	    4 of 6          2
        6.9  Quality Control	    4 of 6          2
        6.10 Procedure	    5 of 6          2
        6.11 Calculations	    6 of 6          2
        6.12 Precision and Accuracy	    6 of 6          2
        6.13 References	    6 of 6          2

7.0  DETERMINATION OF DISSOLVED ORGANIC CARBON AND
       DISSOLVED INORGANIC CARBON	    1 of 8          2

        7.1  Scope and Application	    1 of 8          2
        7.2  Summary of Method	    1 of 8          2
        7.3  Interferences	    1 of 8          2
        7.4  Safety	    1 of 8          2
        7.5  Apparatus and Equipment	    1 of 8          2
        7.6  Reagents and Consumable Materials 	    2 of 8          2
        7.7  Sample Collection, Preservation,  and
               Storage	    4 of 8          2
        7.8  Calibration and Standardization	    4 of 8          2
        7.9  Quality Control	    6 of 8          2
        7.10 Procedure	    6 of 8          2
        7.11 Calculations	    7 of 8          2
        7.12 Precision and Accuracy	    7 of 8          2
        7.13 References	    7 of 8          2

-------
                                                                 Section  T  of  C
                                                                 Revision 2
                                                                 Date:   11/86
                                                                 Page  6  of  9
                           TABLE OF CONTENTS (Continued)
 Section                                                      Page      Revision

 8.0     DETERMINATION OF TOTAL DISSOLVED FLUORIDE BY
         ION-SELECTIVE ELECTRODE  	    1  of  6          2

         8.1  Scope and Application	    1  of  6          2
         8.2  Summary of Method	    1  of  6          2
         8.3  Interferences	    1  of  6          2
         8.4  Safety.	    1  of  6          2
         8.5  Apparatus and Equipment	    2  of  6          2
         8.6  Reagents and Consumable Materials	    2  of  6          2
         8.7  Sample Collection, Preservation,  and
                Storage	    3  of  6          2
         8.8  Calibration and Standardization	    3  of  6          2
         8.9  Quality Control	    4  of  6          2
         8.10 Procedure	    4  of  6          2
         8.11 Calculations	    5  of  6          2
         8.12 Precision and Accuracy	    5  of  6          2
         8.13 References	    5  of  6          2

 9.0     DETERMINATION OF TOTAL DISSOLVED PHOSPHORUS.  .  .    1  of  8          2

         9.1  Scope and Application	    1  of  8          2
         9.2  Summary of Method	    1  of  8          2
         9.3  Interferences	    1  of  8          2
         9.4  Safety	    2  of  8          2
         9.5  Apparatus and Equipment	    2  of  8          2
         9.6  Reagents and Consumable Materials 	    2  of  8          2
         9.7  Sample Collection, Preservation,  and
                Storage	    4  of  8          2
         9.8  Calibration and Standardization	    4  of  8          2
         9.9  Quality Control	    4  of  8          2
         9.10 Procedure	    5  of  8          2
         9.11 Calculations	    5  of  8          2
         9.12 Precision and Accuracy	    5  of  8          2
         9.13 References	    7  of  8          2

10.0     DETERMINATION OF DISSOLVED SILICA	    1  of  7          2

        10.1  Scope and Application	    1  of  7          2
        10.2  Summary of Method	    1  of  7          2
        10.3  Interferences	    1  of  7          2
        10.4  Safety	    1  of  7          2
        10.5  Apparatus and Equipment	    1  of  7          2

-------
                                                                 Section  T of C
                                                                 Revision 2
                                                                 Date:   11/86
                                                                 Page 7  of 9
                           TABLE OF CONTENTS (Continued)
 Section                                                      Page     Revision

         10.6  Reagents and Consumable Materials	    2 of 7        2
         10.7  Sample Collection, Preservation,  and
                 Storage	    3 of 7        2
         10.8  Calibration and Standardization	    3 of 7        2
         10.9  Quality Control	    5 of 7        2
         10.10 Procedure	    5 of 7        2
         10.11 Calculations	    5 of 7        2
         10.12 References	    5 of 7        2

11.0     DETERMINATION OF SPECIFIC CONDUCTANCE 	    1 of 4        2

         11.1  Scope and Application	    1 of 4        2
         11.2  Summary of Method	    1 of 4        2
         11.3  Interferences	    1 of 4        2
         11.4  Safety.	    1 of 4        2
         11.5  Apparatus and Equipment	    1 of 4        2
         11.6  Reagents and Consumable Materials 	    2 of 4        2
         11.7  Sample Collection, Preservation,  and
                 Storage	    2 of 4        2
         11.8  Calibration and Standardization	    2 of 4        2
         11.9  Quality Control	    3 of 4        2
         11.10 Procedure	    3 of 4        2
         11.11 Calculations	    3 of 4        2
         11.12 Precision and Accuracy	    4 of 4        2
         11.13 References	    4 of 4        2

12.0     DETERMINATION OF METALS (Al, Ca,  Fe,  K, Mg,  Mn,
         Na) BY ATOMIC ABSORPTION SPECTROSCOPY	    1 of 23       2

         12.1  Scope and Application	    1 of 23       2
         12.2  Summary of Method	    1 of 23       2
         12.3  Definitions	    3 of 23       2
         12.4  Interferences	    3 of 23       2
         12.5  Safety	    5 of 23       2
         12.6  Apparatus and Equipment	    5 of 23       2
         12.7  Reagents and Consumable Materials	    6 of 23       2
         12.8  Sample Collection, Preservation,  and
                 Storage	    7 of 23       2
         12.9  Calibration and Standardization	    7 of 23       2
         12.10 Quality Control	    8 of 23       2
         12.11 Procedure	    8 of 23       2
         12.12 Calculations	22 of 23       2

-------
                                                                 Section T of
                                                                 Revision 2
                                                                 Date:   11/86
                                                                 Page 8 of 9
                           TABLE OF CONTENTS (Continued)
 Section                                                      Page      Revision

         12.13 References	23 of 23        2

13.0     DETERMINATION OF DISSOLVED METALS (Ca,  Fe,  Mg,  Mn)
         BY INDUCTIVELY COUPLED PLASMA EMISSION
         SPECTROSCOPY	    1 of 10        2

         13.1  Scope and Application	    1 of 10        2
         13.2  Summary of Method	    1 of 10        2
         13.3  Interferences	    2 of 10        2
         13.4  Safety	    6 of 10        2
         13.5  Apparatus and Equipment	    6 of 10        2
         13.6  Reagents and Consumable Materials	    6 of 10        2
         13.7  Sample Handling, Preservation,  and Storage.    7 of 10        2
         13.8  Calibration and Standardization	    8 of 10        2
         13.9  Quality Control	    8 of 10        2
         13.10 Procedure	    8 of 10        2
         13.11 Calculations	    8 of 10        2
         13.12 Precision and Accuracy	10 of 10        2
         13.13 References	10 of 10        2

 APPENDICES

  A      CLEANING OF PLASTICWARE	    1 of 2        2

         A-1.0  Sample Containers	    1 of 2        2
         A-l.l  Cleaning of Plasticware	    1 of 2        2

  B      BLANK DATA FORMS	    1 of 16        2

  C      EXAMPLES OF CALCULATIONS REQUIRED FOR ANC
           AND BNC DETERMINATIONS	    1 of 24        2

         C-1.0  HC1 Standardization (Section 4.8.1).  ...    1 of 24        2
         C-2.0  NaOH Standardization (Section  4.8.2)  ...    4 of 24        2
         C-2.1  Initial NaOH Standardization with KHP
                  (Section 4.8.2.1)	    4 of 24        2
         C-2.2  Standardization Check (Section 4.8.2.2). .    6 of 24        2
         C-2.3  Routine NaOH Standardization with
                  Standardized HC1  (Section 4.8.2.3)  .  . .    8 of 24        2
         C-3.0  Electrode Calibration (Section 4.8.3).  ..   11 of 24        2
         C-4.0  Blank Analysis - ANC Determination
                  (Section 4.9.2)	14 of 24        2

-------
                                                                Section T of C
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 9 of 9
                          TABLE OF CONTENTS (Continued)
Section                                                      Page     Revision

        C-5.0  Sample Analysis	16 of 24        2
        C-5.1  Titration Data	16 of 24        2
        C-5.2  Initial Estimate of YI, (Section 4.11.1).  17 of 24        2
        C-5.3  Initial Estimate of V2, ANC, BNC, and C
                 (Section 4.11.3.1)	17 of 24        2
        C-5.4  Refined Estimates of Y! and Y£	19 of 24        2
        C-5.5  New Estimates of ANC, BNC, and C	21 of 24        2
        C-5.6  Comparison of Latest Two Estimates of
                 Total Carbonate	21 of 24        2
        C-6.0  Quality Control  Calculations	23 of 24        2
        C-6.1  Comparison of Calculated ANC and Measured
                 ANC (Section 4.9.6)	23 of 24        2
        C-6.2  Comparison of Calculated and Measured
                 BNC (Section 4.9.7)	23 of 24        2
        C-6.3  Comparison of Calculated Total Carbonate
                 and Measured Total Carbonate
                 (Section 4.9.8)	24 of 24        2

-------
                                                                Section Figures
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 1 of 1
                                    FIGURES
Figure                                                          Page    Revision

 1.1   Organizational diagram of the National  Surface Water
         Survey and the years during which field activities
         are to be initiated	    2 of 6      2

 2.1   Flow scheme of daily mobile processing  laboratory
         activities	    6 of 45     2
 2.2   Field sample label	    8 of 45     2
 2.3   Aliquot and Audit Sample Labels	    9 of 45     2
 2.4   NSWS Form 5 - Batch/QC Field Data	10 of 45     2
 2.5   NSWS Form 3 - Shipping	13 of 45     2
 2.6   Data flow scheme	14 of 45     2
 2.7   Flow scheme for DIG determination	17 of 45     2
 2.8   Schematic of pH measurement system	20 of 45     2
 2.9   pH sample chamber	21 of 45     2
 2.10  Flow scheme for pH determinations	24 of 45     2
 2.11  Flow scheme for turbidity determinations	28 of 45     2
 2.12  Channel one schematic for total PCV reactive Al  ...   36 of 45     2
 2.13  Channel two schematic for nonexchangeable PCV
         reactive Al	37 of 45     2

 5.1   Ammonia manifold AA I	    6 of 7      2
 5.2   Ammonia manifold AA II	    7 of 7      2

 9.1   Total dissolved phosphorus manifold 	    6 of 8      2

10.1   Silica manifold	    7 of 7      2

12.1   Standard Addition Plot	    9 of 23     2

 C-l   Plot of Fib versus V for HC1 standardization	    3 of 24     2
 C-2   Plot of F3b versus V for initial  NaOH standardization
         with KHP	    5 of 24     2
 C-3   Plot of FI versus V for standardization check-
         titration of NaOH with HC1	    7 of 24     2
 C-4   Plot of FI versus V for routine NaOH standardization.   10 of 24     2
 C-5   Plot of pH versus pH* for electrode calibration  ...   13 of 24     2
 C-6   Plot of FI versus V for ANC determination of
         blank	15 of 24     2
 C-7   Plot of Fia versus Va for initial  determination  of Vi   18 of 24     2
 C-8   Plot of FIC versus Va for Vi determination.  .....   20 of 24     2
 C-9   Plot of F£C versus V^ for ^2 determination	22 of 24     2

-------
                                                                Section Tables
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 1 of 1
                                    TABLES
Table                                                                Page   Revision

 1.1   Required Minimum Analytical Detection Limits, Expected
         Ranges, and Intralab Relative Precision	    4 of 6      2

 2.1   Mobile Processing Laboratory Equipment List	    2 of 45     2
 2.2   List of Sample Codes	11 of 45     2
 2.3   Aliquot Descriptions	39 of 45     2

 3.1   List of Aliquots, Containers, Preservatives,  and
         Corresponding Parameters to be Measured	    2 of 17     2
 3.2   List of Holding Times	    3 of 17     2
 3.3   List of Parameters and Corresponding Measurement Methods .    4 of 17     2
 3.4   Summary of Internal Method Quality Control  Checks	    6 of 17     2
 3.5   Maximum Control Limits for Quality Control  Samples ....    7 of 17     2
 3.6   Factors to Convert mg/L to ueq/L	11 of 17     2
 3.7   Chemical Reanalysis Criteria 	   12 of 17     2
 3.8   Conductance Factors of Ions	13 of 17     2
 3.9   List of Data Forms	15 of 17     2
 3.10  National Surface Water Survey Data Qualifiers	16 of 17     2

 4.1   List of Calculation Procedures for Combinations of
         Initial YI and pH*	21 of 27     2
 4.2   List of Frequently Used Equations and Constants	22 of 27     2

 6.1   Suggested Concentration of Dilute Calibration Standards.     4 of 6      2
 6.2   Typical 1C Operating Conditions	    5 of 6      2
 6.3   Single-Operator Accuracy and Precision 	    6 of 6      2

 9.1   Percent Recovery of Total P in the Presence of SiOg.  ...    1 of 8      2
 9.2   Precision and Accuracy of the Method for Natural  Water
         Samples	    7 of 8      2
 9.3   Precision and Accuracy of the Method for Analyst-
         Prepared Standards	    7 of 8      2

12.1   Atomic Absorption Concentration Ranges 	    2 of 23     2

13.1   Recommended Wavelengths and Estimated Instrumental
         Detection Limits	    2 of 10     2
13.2   Analyte Concentration Equivalents (mg/L)  Arising from
         Interferents at the 100 mg/L level	    4 of 10     2
13.3   Interferent and Analyte Elemental Concentrations Used
         for Interference Measurements in Table 13.2	    5 of 10     2
13.4   Inductively Coupled Plasma Precision and Accuracy Data . .    9 of 10     2

-------
                                                                Section  1.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page  1 of 6
1.0  INTRODUCTION
     The National  Surface Water Survey (NSWS)  is part of the  National  Acid
     Precipitation Assessment Program (NAPAP).   One  of the  responsibilities of
     NAPAP is to assess the extent and severity to which aquatic  resources
     within the U.S.  are at risk because  of effects  of acid deposition.

     The NSWS was  initiated at the request of  the Administrator of  EPA when it
     became apparent  that existing data could  not be used to  quantitatively
     assess the present chemical and biological  status of surface waters  of the
     U.S.  Extrapolation of existing data, largely compiled through individual
     studies, to the  regional or national  scale was  limited because studies
     were often biased in terms of site selection.  Additionally, many previous
     studies were  incomplete with respect to the chemical variables of
     interest, inconsistent relative to sampling/analytical methodologies, or
     highly variable  in terms of data quality.

1.1  Background of the National  Stream Survey

     The NSWS is divided into two major components (Figure  1.1),  the National
     Lake Survey (NLS) and the National Stream Survey (NSS),  each of which has
     three phases. This document pertains to  Phase  I of the  NSS  (NSS-I)  and a
     Phase I pilot survey that was conducted as a trial  prior to  the full NSS-I
     sampling effort.

     The NSS-I involves a synoptic chemical survey of streams in  the Eastern
     U.S. and was  designed to alleviate uncertainty  in making regional
     assessments based on existing data by:

          (1)  providing data from a subset of streams which  are  characteristic
               of  the overall population  of streams  within  a  region;

          (2)  using  standardized methods  in collection of  chemical  data;

          (3)  measuring a complete set of variables thought  to influence or
               be  influenced by surface-water  acidification;

          (4)  providing data which can be used to statistically  investigate
               relationships among chemical variables on a  regional  basis; and

          (5)  providing reliable estimates of the chemical status  of  streams
               within a region of interest.

     The U.S. Environmental  Protection Agency  (EPA)  requires  that data collec-
     tion activities  be based on a program which ensures that the resulting
     data are of known quality and are suitable for  the purpose for which they
     are intended. The goals of the EPA  in designing the NSS-I were to clearly
     identify NSS-I objectives;  identify  intended uses and  users  of the data;

-------
                                                                Section 1.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page 2 of 6
                      NATIONAL SURFACE WATER SURVEY (NSWS)
          NATIONAL LAKE SURVEY (NLS)
                           NATIONAL STREAM SURVEY (NSS)
      PHASE I
 Synoptic Chemistry
Eastern Survey (1984)
      PHASE I
 Synoptic Chemistry
Western Survey (1985)
   PHASE I
Pilot Survey
   (1985)
Phase II
Temporal
Variability
(1986)
Phase II
Biological
Resources
(1986)
Phase I Synoptic Survey
(1986)





        Phase III Long-Term Monitoring
                    (1987)
                          Phase II
                          Temporal
                         Variability
                           (1987)
            Phase II
            Biological
            Resources
              (1987)
                                                Phase III  Long-Term Monitoring
                                                             (1987)
    Figure 1.1.   Organizational  diagram of the National  Surface Water Survey
        and the  years during which field activities are  to be initiated.

-------
                                                                Section 1.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 3 of 6


     develop an overall conceptual  and practical  approach to meeting the objec-
     tives; develop an appropriate  survey design;  identify the quality of data
     needed; develop analytical  protocols and quality assurance/quality control
     (QA/QC) procedures; test the approach through a "pilot" or feasibility
     study; and revise and modify the approach and methodology as needed.

     By using these criteria as guidelines, NSS-I  was designed to provide statis-
     tically comparable data which  could be extrapolated with a known degree of
     confidence to a regional or national scale.   The conceptual approach to
     the survey emphasized that the data would not be used to ascribe observed
     effects to acidic deposition phenomena.   Rather, the intent of the survey
     was to provide information for the development of correlative, not cause-
     and-effect, relationships through large-scale monitoring activities.

     The Quality Assurance Plan (Drouse et al., 1986) provides details of the
     extensive external and internal QA and QC activities for the Phase-I
     Pilot and NSS-I.

     This manual provides details of the analytical methods and internal  QC
     used to process and analyze the stream samples.  Details of the actual
     sampling and on-site stream analyses are provided in the field operations
     manual (Hagley et al., 1986).

1.2  Physical  Parameters and Analytes Measured

     The constituents  and parameters to be measured, along with a rationale for
     each, are listed  below.  Table 1.1 lists the  required detection limits,
     relative precision goals, and  expected ranges.
     1.2.1     Base-Neutralizing Capacity (BNC)
                   BNC is the BNC of a sample due to dissolved C02,  hydro-
               nium, and hydroxide.   In conjunction with ANC,  this measurement
               is useful in refining calculations for both ANC and BNC.   (An
               iterative calculation procedure is performed.   During each
               iteration, improved values for ANC and BNC are  generated).

     1.2.2     Acid-Neutralizing Capacity (ANC)

               ANC is a measure of all bases in  a sample and is an indication
               of buffering capacity.   Negative  ANC is an indication of  mineral
               BNC (mineral BNC = -  ANC).

     1.2.3     Aluminum, Total  Extractable

               Total extractable aluminum is an  estimate of dissolved aluminum
               and includes most mononuclear aluminum species.  Aluminum is
               considered to be highly toxic especially to fish.   Knowing its

-------
                                                                Section 1.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page 4 of 6
   TABLE 1.1.  REQUIRED MINIMUM ANALYTICAL DETECTION LIMITS, EXPECTED RANGES,
                        AND INTRALAB RELATIVE PRECISION
  Parameter3
 Units
 Required
Detection  Expected
 Limit     Range
                           Relative
                           Intralab
                    Precision Goal
BNC
ANC
Al, Total


Extractable
peq/L
ueq/L
mg/L
5 10-150 10
5 -100-1000 10
0.005 0.005-1.0 10(A1>0.01),20(A1<0.01)
  Al Total                mg/L
  Al, Nonexchangeable     mg/L
   and Total PCV Reactive
  Ca                      mg/L
            0.005   0.005-1.0   10(A1>0.01),20(A1<0.01)
  Cl
  DIC
  DOC

  F, Total dissolved
  Fe
  K
  Mg
  Mn

  Na
  NH4
  N03

  P, Total dissolved
  pH, Field
  pH, Lab

  Si02

  S04
  Specific Conductance
  True Color

  Turbidity
  mg/L
  mg/L
  mg/L

  mg/L
  mg/L
  mg/L
  mg/L
  mg/L

  mg/L
  mg/L
  mg/L

  mg/L
 pH units
 pH units

  mg/L

  mg/L
  uS/cm
PCU units6

  NTU
0.010
0.01

0.01
0.05
0.1

0.005
0.01
0.01
0.01
0.01

0.01
0.01
0.005

0.002
0.05

0.05
 d
0
                    0.010-0.800 10(A1>0.01),20(A1<0.01)
                      0.5-
           0.2-
           0.1-
           0.1-

          0.01-
          0.01-
           0.1-
           0.1-
          0.01-

           0.5-
          0.01-
          0.01-

         0.005-
             3-
             3-
i-20

  10
  20
 •50

  0.2
  5
  1
  7
 •5

  7
  2
  5
 5
10
 5(DOO5),10(DOC<5)
 5
10
 5
 5
10

 5
 5
10
 •0.07   10(P>0.01),20(P<0.01)
 -8   ±0.1C
 -8   ±0.05C
             2-25
             1-
             5-
             0-
  20      5
  1000    1
  200    ±5C
            2-15
                     10
Dissolved ions and metals are being determined except where noted.
bUnless otherwise noted, this is the relative precision at concentrations
 above 10 times instrumental detection limits.
cAbsolute precision goal is in terms of applicable units.
dBlank must be <0.9 uS/cm.
ePCU = platinum-cobalt units.

-------
                                                           Section  1.0
                                                           Revision 2
                                                           Date:  11/86
                                                           Page 5 of 6


          concentration is important in assessing the biological environ-
          ment of a stream.

1.2.4     Aluminum, Total

          Total aluminum is an estimate of the potential  aluminum pool
          available to the biological  environment.

1.2.5     Aluminum, Nonexchangeable Pyrocatechol  Violet (PCV)  and Total
          PCV Reactive

          Exchangeable PCV reactive aluminum,  measured as the  difference
          between total reactive and nonexchangeable reactive,  is that
          fraction of soluble aluminum species biologically available and
          considered toxic to fish.  It is therefore important to know the
          relative amount of the exchangeable  species to assess the
          biological environment of a stream.

1.2.6     Dissolved Inorganic Carbon

          The field determination of dissolved inorganic carbon (DIC) is
          necessary in determining the degree  of  dissolved C02 saturation
          in a stream.  Both the field and lab determinations  of DIC (com-
          bined with pH) are useful in QA/QC calculations.

1.2.7     Dissolved Ions (Na, K, Ca, Mg, Fe, Mn,  NH4, F,  Cl, S04, N03)

          These are determined in order to chemically characterize  the
          stream especially for mass ion balance  and buffering capacity.
          Fluoride is also important as an aluminum chelator.

1.2.8     Dissolved Organic Carbon

          Dissolved organic carbon (DOC) determination is necessary to
          establish a relationship with color  and to estimate  the
          concentration of organic acids.  Also,  DOC is important as
          a natural chelator of aluminum.

1.2.9     Dissolved Silica (Si02)

          The absence or existence of dissolved silica is an important
          factor controlling diatom blooms, and it assists in  identifying
          trophic status.  It is also an indication of mineral  weathering.

1.2.10    pH

          pH is a general and direct indication of free hydrogen ion
          concentration.

-------
                                                                Section 1.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 6 of 6
     1.2.11    Specific Conductance
               The conductance of stream water is a general  indication  of its
               ionic strength and is related to buffering  capacity.

     1.2.12    Total Dissolved Phosphorus

               This is an indicator of potentially available nutrients  for
               phytoplankton productivity and overall  trophic status.

     1.2.13    True Color

               True color,  measured in PCU (platinum-cobalt  units),  is  an indi-
               cator of organic acids and DOC.  Substances which  impart color
               may also be  important natural chelators of  aluminum.

     1.2.14    Turbidity

               Turbidity is a measure of suspended material  in a  water  column
               and is measured in nephelometric turbidity  units (NTU).

1.3  References

     Drouse, S. K., D. C. Hillman,  L. W. Creelman, and S.  J. Simon,  1986.
          National Surface  Water Survey - Stream Survey (Pilot, Middle-Atlantic
          Phase I, Southeast Screening, and Middle-Atlantic  Episode  Pilot)
          Quality Assurance Plan.


     Hagley, C. A., C. M. Knapp, C. L. Mayer, and F.  A. Morris, 1986.   The
          National Surface  Water Survey Stream Survey (Pilot, Middle-Atlantic
          Phase I, Southeast Screening, and Middle-Atlantic  Episode  Pilot)
          Field Training and Operations Manual.

-------
                                                                Section 2.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 1  of 45
2.0  FIELD OPERATIONS                     t

     Field operations are based at fully equipped mobile processing labora-
     tories (MPL) in Las Vegas (for the pilot study the MPL were  in the  field)
     A list of equipment contained in the MPL is given in Table 2.1.  Stream
     samples, collected by sampling crews, are sent by Federal  Express to  the
     MPL for preliminary analysis, processing, and shipment to  analytical
     laboratories for more detailed analysis.

     The activities of the MPL crew are described in this section.   Sampling
     crew activities are described elsewhere (Hagley et al., 1986).

2.1  Personnel
     The MPL is staffed by a crew consisting of a coordinator,  supervisor,
     chemist, and analysts.  Coordinators are responsible for the  overall
     operation of the MPL including coordination with the sampling crews,
     sample tracking and logistics, data forms, and safety.   The supervisor
     with the assistance of the chemist and analysts is responsible for  MPL
     measurements and sample processing.

2.2  Daily Operations

     The MPL operates each day that samples arrive.  The daily MPL activities
     are outlined in Figure 2.1 and are divided into activities that are
     conducted before sample arrival (Section 2.2.1) and activities that are
     conducted following sample arrival (Section 2.2.2).

2.2.1  Activities Before Sample Arrival

       Prior to sample arrival, the reagents for determining DIG,  pH,  and  PCV
       Al, and for preparing aliquot 2 (total extractable Al) are  prepared as
       described in sections 2.3, 2.4, 2.7, and 2.8, respectively.  Also,  the
       carbon analyzer, pH meter, nephelometer, and the flow injection analyzer
       (FIA) are calibrated as described in sections 2.3, 2.4,  2.5, and  2.7,
       respectively.

2.2.2  Activities Following Sample Arrival

       After samples are delivered by the carrier, the steps outlined  in
       Figure 2.1 are performed.  The first step, performed  by the coordinator,
       involves organizing the samples into a batch.  The next six steps
       (aliquot preparation and pH, DIG, color, PCV Al  and turbidity determina-
       tions) are performed simultaneously by the supervisor and analysts.
       Finally, after all measurements and processing are finished, the  data
       forms are completed, the samples are packed, and the  forms  and  samples
       are shipped to their destinations.  These steps are detailed in sections
       2.2.2.1 through 2.2.2.4.

-------
                                                               Section 2.0
                                                               Revision 2
                                                               Date:   11/86
                                                               Page 2 of 45
           TABLE 2.1.   MOBILE PRQCESSING LABORATORY EQUIPMENT LIST
    Mobile Lab Equipped with

    a. Electrical and water inputs
    b. Water outlet
    c. Source of water meeting ASTM Type I specifications (such as Barnstead
       NANOpure/ROpure 40 or Millipore Milli-RO/Super-Q System)
    d. Heating/cooling system
    e. Freezer
    f. Laminar-flow hood delivering class 100 air
    g. Solvent storage cabinet
    h. Standard laboratory countertops and sink
    i. Analytical balance and plastic weighing boats
2.  Centrifuge (capable of holding four 50-mL tubes)

3.  Clean 4-L Cubitainers

4.  Clean Nalgene Amber Wide-Mouth Bottles

    a. 500-mL (Nalgene No. 2106-0016)
    b. 250-mL (Nalgene No. 2106-0008)
    c. 125-mL (Nalgene No. 2106-0004)

5.  Total Extractable Aluminum Supplies

    a. Clean 50-mL graduated centrifuge tubes
        with sealing caps (Fisher No.  05-538-55A)
    b. 10-mL polypropylene test tubes  (Elkay No.
        000-2024-001
    c. Plug Tite sealing caps (Elkay No.  127-0019-200)
    d. HPLC-grade methyl  isobutyl  ketone (MIBK)
    e. Sodium acetate (Alfa ultrapure)
    f. 8-hydroxyquinoline (99+ percent purity)
    g. NfyOH (30 percent - Baker Instra-Analyzed  grade)
    h. Clean 1-L, 500-mL, and 100-mL volumetric flasks
    i. Glacial acetic acid (Baker Instra-Analyzed  grade)
    j. Hydrochloric acid (12 M - Baker Instra-Analyzed  grade)
    k. Phenol-red indicator solution (0.04 percent w/v  -
         American Scientific Products  5720)
    1. 2.00-mL Repipet dispenser
    m. 3.00-mL Repipet dispenser top for 1-gallon  bottle
    n. 5.00-mL Repipet dispenser
    o. 100-mL reagent bottle with dropper (Nalgene 2411-0060)
    p. Polystyrene graduated cylinders
         (25-, 100-, 250-mL sizes)
- 1

- 30/day
- 30/day
- 60/day
- 90/day
- 30/day

- 30/day
- 30/day
- 180 mL/day
- 80 g/month
- 30 g/month
- 750 mL/month
- 5 of each
- 100 mL/month
- 500 mL/month

- 1 L
- 21 station
- 21 station
- 2/station
- 2/station

- 2 each/station
                                                                   (continued)

-------
TABLE 2.1.  (Continued)
                                    Section 2.0
                                    Revision 2
                                    Date:   11/86
                                    Page 3 of 45
 6.  Color Determination Kit (Hach Model  CO-1)

 7.  Color Kit Spare Supplies

     a. Color disc (Hach No. 2092-00)
     b. Color viewing tube (Hach No.  1730-00)
     c. Hollow polyethylene stoppers  (Hach No.  14480-74)

 8.  Filtration Apparatus and Supplies

     a. Membrane filters, 0.45 urn, 47-mm  diameter
        (Gelman No.  60173) (package of 100)
     b. Teflon or plastic forceps
     c. Fisher filtrator - low form (Fisher 09-788)
     d. Acrylic vacuum chambers (custom made)
     e. Clean filter holder (Nalgene  No.  310-4000)
     f. Spare rubber stoppers (Fisher  No.  09-788-2)
     g. Vacuum pump  with regulator (Mi Hi pore  No. xx5500000)

 9.  Disposable Gloves (talc-free)

10.  Preservation Supplies

     a. Repipet Jr.  (0.1 ml)
     b. Indicating pH paper (Whatman  Type CS No.  2626-990
          range 1.8  - 3.8)
     c. HN03 and H2$04 (Baker Ultrex  grade or  Seastar
          Ultrapure  grade)

11.  Frozen Freeze Gel Packs - daily  use  (reuseable)
                             - shipping
12.  Styrofoam-Lined Shipping Containers

13.  Field Data Forms,  Shipping Forms,  Batch Forms,  etc.

14.  Color Blindness Test Kit

15.  DIC Determination  Supplies

     a.    Dohrman DC-80 carbon analyzer
     b.    50-mL polypropylene syringes  - station  use
                                       - field  use
     c.    Mininert syringe valves       - station  use
                                       - field  use
                                   - 2
                                     2
                                     10
                                     10
                                   - 7 pkg/week
                                   - 5
                                   - 3
                                   - 6
                                   - 12
                                   - 6
                                   - 1

                                   - 2 pkg/week
                                   - 2
                                   - 6 packs/week

                                   - 50 ml/week
                                   -  25/day
                                   -  30/40 sample
                                      batch

                                   -  4/day
                                   -  1
                                     1
                                     50
                                     I/sample
                                     20
                                     70
                                        (continued)

-------
                                                                Section 2.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 4 of 45
                            TABLE 2.1.  (Continued)

     d.   Zero-grade nitrogen gas

     e.   Anhydrous NagCC^ (ACS Primary Standard Grade)
     f.   Syringe membrane filters (Gelman Acrodisc
           4218, 0.45 urn)
     g.   Spare carbon analyzer parts (nuts,  ferrules,
           tubing, etc.)

16.  MPL pH Supplies

     a.   pH meter (Orion Model 611)
     b.   Orion Ross epoxy body combination pH electrode
     c.   Filling solution for Ross combination pH
           electrode (pack of 6 bottles)
     d.   pH sample chamber
     e.   Certified 0.100 N H2S04
     f.   Ringstand (to hold pH apparatus) and clamps
     g.   NBS-traceable pH buffers (pH 4  and  7)

     h.   50-mL disposable beakers

     Turbidimeter (Monitek Model 21)

     Turbidimeter Supplies

     a.   5-, 10-, 20-, 50-, 100-, 200-NTU standards
     b.   Cuvettes

     Class 100 Air Filtration Filters

     Spare Water Treatment Cartridges

     Coolers

     Clean 20-L Cubitainers with Spigots

     Digital Micropipets (5-40 uL, 40-200 uL,  200-1,000  uL,
       1,000-5,000 uL)

     Micropipet Metal-Free Pi pet Tips (in four sizes
       corresponding to micropipet sizes  in item 23)
17.

18,
19.

20.

21.

22.

23.


24.
25.  Reagents for PCV Aluminum Procedure

     a.   Hydrochloric acid (Ultrex grade or equivalent)
     b.   1,10-Phenanthroline
                                                               - 1 cylinder/
                                                                 month
                                                               - 500 g

                                                               - I/sample
                                                                 2
                                                                 6

                                                                 2
                                                                 2
                                                                 2 L
                                                                 2
                                                                 2 L  of  each/
                                                                   month
                                                                 200
- 1
  1 L of each
  10

  6

  6

  4

  5

  1 of each
  2 cases (1,000
    tips/case)
    of each size
                                                                    (continued)

-------
                                                                Section  2.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page  5 of 45
                            TABLE 2.1.   (Continued)
     c.   Hydroxylammonium chloride
     d.   Pyrocatechol violet
     e.   Hexamethylenetetraamine
     f.   Ammonium hydroxide
     g.   Aluminum standard
     h.   Ion-exchange resin
     i.   Nucleopore polycarbonate filters
     j.   Syringe filter holder
     k.   Nitric acid (Ultrex grade or equivalent)
     1.   Polystyrene divinyl benzene beads

26.  Flow injection analyzer (Lachat)

-------
                                                             Section 2.0
                                                             Revision 2
                                                             Date:   11/86
                                                             Page 6 of 45
Before Sample Arrival
    1.  Prepare reagents for

        a) Total extractable Al
        b) DIG
        c) pH
        d) PCV Al

    2.  Warm up and calibrate instruments

         a) Turbidimeter
         b) Carbon analyzer
         c) pH meter
         d) FIA
                                   Samples
        Following Sample Arrival
                     1.   Insert required audit samples,  assign
                         batch and ID numbers, start batch  form
                     2.   Determine DIG
                     3.   Prepare aliquots
                     4.   Measure pH
                     5.   Measure turbidity
                     6.   Determine true color
                     7.   Determine aluminum species
                     8.   Complete batch and shipping forms
                     9.   Ship samples
                    10.   Distribute data
Figure 2.1.   Flow scheme of daily mobile processing  laboratory  activities.

-------
                                                                Section 2.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page 7 of 45
2.2.2.1   Sample Identification and Batch  Organization—Three types of samples
          (routine,  duplicate,  and blank)  are  collected and  delivered to the
          MPL.   The  sample type is indicated on  the  sample label  (Figure 2.2).
          The samples collected on a given day are organized into a batch
          consisting of the routine, duplicate,  and  blank samples collected on
          that day as well as audit samples (inserted  daily  at  the MPL).


          After organization, a unique  batch ID  number is assigned to each
          batch and  is recorded on the  labels  (and corresponding  aliquot
          labels)  of all  samples in the batch.   Next,  an ID  number is randomly
          assigned to each sample as follows:

          Routine  Samples - Five sample containers are filled at each stream,
          namely,  four syringes (for DIG,  pH,  PCV Al determination) and a cubi-
          tainer.   One ID number is assigned to  all  five containers and is
          recorded on each container label.

          Duplicate  and Blank Samples - ID numbers are assigned in the same
          manner as  for the routine samples.   (Note:   There  are no syringe
          samples  for the blank.)

          Field Audit Samples - One 2-1 field  audit  sample (received each day
          from a central  source) is inserted into each day's batch of samples.
          The field  audit sample is assigned an  ID number in the  same manner
          as a  routine sample,  and the  number  is recorded on the  label (Figure
          2.3a).

          Lab Audit  Samples - One lab audit sample (received from a central
          source)  is included in each day's batch.   A  single lab audit sample
          consists of a set of seven aliquots.   Each aliquot has  a temporary
          label  (Figure 2.3b) listing the  aliquot number, audit sample code,
          preservative amount,  and shipping date.  The lab audit  sample is then
          assigned batch  and sample ID  numbers in the  same manner as for a
          routine  sample.  An aliquot label  (Figure  2.3c) is attached to each
          aliquot, and the batch and sample ID numbers are recorded on the
          label  as are the date and amount of  preservative added.

          After the  batch and sample ID numbers  have been assigned and recorded
          on each  sample  label, the same information is recorded on Form 5,
          Batch/QC Field  Data (Figure 2.4).  Codes necessary to complete the
          form  are given  in Table 2.2.

         NOTE 1:  The ID  numbers are randomly  assigned to all samples in a
                  batch.   Furthermore,  ID  numbers run  consecutively from 1 to
                  the number of samples in the batch.  Audit samples must not
                  always  be assigned the same  ID number.

-------
                                                    Section 2.0
                                                    Revision 2
                                                    Date:  11/86
                                                    Page 8 of 45
     STREAM ID
 U/L
CREW
     DATE SAMPLED
TIME SAMPLED
 PROGRAM

|~|  PHASE I

|~|  SCREENING

I"""!  EPISODE  PILOT
 SAMPLE TYPE

|  ROUTINE

|  DUPLICATE

I  BLANK
                   EPISODE  TYPE

         BASE  -  EPISODE  ONLY

         BASE  -  EPISODE  AND PHASE  I

         RISING

         PEAK

         FALLING
 BATCH  ID
SAMPLE ID
                                 Revised l-8b
           Figure 2.2.  Field sample label.

-------
                                                              Section 2.0
                                                              Revision 2
                                                              Date:   11/86
                                                              Page 9 of 45
FIELD AUDIT SAMPLE
Radian ID No.
Date
Shipped
Code
Batch
Date
Received


ID
a.  Field Audit Sample
         Label
                                                     LAB AUDIT SAMPLE
                                             Aliquot No.
                                              Date Shipped
    Date Received
                                              Code
                                              Preservative Amount
                                               b.   Lab Audit Sample Label
                        Al 1 quot
                        Batch ID

                        Sample ID

                        Date Sampled
                        Preservative

                        Amount

                        Parameters
                            c.   Aliquot Label
Note:  The aliquot
no., preservative,
and parameters are
preprinted on the
seven aliquot
labels.
               Figure 2.3.   Aliquot and Audit Sample Labels.

-------
                                                           Section  2.0
                                                           Revision 2
                                                           Date:   11/86
                                                           Page 10  of 45
NATIONAL SURFACE WATER SURVEY
   BATCH/QC FIELD DATA FORM
DATE RECEIVED
BY DATA MOT	
O FORM 2 LAKES
       OR
O FORM 5 STREAMS
       CUT* ouAumus «,» ««i AHI AVMUUU ron use ON THIS F
          OUALOTtH
       Figure 2.4.  NSWS  Form 5 -  Batch/QC Field  Data.

-------
                                                                Section 2.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 11 of 45
                        TABLE 2.2.  LIST OF SAMPLE CODES
Sample Type
    Code
     Description
Normal3
Audit
Episodic
     R
     D
     B
     TD
F L 1-001
     EB
     ER
     EP
     EF
     Ml
     M2
     S
Routine Stream Sample
Duplicate Stream Sample
Field Blank Sample
Trailer Duplicate

Radian  I.D. Number
Concentrate lot number
Concentration Level
L = low, N = Natural
Type of Audit Sample (F = FIELD, L = LAB)
Episodic sample, base hydrograph
Episodic sample, rising hydrograph
Episodic sample, peak hydrograph
Episodic sample, falling hydrograph
Initial Middle Atlantic Phase I Sample
Final Middle Atlantic Phase I Sample
Southeast Screening Sample

aNormal samples require a Stream ID.

-------
                                                                Section  2.0
                                                                Revision  2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page  12  of 45
         NOTE 2:  Field audit samples are processed  exactly like  routine  stream
                  samples.  Lab audit samples receive  no  field  treatment  other
                  than labeling and shipping.

         NOTE 3:  Seven (eight for the Pilot Study)  different aliquots  are
                  prepared from each field sample  (routine,  duplicate,  or
                  blank).   Each aliquot is assigned  the same batch  and  ID
                  number as the sample from which  it is prepared.

         NOTE 4:  After Form 5 is completed,  the temporary  label  on  the lab
                  audit sample (seven aliquots) is removed  and  placed in the
                  lab audit logbook.

2.2.2.2   Determination of DIG, pH, Turbidity, True  Color,  and  PCV  Al—These
          parameters are measured as described in  sections  2.3, 2.4, 2.5, 2.6,
          and 2.7, respectively.

2.2.2.3   Aliquot Preparation—Seven aliquots (eight for  the Stream  Study
          Pilot) are prepared from each sample, each with the same batch and
          sample ID numbers.  The details for preparing each aliquot are
          provided in section 2.8.

2.2.2.4   Form Completion, Sample Shipment,  and Data Distribution—After a
          batch has been completely processed, the supervisor records all
          analytical data on Form 5 (Figure  2.4).  The coordinator  then reviews
          and signs the form.  Next, each aliquot  is sealed  in  a  plastic bag
          and is packed in a Styrofoam-1ined shipping  container along with
          7 to 10 frozen freeze-gel packs (to maintain aliquots at  4°C).  A
          shipping form (Figure 2.5) is then completed and  enclosed with each
          container, and the containers are  shipped  by overnight  delivery to
          its destination.  Finally, copies  of Forms 1 (a form  completed by the
          sampling crew for each sample),  3,  and 5 are sent  to  the locations
          indicated in Figure 2.6.

2.3  Determination of PIC

2.3.1  Scope and Application

       This method is applicable to the determination  of DIC in natural surface
       waters and is written specifically for the  NSWS.  DIC is determined in
       NSWS mobile processing laboratories by using  a  Dohrman DC-80 Carbon
       Analyzer.  For this reason, the method has  been written  with the assump-
       tion that the DC-80 is being used (Xertex - Dohrman  Corp., 1984).  The
       method detection limit (MDL) for DIC  determined from  replicate analyses
       of a calibration blank (approximately 0.1 mg/L  DIC)  is 0.1 mg/L  DIC.  A
       1.00-mL sample volume was used to determine the MDL.  The  applicable
       analyte concentration range is 0.1 to 50 mg/L DIC.

-------
                                                                 Section 2.0
                                                                 Revision  2
                                                                 Date:   11/86
                                                                 Page  13 of 45
•ATONAL KMFACt WATER &KVEV
tAAPlE MANAOEMENT OFFICE
tJO. K» • I •
ALEXANDRIA.VA  11314
  news
  FORM 9

SHIPPING
RECEIVED PT __________
IF ^COMPLETE WMEWATeLY NOTlFTt
  tAA»>LE MAMAGEMENT OFFICE
      (703) SST-1490
FROM
CSTATON O)|
•AMPVC
«
01
0<
09
04
OS
0«
07
oa
ot
10
1 1
It
13
14
19
It
IT
It
It
to
tl
tz
(3
*4
C9
St
IT
SB
t*
90
TO
(LAB)i
tATCM
10
OATt tAMPLEO

H.QUOTS SHWCD
CFOI 9TATON USE OM.V)
1






























t






























>






























4






























9






























t






























T






























DATE IMFPEO DATE RECEIVED
Mt-tUNO. _______


•AMU CONOITOi k^OM LAt MSCCVT
(FONL«tUSEOM.T>






























OUAUFCXSi
       VI AUOUOT tMWEO
       Mi AUOuOTHBSMCDUETOOESTIIOYEOtMPLE
WHITE - FCLOOCFT
                  TCiiow-tMOOtrr
                  tO.0 - LA* OOFT FOX MCTtlM tO MO
               Figure  2.5.   NSWS  Form 3  - Shipping.

-------
                                                        Section  2.0
                                                        Revision 2
                                                        Date:  11/86
                                                        Page  14  of 45
ANALYTICAL
LABORATORY
Form 3 (2 copies)
   MOBILE
 PROCESSING
 LABORATORY
(keeps 1 copy
 of Forms 1,
  3, and 5)
     Form 3 (1 copy).
     SAMPLE
   MANAGEMENT
     OFFICE
                                        Form 3
                            QA
                          MANAGER
                      (EMSL-Las Vegas)
                   Forms 1 and 5
                             DATA
                             BASE
                         (Oak Ridge)
                                         Forms 1  and  5
                 Figure 2.6.   Data flow scheme.

-------
                                                                Section 2.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 15 of 45
2.3.2  Summary of Method
       Samples for DIG determination are collected and sealed at the stream
       sites in syringes.  At the MPL, a syringe filter is attached to  the
       syringe, and sample is filtered into the sample loop of the DC-80.   The
       sample is subsequently injected into a reaction chamber containing 5
       percent phosphoric acid.  The carbonates (DIG)  in the sample react with
       the acid to form C02 which is sparged from the  reaction chamber  with a
       nitrogen gas carrier stream.   The C02 in the carrier stream is then
       detected and quantified (in terms of DIG) by an infrared (IR)  C02
       analyzer.
2.3.3  Interferences
       No interferences are known.
2.3.4  Safety
       The calibration standards, sample types, and most reagents used  in
       this method pose no hazard to the analyst.  Protective clothing  (lab
       coat and gloves) and safety glasses must be used when handling
       concentrated phosphoric acid.
       The nitrogen cylinder must be secured in an upright position.  The
       line pressure must be kept below 40 psi.
2.3.5  Apparatus and Equipment
2.3.5.1   Dohrman DC-80 Carbon Analyzer equipped with  High Sensitivity  Sampler
          (1.00-mL loop).
2.3.5.2   Reagent bottles for DIG standards (equipped  with three-valve  cap  to
          permit storage under a COg-free atmosphere,  Rainin No. 45-3200).
2.3.5.3   0.45-um syringe filters (Cellulose nitrate).
2.3.5.4   60-mL plastic syringes.
2.3.5.5   Luer-Lok syringe valves.
2.3.6  Reagents and Consumable Materials
2.3.6.1   Nitrogen Gas (99.9 percent)—C02-free.
2.3.6.2   Phosphoric Acid (5 percent v/v)—Carefully add 50 ml concentrated
          phosphoric acid (H^PO^ sp gr 1.71) to 500 ml water.  Mix well
          and dilute to 1,000 ml with water.

-------
                                                                Section  2.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 16  of 45
2.3.6.3   Stock DIG Quality Control  Sample Solution—Weekly,  open  a fresh
          ampule of anhydrous, primary standard grade sodium  carbonate
          and dissolve 8.825 g in water, then dilute to 1.000 L.   Store  at
          4°C in a special reagent bottle under a C02~free atmosphere.

2.3.6.4   Stock DIG Calibration Standard Solution—Biweekly,  open  a fresh
          ampule of anhydrous, primary standard grade N32C03  and dissolve
          8.825 g in water, then dilute to 1.000 L.   Store at 4°C  in a
          special reagent bottle under a C02~free atmosphere.

2.3.6.5   Water—Water used in all  preparations must conform  to ASTM specifica-
          tions for Type I water (ASTM, 1984).   Such water is obtained from the
          Millipore Milli-Q water system.

2.3.7  Sample Collection, Preservation, and Storage

       Samples are collected and sealed in 60-mL plastic syringes.   They are
       stored at 4°C until use.

2.3.8  Calibration and Standardization

2.3.8.1   Set up and operate the DC-80 according to  the manufacturer's instruc-
          tions.

2.3.8.2   Calibration Standard (10.00 mg/L DIC)—Prepare the  calibration
          standard daily by diluting 5.000 ml of the stock DIC calibration
          standard to 500.00 ml with fresh water. Store in a special  reagent
          bottle under a C02~free atmosphere.

2.3.8.3   Erase previous calibration.  Load the sample loop with the 10.00-mg/L
          DIC calibration standard by flushing with  7 to 10 ml solution.
          Inject and start the analysis.  When the analysis is complete, repeat
          the process twice more.

2.3.8.4   Calibrate the analyzer by  pushing the calibrate button.   This  com-
          pletes the calibration.  Sample results are output  directly in mg/L
          DIC.

2.3.9  Quality Control

       QC procedures are outlined in Figure 2.7 and  are described  in sections
       2.3.9.1 through 2.3.9.5.

2.3.9.1   Initial Calibration Verification and Linearity Check—Immediately
          after calibration, analyze two QC samples  to ensure the  calibration
          validity and linearity.

-------
  Prepare calibration and QC  standards.
I  Perform Initial calibration!
  (three 10-ng/L  analyses).   I
  Hake Initial  callb. linearity check
  1.  Analyze 2 mg/L QC sample
  2.  Analyze 20 •g/L QC sample	
YES/        Are Measured values
        2.0 i 0.2 and 20.0 +_ O.S ng/L?
          Record value 1n logbook,
          and record value for 2.00
          ng/L QC sample on Fom 5.
YES
          Analyze calibration
          blank.  Is value <0.l
          •9/L7	
           Record value In logbook.
                 _L
          Analyze up to 10 samples.'
 NO   X^Analyze 2.00 ag/L QC sample.^
             measured value 2.0 + 0.21
                                                                                   Section  2.0
                                                                                   Revision 2
                                                                                   Date:   11/86
                                                                                   Page  17  of  45
                                                         Check Instrunent operation
                                                         and standard preparation.
                                                                             Record sample result
                                                                              and unacceptable QC
                                                                              result on Form 5.
YES
                                               Record QC result
                                              and previous sanple
                                               results on Fora 5.
 •Analyze one sanple per batch In duplicate.
 ^Reanalyze sample associated with unacceptable QC  result.
Does enough volume
renaln of previous
samples for re anal-
ysis?
              Figure  2.7.   Flow  scheme for  DIC  determination.

-------
                                                                Section  2.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page  18  of 45
          Daily, prepare a 2.00-mg/L and a 20.00-mg/L DIG QC sample by  diluting
          1.000 and 10.00 ml of the stock DIG QC sample,  respectively,  to
          500.00 mL with fresh water.  Store each DIG QC  sample  in  a special
       .   reagent bottle under a C02~free atmosphere.

          Analyze the QC samples.  The results must be 2.0 ± 0.2 and 20.0  ±  0.5
          mg/L DIG.  If the results do not fall  within these ranges,  a  problem
          exists in the calibration, standard preparation, or QC sample prepa-
          ration.  The problem must be resolved prior to  sample  analysis,  and
          the QC samples must be reanalyzed.  Acceptable  results must be
          obtained before continuing.

2.3.9.2   Continuing Calibration Verification—To check for calibration drift,
          analyze the 2.00-mg/L DIC QC sample after every 10 samples and after
          the last sample.   The measured value must be 2.0 ± 0.2 mg/L DIC.   If
          it is not, repeat the calibration and reanalyze all  samples analyzed
          since the last acceptably analyzed QC sample.

2.3.9.3   Calibration Blank Analysis—After the initial calibration,  analyze a
          fresh calibration blank.   It must contain less  than 0.1 mg/L  DIC.  If
          it does not, check the water system and repeat  the calibration pro-
          cedure (including preparation of standards).

2.3.9.4   Duplicate Analysis—To determine the analytical  precision,  analyze
          one sample per batch in duplicate.

2.3.9.5   Detection Limit Determination—Determine the detection limit  by
          analyzing 20 blank samples.  The detection limit is defined as three
          times the standard deviation.

2.3.10 Procedure

2.3.10.1   Check that the DC-80 is equilibrated and that a stable baseline  has  been
          achieved.

2.3.10.2   Prepare calibration standard and calibrate the  analyzer.

2.3.10.3   Perform the necessary QC analyses.  Proceed with sample analysis if
          acceptable results are obtained.

2.3.10.4   Place a syringe valve on  the sample syringe and filter 7  to 10 mL  of
          sample directly into the sample loop.   Inject the sample  and  start
          the analysis.  Discard the syringe filter after a single  use.

2.3.10.5   Thirty seconds after injection, switch the valve to the load  position
          and load the next sample.  The analysis time for a single sample is
          3 to 4 minutes.

-------
                                                                Section 2.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 19 of 45
2.3.10.6  At the end of the day, rinse the sample loop with water.   Keep the
          power to the IR analyzer on at all times.

2.3.11 Calculations

       No calculations are necessary.  Sample results are output on the printer
       directly in mg/L DIG.

2.3.12 Reporting

       Record the batch and sample ID numbers directly on the printer output.
       Similarly identify QC samples.  Attach the printout to the logbook.
       Record the sample and QC data on Form 2.

2.4  Determination of pH

2.4.1  Scope and Application

       This method is applicable to the determination of pH in surface waters
       of low ionic strength and is written specifically for the NSWS.  For the
       NSWS, pH is determined in the MPL using an Orion Model 611 pH meter  and
       an Orion Ross combination pH electrode.  As a result, the method has
       been written assuming that the Orion meter and electrode are used (Orion,
       1983).  The applicable pH range is 3 to 11.

2.4.2  Summary of Method

       Samples for pH determination are collected and sealed in syringes at the
       stream site.  At the field station, pH is measured in a closed system to
       prevent atmospheric exposure.  The measurement is performed by attaching
       the sample syringe to the pH sample chamber (Figures 2.8 and 2.9), by
       injecting sample, and by determining pH by using a pH meter and electrode.

2.4.3  Interferences

       No interferences are known.

2.4.4  Safety

       The calibration standards, sample types, and most reagents used in
       this method pose no hazard to the analyst.  Protective clothing (lab
       coat and gloves) and safety glasses must be used when handling
       sulfuric acid.

2.4.5  Apparatus and Equipment

2.4.5.1   Orion Model 611 pH meter

-------
Figure 2.8.   Schematic of  pH measurement  system.
•O O 3O (/>
Q> Qi CD CD
 n> -•• c+
   ..(/>_/.
ro   -«• o
o   o 3
   »-• 3
OK-'    ro
-h —. ro •
   oo    o
-t* (f>
tn

-------
                                        Section 2.0
                                        Revision 2
                                        Date:   11/86
                                        Page 21 of 45
              INLET
Figure 2.9.  pH sample chamber.

-------
                                                                Section 2.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 22 of 45
2.4.5.2   Orion Ross combination pH electrode

2.4.5.3   pH sample chamber

2.4.5.4   60-mL plastic syringes

2.4.5.5   Luer-Lok syringe valves

2.4.6  Reagents and Consumable Materials

2.4.6.1   pH Calibration Buffers (pH 4 and 7)--Commercially available pH
          calibration buffers (NBS- traceable) at pH values of 4 and 7.

2.4.6.2   Potassium Chloride (3 M)— Dissolve 75 g KC1  in 1 L of water.
2.4.6.3   Stock pH Quality Control  Sample Solution (0.100N h^SO^-- Commercially
          available certified standard sulfuric acid at a concentration  of
          0.100N.

2.4.6.4   Water—Water used in all  preparations must conform to ASTM speci-
          fications for Type I water ASTM D 1193 (ASTM, 1984).   It  is obtained
          from the Millipore Milli-Q water system.

2.4.7  Sample Collection, Preservation,  and Storage

       Samples are collected and sealed  in 60-mL plastic syringes.   They are
       stored at 4°C until used.

2.4.8  Calibration and Standardization

2.4.8.1   Weekly, calibrate the temperature function of the pH  meter and
          electrode using a two-point calibration (4°C and room temperature)
          following the instructions.

2.4.8.2   Daily, calibrate the pH function of the pH meter and  electrode using
          a two-point calibration (pH 7  and 4)  following the instructions.

2.4.8.3   Copiously rinse the electrode  with water.  Immerse in 20  ml pH 7
          buffer and stir for 30 to 60 seconds.  Discard and replace with an
          additional 40 ml pH 7 buffer.   While  the solution is  gently stirred,
          measure and record the pH.

2.4.8.4   Repeat the preceding step using the pH 4 buffer.

2.4.8.5   Compare the pH values obtained for the pH 7 and 4 buffers  to their
          certified values.  If either observed value differs from  the certified
          value by more than ±0.02  pH units, repeat the electrode calibration.

-------
                                                                Section 2.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 23 of 45
          If acceptable results cannot be obtained, replace the electrode.

2.4.9  Quality Control

       QC procedures are outlined in Figure 2.10 and are as follows:

2.4.9.1   pH QC Check Sample—Daily, prepare a pH QC check sample (pH QCCS)
          by diluting 1.000 ml of the 0.100N H2S04 to 1.000 L with water.

2.4.9.2   Initial pH QC Check—Immediately after calibration, analyze the  pH
          QCCS by using the procedure described in section 2.4.8.  The observed
          pH must be 4.0 ± 0.1 pH unit.  If it is not, repeat the calibration
          process, then repeat the measurement on a fresh pH QCCS.  If an
          acceptable result is still not obtained, consult the troubleshooting
          guide which is provided by the manufacturer for the meter and elec-
          trode.  Samples must not be analyzed until  an acceptable value for
          the pH QCCS is obtained.

2.4.9.3   Continuing pH QC Check—In order to check for calibration drift,
          the pH QCCS sample is analyzed after every five samples and after  the
          last sample.  The measured valve must be 4.0 ± 0.1 pH unit.  If  it is
          not, recalibrate the electrode and meter and reanalyze all  samples
          analyzed since the last acceptably analyzed pH QCCS.

2.4.9.4   Duplicate Analysis—To determine the analytical precision,  analyze
          one sample per batch in duplicate.

2.4.10 Procedure

2.4.10.1  Calibrate the pH meter and electrode.

2.4.10.2  Perform the required QC analysis.  Proceed with sample analyses  if
          acceptable results are obtained.

2.4.10.3  Clamp a pH sample chamber to a ringstand.  Rinse thoroughly with
          water.

2.4.10.4  Equilibrate the sample syringes to room temperature.

2.4.10.5  Attach a sample syringe to the sample chamber.  Fill the chamber with
          sample.  Rinse the electrode in the top of the chamber for  15 to 30
          seconds.  Drain the chamber and repeat.  Refill the chamber with
          sample and loosely insert the electrode.  Flush with 5 to 10 ml
          sample to expel air bubbles, then lightly seal the chamber.  Measure
          and record the sample pH and temperature.  Monitor the pH reading.
          Record the reading when it stabilizes (± 0.01 pH unit/minute, usually
          about 1 to 5 minutes).  Slowly inject 5 ml sample over a 60-second
          period.  Measure the pH and record when stable.  Repeat the 5-mL
          injections until  successive pH readings are within 0.03 pH  units.

-------
                                                                Section 2.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page 24 of 45
   Perform initial
     calibration.
          Is QCCS
    within 0.1 pH unit?
No
            YES
Record on Form 5.
       Measure pH
    of 5 samples.3
    Record on Form 5.
                                              Yes
                                Record
                                  on
                                Form 5.
                              Jes
  Is QCCS within 0.1 pH unit?
Record QCCS value
on Form 5 and note
sample ID numbers
associated with
unacceptable QCCS.
                                        No
                                                                      \
                  Does  enough  volume
                  of previously  analyzed  \
                  stream samples remain    )
                  for reanalysis?        /
                     No
                              I
aMeasure 1 sample per batch in duplicate  (same  syringe).
bPrevious samples must be reanalyzed after unacceptable QCCS  is obtained.
               Figure 2.10.   Flow scheme  for  pH  determinations.

-------
                                                                Section 2.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page 25 of 45
2.4.10.6  Rinse the sample chamber and electrode copiously with water between
          samples.

2.4.10.7  At the end of the day, store the electrode in 3 M KC1.

2.4.11 Calculations

       No calculations are required.

2.4.12 Reporting

       Record the raw data in the pH logbook, and record the final  sample pH
       value on Form 5.  Also record the initial and continuing QC results on
       Form 5.

2.5  Determination of Turbidity

2.5.1  Scope and Application

       This method is applicable to the determination of turbidity in natural
       surface waters and is written specifically for the NSWS.  Turbidity is
       determined in the MPL by using a Monitek Model 21 nephelometer.  As a
       result, the method has been written with the assumption that the Monitek
       nephelometer is used (Monitek, 1977).  The applicable turbidity range is
       0 to 200 NTU.

2.5.2  Summary of Method

       Samples are collected at the stream site in Cubitainers.  At the MPL
       the sample turbidity is measured directly in NTU by using  a calibrated
       nephelometer.

2.5.3  Interferences

       Air bubbles in the sample cuvette interfere with the determination
       and cause a positive bias.

2.5.4  Safety

2.5.4.1   The calibration standards and sample types pose no hazard to the
          analyst.

2.5.5  Apparatus and Equipment

2.5.5.1   Monitek Model 21 nephelometer and sample cuvettes

-------
                                                                Section 2.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 26 of 45
2.5.6  Reagents and Consumable Materials

2.5.6.1   Turbidity Calibration Standard (10 NTU)—Commercially available
          certified turbidity standard.

2.5.6.2   Turbidity Quality Control  Samples (1.7,  5,  20,  50,  100,  and 200
          NTU)—Commercially available certified turbidity standards.

2.5.7  Sample Collection, Preservation, and Storage

       Stream samples are collected  in plastic Cubitainers and are stored at
       4°C until use.

2.5.8  Calibration and Standardization

2.5.8.1   Turn on the nephelometer power and lamp.   Allow to  warm  up for 15  to
          30 minutes.

2.5.8.2   Set the nephelometer range switch to 20.   Zero  the  instrument with
          the zero knob.

2.5.8.3   Place the 10.0-NTU calibration standard  in  the  instrument.   Calibrate
          by setting the  reading to  10.0 with the  calibrate knob.

2.5.9  Quality Control

       QC procedures are  outlined in Figure 2.11 and  are  as follows:

2.5.9.1   Initial Calibration Verification and Linearity  Check—Immediately
          after calibration, analyze the 1.7-, 5.0-,  and  20.0-NTU  QC samples
          to ensure the calibration  validity and linearity.  The measured
          values must be  1.7 ± 0.3,  5.0 ± 0.5, and 20.0 ± 1.0.  If the measured
          values are unacceptable, the calibration must be repeated.   Ensure
          that the instrument is warmed up and that the cuvettes are clean.
          Acceptable results must be obtained prior to  sample analysis.

2.5.9.2   Continuing Calibration Check—After every eight samples  and after  the
          last sample, reanalyze the 5.0-NTU QC sample.  The  measured value  must
          be 5.0 ± 0.5 NTU.   If it is not, recalibrate  the instrument and re-
          analyze all samples analyzed since the last acceptably analyzed QC
          sample.

2.5.9.3   Duplicate Analysis—In order to determine the analytical  precision,
          analyze one sample per batch in duplicate.

2.5.10 Procedure

2.5.10.1  Warm up the nephelometer.

-------
                                                                Section 2.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page 27 of 45
2.5.10.2  Calibrate the nephelometer.

2.5.10.3  Analyze the QC samples.  Proceed with the following sample analysis
          if acceptable results are obtained.

2.5.10.4  Allow the sample Cubitainer to reach room temperature.  Gently swirl
          sample Cubitainers to mix and distribute any particles which may have
          settled out during sample transport.  Care must be taken to avoid
          agitation-induced air bubbles which interfere with the measurement.
          Rinse the nephelometer cuvette with two 5-mL portions of sample, then
          fill (approximately 25 ml sample).  Wipe the cuvette with a Kimwipe,
          insert the cuvette into the nephelometer, and measure the turbidity
          on range 20.  (Note:  Fingerprints, bubbles, smudges, etc., must be
          avoided because they will affect the accuracy of the system.)  The
          turbidity of a sample is not expected to exceed 20 NTU; however, if
          this occurs, the sample must be analyzed on range 200.  In this case,
          a QC sample with a turbidity greater than the sample must be analyzed
          (50, 100, or 200-NTU QC samples are available).  Acceptable results
          for the QC samples are 50 ± 2.5, 100 ± 5, and 200 ± 10, respectively.
          If an acceptable QC value is not obtained, the turbidimeter must be
          recalibrated on range 200 by using a 100-NTU QC standard, and the
          sample must be reanalyzed.  If the sample turbidity exceeds 200 NTU,
          the sample must be diluted 1:10 with filtered sample and must be
          reanalyzed on range 200 as stated above.  The turbidity of the
          original sample is calculated by multiplying the turbidity of the
          dilute sample by the dilution factor.

2.5.10.5  Rinse cuvette thoroughly with water between samples.

2.5.11 Calculations

       No calculations are required.

2.5.12 Reporting

       Record the sample and QC data in the turbidity logbook and on Form 5.
       Report only the QC data for the 5.0-NTU QC sample on Form 5.

2.6  Determination of True Color

2.6.1  Scope and Application

       This method is applicable to the determination of true color in natural
       surface waters and is written specifically for the NSWS.  True color is
       determined in the MPL by using a Hach Color Determination Kit.  As a
       result, the method has been written with the assumption that the Hach
       Color Determination Kit is used.  The applicable color range is 0 to 200
       PCU.

-------
                                                                Section  2.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page  28  of 45
 YES
        Perform initial
        calibration.
           Range:   20
        Cal. Std.:  10 NTU
                T
       Make calibration linearity
       check
       1. Analyze 1.7-NTU QC sample
       2. Analyze 5-NTU QC sample.
       3. Analyze 20-NTU QC sample.
Are measured values
1.7 + 0.3, 5.0 + 0.5,
     20.0 + 1.0?
         Record values in logbook,
         and record value for 5-
         NTU standard on Form 5.
                   V
       Analyze up to 8 samples3
       Record results in logbook,
 Record QC result and
 previous sample
 results on Form 5.
NO
                                         Check  instrument  operation,
                                         standard concentrations,
                                         etc.
                                              Samples  associated with
                                              unacceptable QC
                                              must  be  reanalyzed
                                              when  acceptable
                                              QC  is obtained.
          YES   /    Analyze 5-NTU QC sample.
                     Is measured value 5 + 0.5  NTU?
                                                 NO
      \
aAnalyze one sample per batch in duplicate.

            Figure 2.11.  Flow scheme for turbidity  determinations.

-------
                                                                Section 2.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page 29 of 45
2.6.2  Summary of Method
       Samples are collected at the stream site in Cubitainers.  At the MPL,
       the true color is determined after centrifuging a sample and after
       comparing its color to APHA PCU color standards.
2.6.3  Interferences
       No interferences are known.
2.6.4  Safety
       The sample types pose no hazard to the analyst.
2.6.5  Apparatus and Equipment
2.6.5.1   Hach Model CO-1 Color Determination Kit with sample cuvette.
2.6.6  Reagents and Consumable Materials
2.6.6.1   Water—Water used to rinse cuvettes must conform to ASTM specifica-
          tions for Type I water ASTM D 1193 (ASTM, 1984).  It is obtained from
          the Millipore Milli-Q water system.
2.6.7  Sample Collection, Preservation, and Storage
       Streams samples are collected in plastic Cubitainers and are stored at
       4°C until use.
2.6.8  Calibration and Standardization
       The color kit contains permanent color standards.  No calibration is
       necessary.
2.6.9  Quality Control
       Duplicate Analysis—To determine the analytical precision, analyze one
       sample per batch in duplicate.
2.6.10 Procedure
2.6.10.1  Allow the samples to reach room temperature.
2.6.10.2  Centrifuge a 50-mL sample to remove turbidity.  Rinse a sample cuvette
          with three 5-mL portions of centrifuged sample.   Fill the cuvette
          with sample and cap it.   Determine the color by  using the color kit
          and by following the instructions provided by the manufacturer.

-------
                                                                 Section 2.0
                                                                 Revision 2
                                                                 Date:  11/86
                                                                 Page 30 of 45
2.6.10.3  Rinse the sample cuvette thoroughly with water between samples.

2.6.11 Calculations

       No calculations are necessary.

2.6.12 Reporting

       Record the sample data in the color logbook and on Form 5.

2.7  Determination of Nonexchangeable Pyrocatechol Violet (PCV) Reactive and
     Total PCV Reactive A1uminu₯

2.7.1  Scope and Application

       This method is applicable to the determination of total reactive and
       nonexchangeable reactive aluminum species in natural  surface waters.

       Detection Limits (MDLs) are to be determined.   The method is presently
       in the developmental  stage, and only limited data are available on  its
       application.  A similar manual method was found to have a detection
       limit of 3.0 ug Al/L (Dougan and Wilson, 1974).  Rogeberg and Henriksen,
       1985, reported a minimum detection limit of 10 ug Al/L when use was made
       of an automated segmented flow system similar to the  one in the present
       study.  This MDL is identical to that reported for an automated flow
       injection analyzer.  The method is applicable for determining the various
       Al species over the concentration range 0.01 to 0.80  mg Al/L.

       This method does not distinguish various inorganic monomeric aluminum
       species from each other nor does it distinguish the various neutral
       organic complexes of aluminum from each other.  Furthermore, the defini-
       tions of total monomeric and nonlabile monomeric organic aluminum are
       operationally based upon commonly accepted usage.  Actually, some charged,
       organically complexed aluminum may be measured as inorganic aluminum,
       and some strongly complexed aluminum may not be measured in either
       fraction.

2.7.2  Summary of Method

       Samples are collected in syringes.  The aluminum species in each sample
       are subsequently determined by flow injection analysis (FIA).  Samples
       are loaded into the FIA system manually, directly from the syringe, and
       are then injected.  The sample, carried by a deionized flow stream, is
       mixed with hydroxylammonium/l,10-phenanthroline solution to eliminate
       iron interference.  The sample is next reacted with a pyrocatechol
       violet solution.  The pH of the solution is then adjusted to pH 6.1 with
       buffer.  The Al is subsequently quantitated by measuring the absorbance

-------
                                                                Section 2.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page 31 of 45


       of the PCV-A1 complex at 580 nm.  The Al so measured is termed total PCV
       reactive Al.

       Another portion of sample undergoes the same reaction sequence; how-
       ever, it is first passed through a strong cation-exchange column prior
       to reaction with PCV.  The column removes inorganic monomeric Al.  The
       Al measured after the cation-exchange procedure is termed nonexchange-
       able PCV reactive Al.  Other organic complexes of aluminum are very
       stable and do not react with PCV and are not measured.  This fraction
       is believed to be nontoxic to fish.

2.7.3  Definitions

       Total PCV reactive aluminum (total monomeric aluminum) is defined as the
       fraction of aluminum which reacts with pyrocatechol  violet without
       preliminary acidification.  This includes aluminum in the free ionic
       form and aluminum which is weakly complexed (compared to pyrocatechol
       violet) by inorganic and organic ligands.

       Nonexchangeable PCV reactive aluminum is operationally defined as the
       fraction of total monomeric aluminum which is not removed by cation-
       exchange resins but is reactive with PCV.  This fraction includes weakly
       complexed organo-alunvinum species (organic monomeric aluminum).

       It is theoretically nontoxic and is subtracted from total reactive
       aluminum to estimate the inorganic monomeric aluminum concentration
       which is believed to be toxic to fish.

2.7.4  Interferences

       Holding time and storage methods affect the aluminum speciation in water
       samples.  Samples should be analyzed as soon as possible after collection.
       Samples should be stored at 4°C in the dark during transit.  Changes in
       temperature and pH may drastically alter aluminum speciation.

       Iron (III) interferes with the determination of aluminum when use is made
       of this method.  The interference is eliminated by reducing Fe (III) to
       Fe (II) with hydroxylammonium chloride and subsequently chelating with
       1,10-phenanthroli ne.

2.7.5  Safety

       The calibration standards and most chemical reagents encountered in this
       method pose no hazard to the analyst when good laboratory practices are
       followed.  Protective clothing (safety glasses, gloves, lab coat) should
       be worn when handling concentrated acids and bases.

2.7.6  Apparatus and Equipment

-------
                                                                Section  2.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page  32  of 45


2.7.6.1  Automated Dual  Channel  Flow-Injection Analyze)—A microprocessor-
         controlled system is used for automatic injection of samples, mixing
         of the required chemicals for the pyrocatechol  violet reaction, and
         detection of the aluminum-catechol  complex.

2.7.6.2  Cation-Exchange Column—An Amberlite IR 120  (14 to 50 mesh)  exchange
         resin is used to separate the organic monomeric aluminum from the
         inorganic monomeric aluminum, by using a 100 mm x 3 mm ID Teflon column
         with fritted Teflon inserts containing the resin.

2.7.6.3  Clean-Air Laminar-Flow Hood—

2.7.6.4  Nucleopore/Polyearbonate Filters—

2.7.6.5  Polystyrene Divinyl Benzene Beads (14 to 50  mesh)--

2.7.7  Reagents and Consumable Materials

2.7.7.1  Water—All water used in preparing  reagents  and cleaning labware must
         meet the specifications for Type I  Reagent Water  given in ASTM  D 1193
         (ASTM, 1984).

2.7.7.2  Stock Reagents—

         Ethanol  - 95 percent (Reagent).

         Hydrochloric acid (HC1) - concentrated (Baker Ultrex grade or
         equivalent).

         Sodium Chloride - crystal (ACS reagent grade).

         Ammonium hydroxide (NH4OH) - concentrated (Baker  Instra-Analyzed or
         equivalent).

         Nitric Acid - concentrated (Ultrex  grade or  equivalent).

         0.1 M HC1 - slowly add  8.3 ml concentrated HC1  acid to 500 ml water
         and dilute to 1.00 L mark.

         Cleaning solution (0.1  N HC1 in 10  percent ethanol) - Slowly add 8.3 mL
         concentrated HC1 to 500 ml D.I. water in a 1-L  graduated cylinder.
         Then add 100 mis ethanol and bring  to a final  volume of 1.00 L  with
         D.I. water.  Prepare under fume hood.

         10 percent nitric acid  (1.6 N)  - Slowly add  10  ml concentrated  Ultrex
         nitric acid to  50 ml of water.   Dilute to 100 ml  with water.

         Sodium chloride solution (0.001 M Nad) - Dissolve 0.058 g sodium
         chloride (ACS reagent grade) in water and dilute  to 1.00 L.

-------
                                                                Section 2.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page 33 of 45
2.7.7.3  Working Reagents-

         Reagent Rl (masking solution) - dissolve 7.6 g hydroxylammoniurn
         chloride and 0.56 g 1,10-phenanthroline in 600 ml water and dilute to
         1.000 L.  Degas and store in clean polyethylene bottle.

         Reagent R2 (pyrocatechol  violet solution) - dissolve 0.375 g pyro-
         catechol violet in 400 ml water.  Let solution stand for about 5
         minutes with occasional shaking, then dilute to 1.00 L.   Store in
         acid-washed, water-rinsed polyethylene bottle.  Degas before use.

         Reagent R3 (buffer) - dissolve 78 g hexamethylenetetraamine in 750 ml
         water and dilute to 1 L.   Mix well, degas, and transfer the solution
         to a polyethylene bottle.

         Ion-exchange resin - mix the sodium form of the Amber!ite IR 120 (14
         to 52 mesh) resin with 1 percent of the corresponding hydrogen form.
         Wash the resin twice with water and then with 0.001 M NaCl until the
         supernatant is clear.  Pack column daily with fresh Amberlite  resin.

         NOTE:  Reagents Rl, R2, and R3 must be prepared daily.

2.7.7.4  Aluminum Calibration Standards--

         Stock aluminum calibration solution (1,000 mg Al/L) - Commercially
         available certified standard.

         Dilute stock aluminum calibration solution (10 mg Al/L)  - Add, using
         a volumetric pipet, 10.0 mL of the 1,000 mg Al/L solution to 750 mL
         water containing 1.0 mL 10 percent nitric acid in a 1.0 liter  volumetric
         flask, then dilute to the mark with water.

         Dilute calibration standards - Daily, prepare the calibration  stan-
         dards listed in the table by diluting the appropriate volume of 10.0
         mg Al/L standard solution to 100 mL.  Dispense using volumetric pipets.
               Low Calibration
High Calibration
Standard
Concen-
tration (mg/L)
0.0000
0.0250
0.1000
0.2000
0.3500
mL 10.0
mg Al/L
Required
0.000
0.250
1.000
2.000
3.500
Standard
Concen-
tration (mg/L)
0.3500
0.5000
0.7500
1.0000
mL 10.0
mg Al/L
Required
3.500
5.000
7.500
10.000
         TOTE:  Prepare the blank (0.000 mg Al/L)  by adding tf.OZU ml 10 percent
                nitric acid to 50 mL water in a 100-mL volumetric flask.   Dilute
                to 100 mL with water.

-------
                                                                Section 2.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page 34 of 45
2.7.7.5  Aluminum Quality Control Samples--

         Stock aluminum QC solution (1,000 mg Al/L) - Commercially available
         certified standard from a source independent of the calibration
         standard.

         Dilute QC stock aluminum solution (10 mg Al/L)  - Prepare as in section
         2.7.7.4.

         Detection limit QC sample (0.020 mg Al/L) - Daily, add 0.0200 mL 1,000
         mg Al/L QC solution to 100 mL water then dilute to 1.000 L.

         Routine QC sample (0.0750 mg Al/L) - Daily, add 3.75 mL 10.00 mg Al/L
         QC solution to 100 mL water then dilute to 500.00 mL.

2.7.7.6  Syringe Filters--

         Acid-wash sufficient 25-mm Swin-Lok filter holders with 5 percent
         nitric acid.  Rinse thoroughly with water.

         Using clean Teflon forceps, remove a 25-mm Nucleopore polycarbonate
         filter from the package.  Dip filter into beaker of water to prewet
         the filter.

         Place filter on the filter base.  Place filter  base with filter on
         syringe attachment.  Center o-ring on filter and place filter top on
         o-ring.  Compress o-ring by screwing exit port  onto syringe attachment.

         Attach a syringe containing 5 percent nitric acid onto the Luer-Lok
         fitting.  Inject 1 to 2 mL through the filter unit.  Attach another
         syringe containing water and inject three separate aliquots of 10 to
         15 mL through the filter unit.

         Repeat the above procedure to prepare adequate  filter units for daily
         batch analysis.  Store acid-washed syringe filters in self-sealing
         bags until needed.

2.7.8  Sample Collection, Preservation, and Storage

       Samples are collected in 60-mL syringes with syringe lock valves to
       prevent C02 degassing or adsorption.

       Samples are stored at 4°C in the dark.

2.7.9  Calibration and Standardization

       Channel 1 (Reactive Aluminum)--Analyze the low and high calibration
       standards (including the 0.00 mg/L standard) before each shift.  A

-------
                                                                Section 2.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 35 of 45
       calibration curve is generated by plotting standard response versus
       standard concentration.  Alternatively, the best fit line of response
       versus concentration is calculated (by the data system of the FIA)  by
       linear regression.

       Channel 2 (Nonexchangeable Reactive Aluminum)--Replace the ion-exchange
       column in the FIA system channel  2 with a blank column containing poly-
       styrene divinyl  benzene resin beads (same mesh size as ion-exchange
       resin).  Analyze the low and high standards and generate a calibration
       curve as in the Channel 1 calibration.

2.7.10  Quality Control

        Internal Quality Control —

        MPL Duplicate - analyze one sample per batch  in duplicate.  The RSD for
        duplicate results must be less than or equal  to 10 percent.  If it is
        not, the reason for the poor precision must be found and eliminated
        prior to continuing sample analysis.

        Detection Limit Quality Control  Check Sample  - analyze the detection
        limit QCCS immediately after calibration and  prior to sample analysis.
        The measured concentration must be within 20  percent of the actual
        concentration.   If not, the reason for the poor accuracy must be found
        and eliminated prior to sample analysis.

        Routine Quality Control Check Sample  - analyze the routine QCCS after
        the detection limit QCCS, after every fifth sample, and after the  final
        sample.  The observed concentration should be within 10 percent of the
        actual concentration.  If this is not the case, the reason for the poor
        accuracy must be found and eliminated before  continuing sample analysis.
        If necessary, the FIA must be recalibrated.  All  samples analyzed  since
        the last acceptable QCCS must be reanalyzed.

2.7.11  Procedure

2.7.11.1  System Preparation—Set up both channels of the FIA system as
          illustrated in Figures 2.12 and 2.13.  Program the computer according
          to instructions provided by the manufacturer.

2.7.11.2  Fill unused syringes with the calibration standards and QC samples.

2.7.11.3  Sample Analysis--

          Standard and QC sample analysis (channel 1  - Reactive Al) - manually
          load the sample injection loop and  then inject to start the FIA
          analysis.

-------
                                                                         Section 2.0
                                                                         Revision 2
                                                                         Date:   11/86
                                                                         Page  36 of  45
 C.
R1.
R2.
R3.
          ml/min  SA^PLE
             1.8
  0.8
   0.8
   1.0
RC1    RC2     RC3
                                     pH6.1
                                     (waste)
     Key:
CarrierDaionixed water (or 0.1 M HCI)
R1 • Masking solution : Hydroxylammonium chloride
   and 1.10 Phenanthroline chloride
R2 • Color reagent: Pyrocatecholviolet
R3 • Buffer solution : Hexamethylenetetramine and NaOH
RC1 • Reaction coil, 10 cm (0.6 mm i.d.)
RC2 • Reaction coil. 30 cm (0.5 mm i.d.)
RC3 • Reaction coil. 60 cm (0.5 mm i.d.)
        Figure 2.12.   Channel  one schematic for  total  PCV reactive Al.

-------
   C.
  R1.
  R2.
  R3.
          Sample-
            ml/min
              1.8
0.8
0.8
1.0
                                                                      Section  2.0
                                                                      Revision  2
                                                                      Date:  11/86
                                                                      Page 37  of 45
                    >Waste
                             CEC
RC1     RC2    RC3
                                     pH6.1
                                    (waste)
            Carrier: Deionized water (or 0.1 M HCI)
            R1 • Masking solution : Hydroxylammonium chloride
               and 1.10 Phenanthroline chloride
            R2 • Color reagent: Pyrocatecholviolet
            R3 • Buffer solution : Hexamethylenetetramine and NaOH
            RC1 • Reaction coil, 10 cm (0.6 mm i.d.)
            RC2 • Reaction coil. 30 cm (0.5 mm i.d.)
            RC3 - Reaction coil. 60 em (0.6 mm i.d.)
            CEC • Cation exchange column
Figure 2.13.   Channel  two schematic  for nonexchangeable PCV  reactive Al.

-------
                                                                Section 2.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page 38 of 45
          Standard and QC sample analysis (channel 2 - Nonexchangeable Al) -
          manually load the sample injection loop, then inject to start the FIA
          analysis.

          Routine sample analysis - place a 0.4-um polycarbonate syringe filter
          on the sample syringe.  Eject 5.0 ml sample through the filter into a
          waste container.  Next, load the sample injection loop with filtered
          sample and inject to start the FIA analysis.

2.7.11.4  Analyze the routine QC sample every five samples and after the last
          sample.  Results must be within the specifications listed in section
          2.7.10.

2.7.11.5  If a sample concentration exceeds the calibrated range, inject a
          smaller sample volume (consult the operating manual for details on
          techniques to reduce sample volume).

2.7.11.6  Replace the ion-exchange cartridge after every 50 samples injected.

2.7.11.7  After a day's analysis, flush the FIA system with water for 5
          minutes and then flush with air for 2 minutes.

2.7.12  Calculations

        Calculate concentration by comparing the peak heights with the calibra-
        tion curve.  Report results as ug Al/L for both species of aluminum.

2.7.13  Precision and Accuracy

        For surface water samples containing 10 to 350 ug Al/L, the average
        standard deviation was ±3.1 ug Al/L.

        Accuracy (recovery) was reported by Rogeberg and Henriksen, 1985, for
        surface waters spiked with 150 and 580 ug Al/L.  The recovery was found
        to be to be 99 percent and 105 percent, respectively.

2.8  Aliquot Preparation

2.8.1  Summary

       Stream samples are collected in 4-L Cubitainers.  From each sample, the
       aliquots are prepared.  Each aliquot is processed in a different manner
       according to which analytes will be determined in the aliquot.

       A brief description of the aliquots is given in Table 2.3.

-------
                                                                Section 2.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 39 of 45
                        TABLE 2.3.  ALIQUOT DESCRIPTIONS

Aliquot
1
2
3
4
5
6a
7
8»
Container Description
250 mL
(acid-washed)
10 mL
(acid-washed)
250 mL
(not acid-washed)
125 mL
(acid-washed)
500 mL
(not acid-washed)
125 mL
(acid-washed)
125 mL
(acid-washed)
10 mL
Description
Filtered sample acidified with HN03 to
a pH <2
MIBK-Hydroxyquinoline extract
Filtered sample
Filtered sample acidified with ^$04
to a pH <2
Raw unfiltered sample
Filtered sample acidified with HoSO,
to a pH <2
Unfiltered sample acidified with HN03
to a pH <2
MIBK-Hydroxyquinoline extract

aUnfiltered for Pilot study.
bFor Streams Pilot only.  See 2.8.5.5.

-------
                                                                Section  2.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page  40  of 45
2.8.2  Safety
       The sample types and most reagents used in preparing aliquots  pose
       little hazard to the analyst.   Protective clothing  (lab  coat and  gloves)
       and safety glasses must be used when handling concentrated  sulfuric,
       nitric, hydrochloric, and glacial  acetic acids and  concentrated ammonium
       hydroxide.  The use of hydrochloric and acetic acids and of ammonium
       hydroxide should be restricted to  the hood.

       MIBK is a highly flammable organic solvent and must be kept away  from
       ignition sources.  Also, MIBK  vapor is irritating to the eyes, nose,  and
       throat.  Exposure to the vapor may cause temporary  irritation.

       Liquid MIBK is also an irritant.  If spilled  on skin or  in  eyes,  wash
       affected area thoroughly with  water until irritation stops.  The  use  of
       MIBK should be restricted to the hood.  If it must  be used  outside  of
       the hood, organic vapor masks  should be worn.

2.8.3  Apparatus and Equipment

       Filtration Apparatus—Includes filter holder, vacuum chamber,  and vacuum
       pumps.

2.8.4  Reagents and Consumable Materials

2.8.4.1   Ammonium Hydroxide (1 M)—Carefully add 20 ml concentrated  ammonium
          hydroxide (NH4OH, 5 M, Baker Instra-Analyzed grade or equivalent)  to
          80 ml water.

2.8.4.2   Glacial Acetic Acid—Baker  Instra-Analyzed grade or equivalent.

2.8.4.3   8-hydroxyquinoline Solution (10 g/L)--Dissolve 5 g 8-hydroxyquinoline
          (99 percent plus purity)  in 12.5 ml glacial  acetic acid  (HOAc, Baker
          Instra-Analyzed grade or  equivalent), then dilute to  500 ml with
          water.

2.8.4.4   8-hydroxyquinoline/Sodium Acetate Reagent  (HOx Reagent)—Prepare
          daily by mixing in order, 30 ml 1.0 M NaOAc, 150 ml water,  and 30  mL
          8-hydroxyquinoline solution.

2.8.4.5   Buffer Solution (pH 8.3)—Carefully add 56 mL glacial  acetic acid
          (Baker Instra-Analyzed grade or equivalent)  to 75 mL  NH4OH  (5  M,
          Baker Instra-Analyzed grade or  equivalent).   Dilute to 250  mL  with
          water.  Adjust the pH to  8.3 with NH4OH or HOAc  (whichever  is  neces-
          sary, testing the pH with indicating pH paper).   Add  an  additional 16
          mL NH4OH, then dilute to  500 mL with water.

2.8.4.6   Nitric Acid (HN03, 12 M,  Baker  Ultrex grade or equivalent).

-------
                                                                Section  2.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page 41  of 45
2.8.4.7   Phenol Red Indicator Solution (4 percent w/v).
2.8.4.8   Sodium Acetate (NaOAc, 1.0 M)—Dissolve 8.20 g sodium acetate  (Alfa
          ultrapure grade or equivalent)  in water, then dilute to 100 ml.

2.8.4.9   Sulfuric Acid (^$04, 18 M, Baker Ultrex grade or equivalent).

2.8.4.10  Water—Water used in all preparations must conform to ASTM specifica-
          tions for Type I water ASTM D 1193 (ASTM, 1984).   It is obtained  from
          the Mi Hi pore Milli-Q water system.

2.8.4.11  Aliquot Bottles—Clean aliquot  bottles are required for the aliquots
          prepared from each sample.  The bottles are cleaned (by using  the
          procedure in Appendix A) and are supplied by an outside contractor.

2.8.4.12  Indicating pH Paper (Range 8 to 9 and 1 to 3)

2.8.4.13  Membrane Filters (0.45-nm pore  size)

2.8.5  Procedure

       Preparation of the aliquots is described in this section.   All  filtra-
       tions and aliquot 2 preparation are performed in the laminar-flow clean
       work station.

2.8.5.1   Preparation of Aliquots 1, 4, and 6  (Unfiltered for Pilot Study)

          Complete aliquot labels for aliquots  1, 4, and 6 and attach to
          containers.  Assemble the filtration  apparatus with a waste container
          as a collection vessel.  Thoroughly  rinse the filter holder and
          membrane filter in succession with 20 to 40 ml water, 20 ml 5  percent
          HN03 (Baker Instra-Analyzed grade),  and 40 to 50 ml water.

          Rinse the filter holder and membrane  with 10 to 15 mL of the sample
          to be filtered.

          Replace the waste container with the  aliquot 1 container.   Reapply
          vacuum (vacuum pressure must not exceed 12 in. Hg), and filter 10 to
          15 mL of sample.  Remove the vacuum.   Rinse the aliquot 1 container
          with the 15 ml of filtered sample by  slowly rotating the bottle so
          that the sample touches all surfaces.  Discard the rinse sample and
          replace the container under the filter holder.

          Filter sample into the container until  full.

          Transfer filtered sample into the aliquot 4 and 6 containers (pre-
          viously labeled) after first rinsing  the containers with 10 to 15 mL
          filtered sample.

-------
                                                                Section 2.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page 42 of 45


          Return the aliquot 1 container to the filtration apparatus and
          collect additional filtered sample until  the container is full.

          If it is necessary to replace a membrane  (because of clogging) before
          adequate filtered sample has been obtained, rinse the new membrane
          with 15 to 20 ml water, 10 to 15 ml 5 percent HN03, 40 to 50 mL
          water, and 10 to 15 ml sample prior to collecting additional sample.

          Between samples, remove the membrane and  thoroughly rinse the filter
          holder with water.

          Preserve by adding concentrated HN03 to aliquot 1 and concentrated
          H2S04 to aliquots 4 and 6 in 0.100-mL increments until the pH <2
          (U.S. EPA, 1983).  Check the pH by placing a drop of sample on
          indicating pH paper, using a clean plastic pi pet tip.  Record on the
          aliquot label the volume of acid added.

          Store aliquots 1, 4, and 6 at 4°C until ready to ship.

2.8.5.2   Preparation of Aliquot 2 - Total Extractable Aluminum

          Obtain a filtered portion of sample from  the analyst performing
          filtrations.

          Rinse a clean, plastic 50-mL graduated centrifuge tube with three
          10-mL portions of the filtered sample, then fill to the 25.0-mL  mark.

          Add two to three drops phenol red indicator, 5.0 ml HOx reagent, and
          2.0 ml NH4+/NH3 buffer.  Shake for 5 seconds.  This should adjust the
          pH to 8.3, and the solution should turn red.  If it does not turn red,
          rapidly adjust the pH by dropwise addition of 1 M NfyOH until the
          solution color changes to red.  Add 10.0  ml MIBK, cap, and shake
          vigorously for 10 seconds by using a rapid, end-to-end motion.  (Note:
          Successful extraction depends on good agitation.)  This entire process
          should take about 15 to 20 seconds.  Open tube carefully after shaking
          because pressure builds up.

          Centrifuge the sample to hasten separation of the aqueous and organic
          layers, then  transfer the MIBK layer with a 5-mL micropipet to a
          10-mL centrifuge tube.  Securely cap tube.

          Complete a label for aliquot 2 and attach label to the container.

          Store the 10-mL tube containing aliquot 2 at 4°C in the dark until
          ready to ship.

          Discard the 50-mL centrifuge tube after a single use.

-------
                                                                Section 2.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 43 of 45


2.8.5.3   Preparation of Aliquot 3—Filtered sample for aliquot 3 is obtained
          similarly to that for aliquots 1, 4, and 6, except that the filter
          holder used to filter aliquot 3 is never allowed to come into contact
          with nitric acid.  This is CRUCIAL in preventing nitrate contamina-
          tion.  Previous experience indicates that even the most scrupulous
          water rinses did not remove all traces of a nitric acid rinse.
          Blanks still contained measurable nitrate.

          Soak filter holders for 24 hours in deionized water prior to first
          use.

          Complete an aliquot 3 label and attach label to the aliquot bottle.

          Assemble the filtration apparatus with a waste container as a
          collection vessel.  Thoroughly rinse the filter holder and membrane
          filter with three 25-mL portions water, followed by 10 to 15 ml
          sample to be filtered.

          Replace the waste container with the aliquot 3 container and filter
          an additional 15 ml sample.  Remove the container and rinse by slowly
          rotating the bottle so that the sample touches all surfaces.  Discard
          the rinse sample and replace the container under the filter holder.

          Filter sample into the container until full.

          If it is necessary to replace a membrane (because of clogging), rinse
          the membrane with three 20-mL portions water followed by 15 ml sample
          before collecting additional sample.

          Store at 4°C until ready to ship.

          Between samples, remove the membrane and thoroughly rinse the filter
          holder with water.

2.8.5.4   Preparation of Aliquots 5 and 7—Aliquots 5 and 7 are unfiltered
          aliquots.

          Complete aliquot 5 and 7 labels and attach to the appropriate aliquot
          bottles.  Transfer 15 to 20 ml sample to aliquot bottle and rinse by
          slowly rotating bottle so that sample touches all surfaces.   Discard
          rinse.

          Fill aliquot bottle with unfiltered sample.  Fill aliquot 5 bottle so
          that no headspace exists.

          Preserve by adding concentrated HN03 to aliquot 7 in 0.100-mL incre-
          ments until  pH <2 (U.S. EPA, 1983).  Check the pH by placing a drop
          of sample on indicating pH paper, using a clean plastic pi pet tip.

-------
                                                                Section  2.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page  44  of  45


          Record the volume of acid added on the aliquot label.

          Store at 4°C until  ready to ship.

2.8.5.5   Aliquot 8 Preparation (Extractable Organic Aluminum)  Stream Pilot
          Only-

          Aliquot 8 is prepared as soon as possible.  Furthermore,  it is only
          prepared for samples with an initial  pH <6 (as determined from field
          data).  As with Aliquot 2, Aliquot 8  must be prepared  in  the laminar-
          flow hood.

          Prepare the resin column by pouring the resin slurry  into a  column
          until there is a 10-mL resin bed.   Top up the column  with 3  x  10~4 M
          Nad and connect the column to the peristaltic pump.

          Pump 3 x 10~4 M Nad through the column and adjust the flow  rate  to
          40.0 mL/min.  Flush the column with 50 mL of the eluent.  Check the
          eluent pH.  It must be 5.0 ± 0.5.   If not, reprepare  the  resin slurry
          and column.

          Pump 50 ml of sample through the column,  collecting the column
          effluent in a waste container.  Pump  an additional  25  to  30  ml sample
          through the column, collecting the effluent in a clean 50-mL centri-
          fuge tube.

          Adjust the volume in the tube to 25.0 ml.  Extract the 25.0  ml by using
          the same procedure  as for Aliquot 2.   Attach an Aliquot 8 label,
          recording the necessary information.   Store at 4°C until  ready to
          ship.

          Flush the column with 50 ml of eluent.  Check the effluent  pH. It
          must be 5.0 ± 0.5.   If not, reprepare the column before processing
          another sample.

          NOTE:  Keep resin covered with liquid.  Avoid the introduction of air
                 into the column.

2.9  References

     American Society for Testing and Materials, 1984.  Annual  Book of ASTM
          Standards, Vol. 11.01, Standard Specification for Reagent Water,  D
          1193-77 (reapproved 1983).  ASTM,  Philadelphia, Pennsylvania.

     Dougan, W. K., and A. L. Wilson, 1974.   The Absorptiometric Determination
          of Aluminum in Water:  A Comparison of Some Chromagenic Reagents  and
          the Development of  an Improved Method.  Analyst, v. 99, pp.  413-430.

-------
                                                           Section 2.0
                                                           Revision 2
                                                           Date:  11/86
                                                           Page 45 of 45
Hagley, C. A., C. M. Knapp, C. L. Mayer, and F.  A.  Morris, 1986.   The
     National Surface Water Survey Stream Survey (Pilot Middle-Atlantic
     Phase I, Southeast Screening, and Middle-Atlantic Episode Pilot)
     Field Training and Operations Manual.

Monitek, Inc., 1977.  Model 21 Laboratory Nephelometer, Preliminary
     Operating and Maintenance Instructions.  Hayward, California.

Orion Research Incorporated, 1983.  Instruction  Manual - Model 611  pH/
     mi Hi-volt manual.  Orion, Cambridge, Massachusetts.

Rogeberg, E. J. S., and A. Henriksen, 1985.  An  Automatic Method  for
     Fractionation and Determination of Aluminum Species in Fresh-Waters,
     Vatten, v. 41, pp. 48-53.

U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, 1983 (revised).   Methods for
     Chemical Analysis of Water and Wastes.  EPA-600/4-79-020.  U.S. EPA,
     Cincinnati, Ohio.

Xertex-Dohrman Corporation, 1984.  DC-80 Automated  Laboratory Total
     Organic Carbon Analyzer Systems Manual, 6th ed.   Xertex-Dohrman,
     Santa Clara, California.

-------
                                                                Section 3.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 1 of 17
3.0  ANALYTICAL LABORATORY OPERATIONS

3.1  Summary of Operations

     Samples are shipped from the MPL to the contract analytical  laboratories
     for analysis.  Each sample consists of seven (eight for Stream Pilot)
     aliquots, each processed in a different manner depending on  the analytes
     for which the aliquot will be analyzed.  A brief description of each
     aliquot and of corresponding analytes are given in Table 3.1.

     After receipt, the analytes in each sample are quantified.   The analyses
     must occur within the prescribed holding times (Table 3.2) or a penalty is
     assessed against the lab.  Strict QC requirements must be followed through-
     out the analyses.  Finally, the sample results must be reported in the
     proper format, on a timely basis, for entry in the NSWS data base.

3.2  Sample Receipt and Handling

     Samples are shipped to the contract laboratory by overnight  delivery
     service.  Upon receipt, measure the temperature inside the  shipping con-
     tainer and record the temperature on the shipping form.  Log in samples
     and ensure that the samples listed on the shipping form have actually  been
     received.  Note anything unusual (such as leaking samples) on the shipping
     form.

     Store sample aliquots 2, 3, 4, 5, and 6 in the dark at 4°C  when not in
     use.  The samples must be stored at 4°C for 6 months or until notified by
     the QA manager.

     Clean all labware that comes into contact with the sample (such as
     autosampler vials, beakers, etc.) as described in Appendix  A.

3.3  Sample Analysis

     The analytes to be determined in each sample and corresponding measurement
     techniques are listed in Table 3.3, and the method protocols are provided
     in sections 4 through 13.  Each analyte must be determined within the
     holding times listed in Table 3.2.

3.4  Internal  Quality Control Requirements

     QC is an integral part of sample analysis.  Method QC requirements common
     to all methods are detailed in this section.  QC requirements specific to
     a single method are detailed in the description for that method.

-------
                                                                Section 3.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 2 of 17
             TABLE 3.1.   LIST OF ALIQUOTS, CONTAINERS, PRESERVATIVES,
                    AND CORRESPONDING PARAMETERS TO BE MEASURED

 Aliquot3  Container
Preservative and
  Description
Parameters
    1       250 mL   Filtered, pH <2 with HN03

    2        10 mL   MIBK-HQ extract

    3       250 mL   Filtered

    4       125 mL   Filtered, pH <2 with H2S04

    5       500 mL   Unfiltered


    6b      125 mL   Filtered, pH <2 with H2S04

    7       125 mL   Unfiltered, pH <2 with HN03

    8C       10 mL   MIBK-HQ extract
                         Ca, Mg, K, Na,  Mn,  Fe

                         Total  extractable Al

                         Cl, F, $04, N03,  Si02

                         DOC, NH4

                         pH, BNC, ANC,  specific
                           conductance,  DIC

                         Total  dissolved P

                         Total  Al

                         Extractable organic Al (ion
                           exchanged)
aAliquots 2, 3, 4, 5, and 6 must be stored at 4°C in the dark.
bUnfiltered for Pilot Study.
cAliquot 8 is used for the Pilot Study only.

-------
                                                                Section 3.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 3 of 17
                       TABLE 3.2.   LIST OF HOLDING TIMES
 Maximum
 Holding
  Time                                  Parameter
7 days                     N03,a pHb, Total  extractable Al

14 days                    ANC, BNC, specific conductance,  DIG,  DOC

28 days                    Total P, NH4> Cl, S04, F,  Si02

6 months0                  Ca, Mg, K, Na, total  Al,  Mn, Fe


aAlthough the EPA (U.S. EPA, 1983) recommends that nitrate  in unpreserved
 samples (un-acidified) be determined within 48  hours of collection,  evidence
 exists (Peden, 1981 and APHA et al.. 1985)  that nitrate is stable for  2 to  4
 weeks if stored in the dark at 4°C.
b Although the EPA (U.S. EPA, 1983) recommends that pH be measured immediately
 after sample collection,  evidence exists (McQuaker  et al., 1983)  that  it  is
 stable for up to 15 days  if stored at 4°C and sealed from  the atmosphere.
 The pH is also measured in a sealed sample at the field station within 12
 hours of sample collection.
CA1though the EPA (U.S. EPA, 1983) recommends a  maximum 6-month  holding time
 for these metals, this study requires that all  of the metals be determined
 within 28 days.  This is  to ensure that significant changes do  not occur  and
 to obtain data in a timely manner.

-------
                                                                Section 3.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page  4 of 17
     TABLE 3.3.   LIST OF PARAMETERS AND CORRESPONDING MEASUREMENT METHODS

          Parameter
                                                   Method
1.  BNC
2.  ANC
3.  Aluminum,
4.  Aluminum,
          total
          total
    extractable
5.  Aluminum, Nonexchangeable and
      Total PCV Reactive
6.  Ammonium, dissolved
7.  Calcium, dissolved
8.  Chloride, dissolved
9.  Fluoride, total dissolved
10. Inorganic carbon, dissolved

11. Iron, dissolved
12. Magnesium, dissolved
13. Manganese, dissolved
14. Nitrate, dissolved
15. Organic carbon, dissolved
16.
17.
PH
Phosphorus,
total dissolved
18. Potassium, dissolved
19. Silica, dissolved

20. Sodium, dissolved
21. Sulfate, dissolved
22. Specific conductance
Titration with Gran analysis
Titration with Gran analysis
202.2 AAS (furnace)
Extraction with 8-hydroxyquinoline
  into MIBK followed by AAS (furnace)
Automated Colorimetric Pyrocatechol
  Violet (PVC)
Automated colorimetry (phenate)
AAS (flame) or ICPES
Ion chromatography
Ion-selective electrode and meter
Instrument (acidification, C02
  generation, IR detection)
AAS (flame) or ICPES
AAS (flame) or ICPES
AAS (flame) or ICPES
Ion chromatography
Instrument (uv-promoted oxidation,
  C02 generation, IR detection)
pH electrode and meter
Automated colorimetry
  (molybdate blue)
AAS (flame)
Automated colorimetry
  (molybdate blue)
AAS (flame)
Ion chromatography
Conductivity cell and meter


-------
                                                                Section 3.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 5  of 17
3.4.1     Method Quality Control
          Each method contains specific QC steps which must be performed to
          ensure data quality.  Table 3.4 is a brief summary of the required
          QC checks as well as control limits and corrective actions for QC
          checks outside control  limits.  QC steps common to all  (or most) of
          the methods are detailed in sections 3.4.1.1 through 3.4.1.5,  while
          QC steps specific to a single method are detailed in the method
          protocol.

3.4.1.1   Calibration Verification QC Check Sample—After performing the cali-
          bration step for a method,  verify the calibration (to ensure proper
          standard preparation, etc.) prior to sample analysis by analyzing a
          calibration QC check sample (QCCS).  The QCCS is a known sample
          containing the analyte of interest at a concentration in the low- to
          mid-calibration range.   Furthermore, the QCCS must be independent of
          the calibration standards.

          For each batch of samples,  analyze the calibration QCCS immediately
          after calibration, after every 10 sample analyses, and after the
          final sample analysis.   Plot the measured analyte concentration in
          the QCCS on a control chart and develop the 95 percent and 99  percent
          confidence intervals.  The  99 percent confidence interval  must be
          within the limits given in  Table 3.5.  (The limits in Table 3.5 may
          be used as initial limits until enough data are obtained to generate
          a control  chart.)  If the 99 percent confidence interval  is not with-
          in those limits, a problem  exists with the experimental technique or
          the QCCS itself.

          The measured analyte concentration in the QCCS must be within  the 99
          percent confidence interval.  An acceptable result must be obtained
          prior to continuing sample  determinations.  If unacceptable results
          are obtained, repeat the calibration step and reanalyze all samples
          analyzed since the last acceptably analyzed QCCS.

3.4.1.2   Detection  Limit Determination and Verification—Determine the
          detection  limit weekly for  all parameters (except pH and specific
          conductance for which the term detection limit does not apply). For
          the NSWS,  the detection limit is defined as three times the standard
          deviation  of 10 nonconsecutive reagent or calibration blank analyses.
          In the case where a signal  is not obtained for a blank analysis (such
          as in ion  chromatographic analyses or autoanalyzer analyses),  a low-
          concentration standard (concentration about three to four times the
          detection  limit) is analyzed rather than a blank.  Detection limits
          must not exceed the values  listed in Table 1.1.  If a detection limit
          is not met, refine the analytical technique and optimize any instru-
          mentation  variables until the detection limit is achieved.

-------
                                                                                            Section  3.0

                                                                                            Revision  2

                                                                                            Date:    11/86

                                                                                            Page  6  of 17




          TABLE 3.4.   SUMMARY  OF  INTERNAL  METHOD QUALITY CONTROL CHECKS


••••••••••••••••••*•••••••••••••••••••••••*••••••••••••••••••••••••••*•••••••••••••••••••••••••••*••••••••••••••••••••••
Parameter or Method              QC Check                        Control  Units                Corrective Action*


BMC. ANC, pH         1.  Tltrtnt standardization cross-    1.  Relative difference 60S.           6.   Clean or replace separator
                                                                       ~                  column.  Recalibrate.
•Assuming QC check  is outside control  limits.

-------
                                                         Section 3.0
                                                         Revision 2
                                                         Date:  11/86
                                                         Page 7 of 17
  TABLE 3.5.  MAXIMUM CONTROL LIMITS FOR QUALITY CONTROL SAMPLES

                   Maximum Control Limit for QC Sample (% Deviation from
Parameter                 Theoretical Concentration of QC Sample)


Al, total extractable                      ±20%

Al, total                                  ±20?

Ca                                         ±5?

Cl                                         ±5%

DIC                                        ±10%

DOC                                        ±10%

F, total dissolved                         ±5%

Fe                                         ±10%

K                                          ±5%

Mg                                         ±5%

Mn                                         ±10%

Na                                         ±5%

NH4                                        ±10%

N03                                        ±10%

P, total dissolved                         ±20%

Si02                                       ±5%

$04                                        ±5%

Specific conductance                       ±2%

-------
                                                                Section  3.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page 8 of 17
          To verify the detection limit for the determination  of  metals  and
          total dissolved P daily, analyze a detection limit QCCS after  cali-
          bration and prior to sample analysis.  The  detection limit QCCS  must
          contain the analyte of interest at two to three times the  detection
          limit.  The measured concentration must be  within  20 percent of  the
          true concentration.  If it is not, the detection limit  is  question-
          able.

3.4.1.3   Blank Analysis—Once per batch analyze a calibration blank as  a
          sample.  The calibration blank is defined as a  "0" mg/L standard
          (contains only the matrix of the calibration standards).   The  measured
          concentration of the calibration blank must be  less  than twice the
          instrumental detection limit.  If not, the  blank is  contaminated, or
          the calibration is in error at the low end.   Prior to sample analysis,
          investigate and eliminate any contamination source and  repeat  the
          calibration.

          Prepare and analyze a reagent blank for the three  methods  which
          require sample preparation (dissolved Si Op,  total  dissolved P, and
          total Al).  A reagent blank contains all  the reagents (in  the  same
          quantities) used in preparing a real sample for analysis.   Process in
          the same manner (digestions, etc.) as a real  sample. The  measured
          concentration of the reagent blank must be  less than twice the
          required detection limit (Table 1.1).  If it is not, the reagent
          blank is contaminated.  Investigate and eliminate  the contamination
          source.  Prepare and analyze a new reagent  blank and apply the same
          criteria.  Reanalyze all samples associated with the contaminated
          blank when the contamination is eliminated.   Contact the QA manager
          if a contaminated reagent blank problem cannot  be  rectified.

          Prepare one reagent blank with each set of  samples processed at  one
          time.  For example, if two sample batches are processed together,
          only one reagent blank is necessary.  Report the concentration of the
          single reagent blank for both batches.  On  the  other hand, if  a
          sample batch is split into groups that are  processed at different
          times, a reagent blank is necessary for each group.   In this case,
          report all reagent blank values for the batch.   (Identify  in a cover
          letter which reagent blank values are associated with which samples.)

3.4.1.4   Duplicate Sample Analysis—Prepare and analyze  one sample  per  batch
          in duplicate.  If possible, for duplicate analysis choose  a sample
          containing analyte at a concentration greater than five times  the
          detection limit.  Calculate the relative standard  deviation (RSD)
          between duplicates.  The duplicate precision (RSD) must not exceed
          the value given in Table 1.1.  If duplicate RSD values  fall outside
          the values given in Table 1.1, a problem exists (such as instrument
          malfunction, calibration drift, etc.).  After finding and  resolving

-------
                                                                Section 3.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 9 of 17
          the problem, analyze a second sample in duplicate.  Acceptable dupli-
          cate sample results must be obtained prior to continuing sample
          analysis.
                                        S
                             ZRSD  =   —  x  100
                                        x
                                           - x)2\l/2
                               S  =
                                          n-1


3.4.1.5   Matrix Spike Analysis (Stream Pilot only)--Prepare one matrix spike
          with each batch by spiking a portion of a sample with a known
          quantity of analyte.   The spike concentration must be the larger of
          two times the endogenous level  or ten times the required detection
          limit.  Also, the volume of the spike added must be negligible (less
          than or equal to 0.001 of the sample aliquot volume).  Calculate the
          percent recovery of the spike as follows:

                                    (measured           measured  \
                                  :oncentration      concentration]
                                   of sample      "   of unspiked I
                                   plus spike           sample    /
                                	 X 100
                                (actual concentration of spike added)

          The spike recovery must be 100 ± 15 percent.  If the recovery is not
          acceptable, spike and analyze two additional, different samples.  If
          either recovery is unacceptable, analyze the entire batch by the
          method of standard additions.  The method of standard addition
          involves analyzing the sample,  sample plus a spike at about the
          endogenous level, and sample plus a spike at about twice the endo-
          genous level.

       NOTE:  Matrix spikes for graphite furnace atomic absorption spectroscopy
              (GFAA) analyses may not be added directly in the furnace.

              The concentration of the matrix spike must not exceed the instru-
              ment linear dynamic range.   For this reason, the matrix spike
              concentration for furnace analyses must be chosen judiciously and
              may be different than suggested above.

-------
                                                                Section 3.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 10 of 17


              Similarly, care must be taken to avoid exceeding the linear range
              when performing standard additions for GFAA analyses.   The
              samples may be diluted, and the spike levels may be adjusted so
              that the linear range is not exceeded.

3.4.2     Overall Internal Quality Control

          Once each parameter in a sample has been determined, two procedures
          exist for checking the correctness of analyses.  These procedures are
          outlined in sections 3.4.2.1 and 3.4.2.2.

3.4.2.1   Anion-Cation Balance—Theoretically, the acid neutralizing capacity
          (ANC) of a sample equals the difference between the concentration
          (eq/L) of cations and the anions in a sample (Kramer,  1982).   In
          practice, this is rarely true because of analytical variability and
          because of ions that are present but not measured.   For each  sample,
          calculate the percent ion difference UID) as follows:


                                      ANC + Z anions - I cations
                 % Ion Difference  =  -  x  100
                                                  TI

          TI (Total ion strength)  =  Z anions + Z cations +  ANC + 2 [H+]

                         Z anions  =  [Cl"] + [F~] + [N03~] + [S042~]

                        Z cations  =  [Na"1"] + [K+] + [Ca2+] + [Mg2+] +  [NH4+]

                              ANC  =  [ALK]

                             [H+]  =  (10~PH) x 106 ueq/L

          All  concentrations are expressed as microequivalents/liter (ueq/L).
          Table 3.6 lists factors for converting mg/L to ueq/L for each of the
          parameters.
          The %ID must not exceed the limits given in Table 3.7.   An  unaccept-
          able value for %ID indicates the presence of unmeasured ions or an
          analytical error in the sample analysis.  For the surface waters
          sampled, the ions included in the %ID calculation are expected to
          account for 90 to 100 percent of the ions in a sample.   Note that  the
          ANC term in the calculation accounts for protolyte ions that are not
          specifically determined (such as organic acids and bases).

          Examine the data from samples that do not meet the %l\) criteria for
          possible causes of unacceptable %ID.  Often, the cause is improper
          data reporting (misplaced decimal point, incorrect data reduction,

-------
                                                                Section  3.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page  11  of 17
                      TABLE 3.6  FACTORS TO CONVERT mg/L TO ueq/L
                     SS«SSStZ«««««~~~~~« — ~2£2'S2SS»!Z«SSZISS3S«««»«S ——
                                                Factor
                           Ion             (ueq/L per mg/L)
Ca2+
cr
F-
K+
Mg2+
Na+
NH4+
N03"
S042'
49.9
28.2
52.6
25.6
82.3
43.5
55.4
16.1
20.8
          switched sample ID'S, etc.).   After examining the  data,  redetermine
          any parameter that is suspect.   If an explanation  for the poor IID
          cannot be found and if the problem cannot be corrected,  contact the  QA
          manager at EMSL-Las Vegas for further guidance.

3.4.2.2   Conductivity Balance—Estimate the specific conductance  of a sample
          by summing the equivalent conductances for each  measured ion.   Calcu-
          late the equivalent conductance for each ion by  multiplying the ion
          concentration by the appropriate factor in Table 3.8.  Calculate the
          percent conductance difference (%CD) as follows:


                                       calculated cond. -  measured cond.
          % Conductance Difference  =  	 x 100
                                              measured conductance
          The ZCD must not exceed the limits listed in Table 3.7.   As with  the
          ZID calculation, an unacceptable value for %CD indicates either the
          presence of unmeasured ions or an analytical  error in the sample
          analysis.  For the surface waters sampled, the ions included in the

-------
                                                         Section 3.0
                                                         Revision 2
                                                         Date:  11/86
                                                         Page 12 of 17
               TABLE 3.7.  CHEMICAL REANALYSIS CRITERIA


A.  Anion-Cation Balance

                                                        Maximum
     Total Ion Strength (ueq/L)                    % Ion Differencea

                 <50                                      60
              ^50<100                                     30
                 _>100                                     15


B.  Specific Conductance

                                                    Maximum
    Measured Conductance (uS/cm)         -   % Conductance Difference5

                 <5                                    50
               >5<30                                   30
                 >30                                   20
alf the absolute value of the percent difference exceeds these values,
 the sample is reanalyzed.  When reanalysis is indicated, the data for
 each parameter are examined for possible analytical error.  Any suspect
 results are then redetertnined, and the above percent differences are
 recalculated (Peden, 1981).  If the differences are still unacceptable
 or if no suspect data are identified, the QA manager should be contacted
 for guidance.

-------
                                                          Section 3.0
                                                          Revision  2
                                                          Date:  11/86
                                                          Page 13 of 17


                 TABLE  3.8.   CONDUCTANCE FACTORS OF IONS3
Ion
   Specific
  Conductance
(uS/cm at 25°C)
    per mg/L
Ion
 Specific
Conductance
     at 25°C)
  per mg/L
Ca2+
CT
co32-
H+
HC03-
Mg2+







2.60
2.14
2.82
3.5 x 105
(per mole/L)
0.715
3.82

[H+] moles/L = 10
pH = pH determine
Kw
[OH-] = 	
[H+]
5.080
Hffi ~ - n
ru+i
4.996
Na+ 2.13
NH4+ 4.13
S042' 1.54
N03" 1.15
K+ 1.84
OH" 1.92 x 105
(per mole/L)

-pH
d at V=0 of the BNC titration.

[DIC(mg/D] [H+] K1
2 + [H+] Kx + Kj K2
[DIC(mg/D] K:K2
                            ru"*"12 4. rH"*"~\v  4. \t  v
                            Ln  J   ~ Ln Jl\i  T |\i |^/j
                                         1     it.

                       = 4.4463  x 10"7   K2 = 4.6881 x 10"11

aAPHA et al., 1985; Weast,  1972.

-------
                                                                Section 3.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 14 of 17


          %CD calculation are expected to account for 90 to 100 percent of the
          ions in a sample.  However, in contrast to the %ID calculation,  there
          is no term in the %CD calculation to account for protolytes  not
          specifically determined.

          Examine the data from samples that do not meet the %CD criteria for
          possible causes of the unacceptable %CD,  such as improper data
          reporting or analysis.  The presence or absence of unmeasured pro-
          tolytes can be tested by the procedures described in section 4.   Note
          that the absence of unmeasured protolytes is positive evidence that
          the %CD exceeds the maximum difference because of analytical  error.
          Redetermine any parameter that is identified as suspect.   If an
          explanation for the poor %CD cannot be found and if the problem cannot
          be corrected, contact the QA manager at EMSL-Las Vegas for further
          guidance.

3.5  Data Reporting

    . Record the results from each method on the data form indicated in Table
     3.9 (blank data forms are included in Appendix B).  Report results to the
     number of decimal places in the actual detection limit.   However,  report
     no more than four significant figures.  Sample results from reanalyzed
     samples (occasionally samples are reanalyzed for QC reasons) are  annotated
     by the letter R.  Results obtained by standard additions are annotated by
     the letter G.  These and other data qualifiers are listed in Table 3.10.
     After the forms are completed, the laboratory manager must sign them to
     indicate that he has reviewed the data and that the samples were  analyzed
     exactly as described in this manual.  All  deviations from the  manual
     require the authorization of the QA manager prior to sample analysis.

3.6  References

     American Public Health Association, American Water Works Association, and
          Water Pollution Control Federation, 1985.  Standard Methods  for  the
          Examination of Water and Wastewater,  16th Ed.  APHA, Washington, D.C.

     Kramer, J. R., 1982.  ANC and BNC.  j£:  R. A. Minear, L. H.  Keith
          (eds.), Water Analysis.  Vol. 1.  Inorganic Species, Part 1.
          Academic Press, Orlando, Florida.

     McQuaker, N. R., P. D. Kluckner, and D. K. Sandberg, 1983.  Chemical
          Analysis of Acid Precipitation:  pH and BNC Determinations.   Environ.
          Sci.  Technol., v. 17 n. 7, pp. 431-435.

     Peden, M. E., 1981.  Sampling, Analytical, and Quality Assurance  Protocols
          for the National Atmospheric Deposition Program.  Paper presented at
          October 1981 ASTM D-22 Symposium and Workshop on Sampling and
          Analysis of Rain.  ASTM, Philadelphia, Pennsylvania.

-------
                                                           Section 3.0
                                                           Revision 2
                                                           Date:   11/86
                                                           Page 15 of 17
                    TABLE 3.9.  LIST OF DATA FORMS
    Data Form                             Description


       11                        Summary of sample results

       13                        ANC and BNC results

       14a                       QC data for ANC and BNC analysis

       15a                       Specific conductance (measured and
                                   calculated)

       16a                       Anion-cation balance calculations

       17                        Ion chromatography resolution test form

       18                        QA (detection  limits)

       19                        Sample holding times summary

       20                        Blank and QCCS results

       21                        Dilution factors

       22                        Duplicate results


  aForm is not required but is recommended for  internal  lab use.
Copies of raw data must be submitted as requested by the QA manager.   All
original raw data must be retained by the lab until  notified otherwise.
Raw data include data system printouts, chromatograms,  notebooks,  QC
charts, standard preparation data, and all  information  pertinent to
sample analysis.

-------
                                                                Section  3.0
                                                                Revision  2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page  16  of 17


           TABLE 3.10.  NATIONAL SURFACE WATER SURVEY  DATA QUALIFIERS


Qualifier                               Indicates


   F              Result outside criteria with consent of  QA manager

   G              A typical  result;  already reanalyzed and confirmed  by  the
                    laboratory manager
   H              Holding time exceeded criteria (Form 19  only)
   J              Result not available; insufficient sample volume  shipped

   K              Result not available; entire aliquot not shipped
   L              Result not available; analytical  interference
   M              Result not available; sample lost or destroyed by lab

   N              Not required
   P              Result outside criteria,  but insufficient volume  for
                    reanalysis
   Q              Result outside QA  criteria

   R              Result from reanalysis

   S              Contamination suspected
   T              Leaking container
   U              Result not required  by procedure

   V              Anion-cation balance outside criteria because  of  DOC

   W              % Difference UD)  calculation (Form  14)  outside criteria
                    because  of high  DOC.

   Y              Available  for miscellaneous  comments
   Z              Available  for miscellaneous  comments

-------
                                                           Section 3.0
                                                           Revision 2
                                                           Date:   11/86
                                                           Page 17 of 17
U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, 1983 (revised).  Methods for
     Chemical Analysis of Water and Wastes.   EPA-600/4-79-020.  U.S.  EPA,
     Cincinnati, Ohio.

Weast, R. C. (ed.), 1972.  CRC Handbook of Chemistry and Physics,  53rd Ed,
     CRC Press, Cleveland, Ohio.

-------
                                                                Section 4.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page 1 of 27


4.0  DETERMINATION OF BASE-NEUTRALIZING CAPACITY, ACID-NEUTRALIZING CAPACITY,
     AND pH

4.1  Scope and Application

     This procedure is applicable to the determination of pH, ANC, and BNC in
     weakly buffered natural waters of low ionic strength.  The terms ANC and
     BNC refer to the acid-neutralizing capacity (ANC) and base-neutralizing
     capacity (BNC) of systems which are based on the carbonate ion system.
     (The soluble reacting species are HoC03, HC03~, and C03Z~.)  For calcula-
     tion purposes, it is assumed that the streams in this survey are repre-
     sented by a carbonate ion system; hence, the ANC and BNC definitions are
     made in relation to the carbonate ion species (Kramer, 1982; Butler, 1982).

4.2  Summary of Method

     Samples are titrated with standardized acid and base while monitoring and
     recording the pH.  The BNC and ANC are determined by analyzing the titra-
     tion data by using a modified Gran analysis technique (Kramer, 1982; Butler,
     1982; Kramer, 1984; Gran, 1952).

     The Gran analysis technique defines the Gran functions F^ and ?2 based
     upon the sample volume, the acid or base volume added, and the carbonate
     dissociation constants.  The Gran functions are calculated for several
     data pairs of titrant volume added (either acid or base) and the resulting
     pH.  The data pairs are chosen so that they cross the ANC and BNC equiv-
     alence points.  When the Gran functions are plotted versus volume of
     titrant added, the linear portion of each curve can be interpolated to the
     equivalence point.

     The pH is determined prior to the start of the titrations with the elec-
     trode used during the titration.  (U.S. EPA, 1983; McQuaker et al., 1983;
     NBS, 1982).

     The air-equilibrated pH is determined similarly after equilibrating the
     sample with 300 ppm C0£ in air.  Air equilibration is expected to nor-
     malize pH values by factoring out the day-to-day and seasonal fluctuations
     in dissolved C0£ concentrations.

4.3  Interferences

     No interferences are known.

4.4  Safety

     The standards, sample types, and most reagents pose little hazard to the
     analyst.  Protective clothing (lab coat and gloves) and safety glasses
     must be used when handling concentrated acids and bases.

-------
                                                                Section 4.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page 2 of 27


     Gas cylinders must be secured in an  upright  position.

4.5  Apparatus and Equipment

4.5.1  pH/mV Meter--A digital  pH/mV meter capable of measuring pH to ±0.01 pH
       unit, potential to ±1 mV,  and temperature  to ±0.5eC  must  be  used.  It
       must also have automatic temperature  compensation  capability.

4.5.2  pH Electrodes—High-quality, low-sodium glass pH and reference elec-
       trodes must be used.   (Gel-type reference  electrodes must not be used.)
       A combination electrode is recommended  (such as the  Orion Ross combina-
       tion pH electrode or equivalent),  and the  procedure  is written assuming
       one is used.

4.5.3  Buret—A microburet capable of precisely and accurately delivering 10 to
       50 piL must be used (relative error and  standard deviation less than 1
       percent).

4.5.4  Teflon Stir Bars

4.5.5  Variable Speed Magnetic Stirrer

4.5.6  Plastic Gas Dispersion Tube

       NOTE:   Glass dispersion tubes must not be used because they can add
               ANC to a sample.  Plastic  dispersion tubes are available in most
               fish-aquarium supply stores.

4.5.7  Titration System—Alternatively to items 4.5.1 through 4.5.3, a commer-
       cial titration instrument meeting  the same specifications may be used.

4.6  Reagents and Consumable Materials

4.6.1  Carbon Dioxide Gas (300 ppm C02 in Air)—Certified Standard  Grade

4.6.2  Hydrochloric Acid Titrant (0.01N HCD—Add 0.8 ml  concentrated hydro-
       chloric acid (HC1, 12N, ACS reagent grade  or equivalent)  to  500 ml
       water, then dilute to 1.00 L with  water.  Standardize as  described in
       section 4.8.1.

4.6.3  Nitrogen Gas (N2)—C02-free

4.6.4  Potassium Chloride Solution (0.10  M KC1)—Dissolve 7.5 g  KC1 (Alfa
       Ultrapure or equivalent) in water, then dilute to  1.00 L  with water.

4.6.5  Potassium Hydrogen Phthalate (KHP)—Dry 5  to 10 g  KHP (ACS-certified
       primary standard grade or equivalent) at 110°C for 2 hours,  then store
       in a desiccator.

-------
                                                                Section  4.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page  3 of 27


4.6.6  pH Calibration Buffers (pH 4, 7, and 10)—NBS-traceable pH buffers at  pH
       values of 4, 7, and 10.

4.6.7  pH QC Samples (pH 4 and 10)--pH 4 QC sample - dilute 1.00 ml  stand-
       ardized 0.01N HC1 titrant to 100.00 ml with water.   The theoretical pH
       is calculated by:

                                    i     /NHC1\
                            pH  =  -log   	
                                         \100 /

4.6.8  pH 10 QC sample - Dilute 1.00 ml of the standardized 0.01N NaOH
       titrant to 100.00 ml with water.  The theoretical  pH is calculated by:

                                             /NNaOH\
                            pH  =  14 + log   	
                                             \ 100

4.6.9  Sodium Carbonate (Na2C03)~Dry 5 to 10 g Na2C03 (ACS certified primary
       standard grade or equivalent) at 110°C for 2 hours,  then store in a
       desiccator.

4.6.10 Sodium Hydroxide Stock Solution (50 percent w/v NaOH)--Dissolve 100 g
       NaOH (ACS reagent grade or equivalent) in 100 ml water.  After cooling
       and allowing any precipitate to settle (may be hastened by centrifuga-
       tion), transfer the supernatant to a polyethylene  bottle.   Store  tightly
       capped and avoid atmospheric exposure.

4.6.11 Sodium Hydroxide Titrant (0.01 N NaOH)--Dilute 0.6 to 0.7  mL 50 percent
       NaOH to 1.0 L with water.   Standardize as described  in section 4.8.2.

4.6.12 Water—Water used to prepare reagents and standards  must conform  to ASTM
       D 1193 specifications for Type I water (ASTM, 1984).

4.7  Sample Collection, Preservation,  and Storage

     The sample for which BNC, ANC, and pH is to be determined is delivered to
     the lab in a 500-mL amber polyethylene bottle (aliquot 5).  Store at 4°C
     and minimize atmospheric exposure.

4.8  Calibration and Standardization

4.8.1  Standardization of HC1 Titrant

4.8.1.1    Weigh about 1 g anhydrous Na2C03 to the nearest  0.1 mg, dissolve in
           water, then dilute to 1.000 L.  Calculate the  concentration by the
           following equation.

-------
                                                                 Section 4.0
                                                                 Revision  2
                                                                 Date:  11/86
                                                                 Page 4 of 27


                                     Wt. Na2C03 g       1
                          CO   =   ••---  " '           x —
                         2  3      106.00 g   1 mole   1L

                                    mole      2 eq

           NOTE:  This solution is to be freshly prepared just before use.

4.8.1.2    Calibrate the pH meter and electrode as recommended by the manu-
           facturer.

4.8.1.3    Pipet 1.00 ml standard Na2C03 plus 40.00 ml COo-free  deionized water
           into a clean, dry titration vessel.  Add a Teflon stir bar and stir
           at a medium speed (no visible vortex).

4.8.1.4    Immerse the pH electrode and record the pH when a stable reading is
           obtained.

4.8.1.5    Add a known volume of the HC1 titrant and record the  pH when a
           stable reading is obtained.  Use the following table  as a guide to
           the volume of titrant that should be added in different pH ranges:

                                             Maximum Volume Increment
                        pH                      of HC1 Titrant (ml)
                       >7.5                            0.2
                        7.5-4                          0.1
                       <4                              0.2

           Continue the titration until the pH <4.  Obtain at least seven data
           points in the range pH 4 to 7.

4.8.1.6    Calculate F^ for eacn data Pair (volume acid added, pH) with pH in
           the range 4 to 7:


                                                                      w
           F1h  =  (V. + V)	  I	=	=-^	 ) + —- - [H+:
            *•-'       *>        / t*  .  »• \  lrii+"iX.r*i4'ni*    \»  \»  I   r ij+T
                                                                    Ln J
= (vs + v)
VP / r 11+ "! i/ , o v \/
ew / LnjNl*ti\li\o
si i i e.
(Vs + V) l[H*]2 + [H+]K1 +
I/ I/
Kl K2
                 =  Gran function

             Vs  =  Initial sample volume = 41.00 ml

              V  =  Volume of HC1 added in ml

              C  =  N Na2C03/(2 x dilution factor)

-------
                                                                Section 4.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 5 of 27
           [H"1"]  =  10"pH

             Kj  =  4.4463 X 10~7

             K2  =  4.6881 x 10~n

             Kw  =  1.01 x 10"14

4.8.1.7    Plot F^ versus V.  Using the points on the linear portion of the
           plot, perform a linear regression of F^ on V to obtain the coef-
           ficients of the line:

                                 Flb =  a + bV

           The correlation coefficient should exceed 0.999.  If it does not,
           reexamine the plot to make sure only points on the linear  portion
           are used in the linear regression.

4.8.1.8    Calculate the equivalence volume, Vj, by:

                                 Y!  =  -a/b

           then calculate the HC1 normality by:

                                          N Na2C03 x V Na2C03
                                 NHC1  =  	


4.8.1.9    Repeat the titration and calculation three times (steps 4.8.1.3
           through 4.8.1.8).  Calculate an average N^r/i  a"d standard  deviation.
           The RSD must be less than 2 percent.  If it is not,  the entire
           standardization must be repeated until  it is less than 2 percent.

4.8.1.10   The concentration of every new batch of HC1 titrant must be cross
           checked by using the procedure described in section 4.8.2.2.

4.8.1.11   Store in a clean polyethylene bottle.  Although the HC1  titrant  is
           stable, it must be restandardized monthly (sections 4.8.1.1 through
           4.8.1.9).

           NOTE:  An example of an HC1 standardization is given in Appendix
                  C-1.0.

4.8.2  Standardization of NaOH Titrant

       Every batch of NaOH titrant is initially standardized against  KHP
       (section 4.8.2.1), and the standardization  is cross-checked against

-------
                                                                Section 4.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page 6 of 27


       standardized HC1 titrant (section 4.8.2.2).  Thereafter, it is
       restandardized daily against the HC1  titrant (section 4.8.2.3).

4.8.2.1   Initial NaOH standardization

          Weigh about 0.2 g KHP to the nearest 0.1 mg,  dissolve in water, then
          dilute to 1.000 L.  Calculate the  normality of the solution by the
          following equation.

                                      wt.  KHP g       1
                                      204.22 g       1 L

                                         eq

          Calibrate the pH electrode and meter as recommended by the
          manufacturer.

          Purge the titration vessel with C02~free nitrogen,  then pi pet 5.00
          ml standard KHP solution and 20.00 ml C02~free water into the vessel.
          Maintain a C02~free atmosphere above the sample throughout the
          titration.

          Add a Teflon stir bar and stir at a medium speed (no visible vortex).

          Immerse the pH electrode and record the reading when it stabilizes.

          Titrate with the 0.01N NaOH by using the increments specified in the
          table below.  Record the volume and pH (when stable) between addi-
          tions.  Continue the titration until the pH >10.  Obtain at least
          four data points in the pH range 5 to 7 and four data points in the
          pH range 7 to 11.

                                        Maximum Volume Increment of
                        pH                   NaOH Titrant (ml.)

                          <5                      0.10
                      5 to 9                      0.05
                          >9                      0.2

          Calculate F3& for each data pair (volume added, pH) with a pH 5 to
          10.
                             VCC     /   [H+]Ki  + 2 [H+]2   \           Kw
        F3b  =  (Vs + V)       S      '         L               !-  r"+n
                           (Vs + V)   \[H+]2 + [H+]K,  + K!  K9/          [H+]

-------
                                                                Section  4.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page  7 of 27
                    =  Gran function

                Vs  =  Initial sample volume = 25.00 ml

                 V  =  Volume of NaOH added (ml)

                 C  =  N KHP corrected for initial  dilution = N KHP/5

              [H+]  =  10-PH

                K!  =  1.3 x 10~3

                K2  =  3.9 x 10"6

                Kw  =  1.01 x 10"14
          Plot P3b versus V.  Using the points on the linear portion of  the  plot,
          perform a linear regression of F3D on V to obtain the coefficients of
          the line:

                                 F3b  =  a + bV

          The correlation coefficient should exceed 0.999.   If it does not,
          examine the plot to ensure that only points on the linear  portion  are
          used in the linear regression.

          Calculate the equivalence volume, 73, by:

                                 V3  =  -a/b

          then calculate the NaOH normality by:

                                           NKHP x VKHP
                                 NNaOH  =  	


          Repeat the titration and calculation a total  of three times.
          Calculate an average N^on and standard deviation.  The RSD must be
          less than 2 percent.  If not, the entire standardization must  be
          repeated until the RSD is less than 2 percent.

4.8.2.2   NaOH-HCl Standardization Cross-check

          Purge a titration vessel with C02~free nitrogen,  then pipet 0.500  ml
          of 0.01N NaOH and 25.00 ml of COp-free water into the vessel.
          Maintain a C02-free atmosphere above the sample.

          Add a Teflon stir bar and stir at a medium speed.

-------
                                                      Section 4.0
                                                      Revision 2
                                                      Date:   11/86
                                                      Page 8 of 27
Immerse the pH electrode and record the reading when it stabilizes.

Titrate with the standardized 0.01N HC1 by using the increments
specified in the table below.  Record the volume and pH (when stable)
between additions.   Continue the titration until the pH is less than
3.5.  Obtain at least seven data points in the pH range 4 to 10.

                              Maximum Volume Increment of
              pH                   HC1 Titrant (ml)

                >10                      0.2
            10 to 4                      0.05
                 <4                      0.2

Calculate Fj for each data pair (V, pH) with a pH 4  to 10.

                                     .  Kw
                    Fl  =  (vs + v)


    FI  =  Gran function

    Ys  =  Initial  sample volume = 25.5 ml

     V  =  Volume of HC1 added (ml)

    Kw  =  1.01 x 10'14

  [H+]  =  10-PH

Plot FI versus V.  Using the points on the linear portion of the
plot, perform a linear regression of FI on V to obtain the coeffi-
cients of the line:

                    Fj  =  a + bV

The correlation coefficient should exceed 0.999.  If not, reexamine
the plot to ensure  that only points on the linear portion are used
in the linear regression.

Calculate the equivalence volume, Vj, by:

                    Vj  =  -a/b

then calculate the  HC1 normality (designated as N'uri) by:

-------
                                                                Section 4.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 9 of 27
                                        NNaOH x vNaOH
               VNaOH  =  0-500

          Calculate the absolute relative percent difference (RPD)  between
                and NHCI (normality determined in section 4.8.1)  by:
                             RPD  =
                                          N*HC1  " NHC1
                                       0.5
                      x  100
          The absolute RPD must be less than 5 percent.   If it is not,  then  a
          problem exists in either the acid or the base  standardization or both
          (bad reagents, out-of-calibration burets, etc.).   The problem must be
          identified, and both procedures 4.8.1 and 4.8.2 repeated until  the
          RPD calculated above is less than 5 percent.

4.8.2.3   Daily NaOH Standardization

          Calibrate the pH meter and electrode as recommended by the manu-
          facturer.

          Purge the titration vessel with COo-free nitrogen,  then pipet 1.000
          ml NaOH titrant plus 25.00 mL O^-free water into the vessel.
          Maintain a C02~free nitrogen atmosphere above  the sample.   (Smaller
          volumes of NaOH may be used.  A known volume of C02-free water
          should be added to bring solution to a convenient volume.)

          Add a Teflon stir bar and stir at a medium speed.

          Immerse the pH electrode and record the reading when it stabilizes.

          Titrate with the standardized HC1 titrant by using the increments
          specified in the table below.  Record the volume  and pH (when stable)
          between additions.  Continue the titration until  the pH <4.  Obtain
          at least seven data points in the pH range 4 to 10.
                      PH
                   10 to 4
                        <4
Maximum Volume Increment of
      HC1 Titrant (ml)

            0.2
            0.05
            0.2

-------
                                                      Section 4.0
                                                      Revision 2
                                                      Date:   11/86
                                                      Page 10 of 27
Calculate Fj for each data pair (volume acid added,  pH)  with a pH
4 to 10:
                   F   =  (v  + V)   — - [H+]
                    1       S
    FI  =  Gran function

    Vs  =  Initial sample volume = 26.00 ml

     V  =  Volume of HC1 added

    Kw  =  1.01 x 10'14

  [H*]  =  10~PH

Plot F! versus V.  Using the points on the linear portion of the
plot, perform a linear regression of Fj on V to obtain the coeffi-
cients of the line:

                   F!  =  a + bV

The correlation coefficient should exceed 0.999.  If it does not,
reexamine the plot to make sure that only points on the linear
portion are used in the linear regression.

Calculate the equivalence volume, Vj, by:

                   Vx  =  -a/b

then calculate the NaOH normality by:

                              NHCI * vx
                   NNaOH
                                vNaOH
Repeat the titration and calculation twice more.   Calculate an
average NNa0u and standard deviation.   The RSD must be less than
2 percent.  If it is not, the entire standardization must be repeated
until the RSD is less than 2 percent.

Because the NaOH titrant can readily deteriorate  through exposure to
the air, every effort must be made to  prevent its exposure to the air
at all times.  Furthermore, it must be standardized daily or before
every major work shift.  Store the NaOH titrant in a linear poly-
ethylene or Teflon container with a C02~free atmosphere, e.g.,
under C02~free air, nitrogen, or argon.

-------
                                                                Section 4.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 11 of 27


          NOTE:  An example of NaOH standardization is given in Appendix C.

4.8.3  Calibration and Characterization of Electrodes

       Separate electrodes must be used for the acid and base titrations.  Each
       new electrode pair must be rigorously evaluated for Nernstian response
       by using the procedure described in section 4.8.3.1 prior to analyzing
       samples.  After the initial electrode evaluation, the electrodes are
       calibrated daily by using the procedure in section 4.8.3.2.

4.8.3.1   Rigorous Calibration Procedure—This procedure calibrates and evaluates
          the Nernstian response of an electrode.  Also, it familiarizes the
          analyst with the characteristic response time of the electrode.

          Following the instructions of the manufacturer, calibrate the electrode
          and meter used for acid titrations with pH 7 and 4 buffer solutions
          and calibrate the electrode used for base titrations with pH 7 and 10
          buffer solutions.

          Prepare a blank solution by pipetting 50.00 ml C02-free water and
          0.50 ml 0.10M KC1 into a titration vessel.

          Add a Teflon stir bar and stir at a medium speed by using a  magnetic
          stirrer.

          Titrate the blank with standardized 0.01N HC1 by using the increments
          specified in the table below.  Continue the titration until  the pH
          is 3.3 to 3.5.  Record the pH between each addition, noting  the time
          required for stabilization.  Obtain at least seven data points that
          have a pH less than 4.

                                        Maximum Volume Increment of
                        pH                   HC1  Titrant (ml)

                        >4                        0.050
                        <4                        0.3

          Prepare a fresh aliquot of water and 0.1M KC1 as in 4.8.3.1.2.

          Under a C02~free atmosphere, titrate the blank with standardized
          0.01N NaOH by using the increments specified in the table below.

          Continue the titration until the pH is 10.5 to 11.  Record the pH
          between each addition.  Obtain at least 10 data points between pH 9
          and 10.5.

-------
                                                      Section 4.0
                                                      Revision 2
                                                      Date:   11/86
                                                      Page 12 of 27
                               Maximum Volume Increment of
               pH                   NaOH Titrant (ml)
              <10                         0.10
              >10                         0.20

For each titration, calculate the pH for each data by point using
pH* = -log [H+].  [H+] is calculated by:

   acid titration
   base titration


                    [H+]  =
   VA  =  acid volume

   CA  =  HC1  concentration in eq/L

   Vs  =  sample volume = 50.5 mL

   kw  =  1.01 x 10'14

   VB  =  base volume

   CB  =  NaOH concentration in eq/L

For each titration, plot the measured pH versus the calculated  pH
(designated as pH*).  Perform a linear regression  on each  plot  to
obtain the coefficients of the line:

                   pH  =  a + b(pH*)

The plots must be linear with b = 1.00 ± 0.05  and  r > 0.999.
Typically, some nonlinearity exists in the pH  region 6 to  8.  This
is most likely because of small errors in titrant  standardization,
impure salt solutions, or atmospheric CO? contamination.   The non-
linear points should not be used in the linear regression.

If the plots are not linear and do not meet the specifications
above, the electrode should be considered suspect.  The electrode

-------
                                                                Section 4.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 13 of 27


          characterization must then be repeated.  If unacceptable results are
          still obtained, the electrode must be replaced.

          The plots for both titrations should be coincident.  Combine the data
          from both titrations and perform a linear least squares analysis on
          the combined data to obtain new estimates for the coefficients of the
          equation:

                             pH  =  a + b(pH*)

          The electrodes are now calibrated.  Do not move any controls on the
          meter.

          If the two plots are not coincident (i.e;, the coefficients  a and b
          do not overlap), the characterization must be repeated.  If  the plots
          are still not coincident, the electrode must be replaced.

4.8.3.2   Daily Calibration Procedure—Generally, the calibration curve
          prepared above is stable from day to day.  This daily calibration is
          designed to verify the calibration on a day-to-day basis.

          Copiously rinse the electrode with water.  Immerse it in 20  ml of pH
          7 buffer and stir for 1 to 2 minutes.  Discard the buffer and replace
          with an additional 40 ml of pH 7 buffer.  While the solution is
          gently stirred, measure the pH.  Adjust the pH meter calibration knob
          until the pH is equal to the theoretical pH of the buffer.

          Record the theoretical pH and the final, measured pH reading.  (The
          two values should be identical).

          Copiously rinse the electrode with water.  Immerse it in 20  mL of pH
          4 QC sample and stir for 1 to 2 minutes.  Discard the sample and
          replace it with an additional 40 ml pH 4 QC sample.  While the solu-
          tion is stirred, measure and record the pH.  From the calibration
          curve of pH versus pH*, determine the pH* for the observed pH.
          Compare pH* to the theoretical pH of the QC sample.  The two values
          must agree within ±0.05 pH unit.  If the two values do not agree, the
          rigorous calibration procedure (section 4.8.3.1) must be performed
          prior to sample analysis.

          Repeat the above step with the pH 10 QC sample.  This sample must be
          kept under a COp-free atmosphere when in use, or acceptable  results
          may not be obtained.

-------
                                                                Section 4.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 14 of 27


4.9  Quality Control

4.9.1  Duplicate Analysis

       Analyze one sample per batch in duplicate.   The duplicate precision
       (expressed as an RSD) must be less than or  equal  to 10 percent.   If the
       duplicate precision is unacceptable (RSD >10 percent), then a problem
       exists in the experimental technique.  Determine and eliminate  the cause
       of the poor precision prior to continuing sample analysis.

4.9.2  Blank Analysis

       Determine the ANC in one blank per batch.  The absolute value of the ANC
       must be less than or equal to 10 ueq/L.  If it is not, contamination is
       indicated.  Determine and eliminate the contamination source (often the
       source will be the water or KC1) prior to continuing sample analysis.
       Blank values are calculated as described in 4.11.1 and Appendix C-4.0.

4.9.3  pH QCCS

       Prior to analysis of the first sample in a  shift and every  five samples
       thereafter, the appropriate pH QC sample (pH 4 QC for acid  titrations
       and pH 10 QC for base titrations) must be analyzed by using the following
       procedure.  Copiously rinse the electrode with deionized water.   Immerse
       it in 20 mL of QC sample and stir it for 30 to 60 seconds.   Discard the
       sample and replace it with an additional 40 ml of QC sample.  While the
       solution is gently stirred, measure and record the pH.  From the
       calibration curve of pH versus pH*, determine the pH*.  If  the  pH* and
       theoretical pH of the QC sample differ by more than ±0.05 pH unit, stop
       the analysis and repeat the rigorous electrode calibration  (section
       4.8.3.1).  Previously analyzed samples (up  to last acceptable QC sample)
       must be reanalyzed.  Acceptable values of pH* are reported  on Form 20.

4.9.4  Comparison of Initial Titration pH Values

       The values for measured pH at Vt-jtrant = 0  (before KC1 spike) of the
       acid and base titrations should be within ±0.1 pH unit.  If they are
       not, check operation to ensure that cross-contamination is  not  occurring.

4.9.5  For a sample with ANC <_ -15 ueq/L, calculate a value for ANC as follows:

                    [ANC]CQ  =  106 x 10~PH* (pH at V  =  0)

       (The pH at Vtjtraqt = 0 is taken from the acid titration.)   If  ANC
       differs from [ANCJco by more than ±10 ueq/L, then check the electrode
       operation and calibration.

-------
                                                                Section 4.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 15 of 27
4.9.6  Comparison of Calculated ANC and Measured ANC

       A value for ANC can be calculated from the DIC concentration and the
       pH of a sample.  Two sets of pH and DIC values are obtained in the lab:
       (1) pH* at V=0 of the base titration and the associated DIC concentration
       and (2) pH of the air-equilibrated sample and the associated DIC concen-
       tration.  Each set can be used to calculate a value for ANC.  The calcu-
       lated values for Alk can then be compared to the measured value of ANC.
       The comparison is useful in checking both the validity of assuming a
       carbonate system and the possibility of analytical error.  ANC is calcu-
       lated from pH and DIC as follows:

                    [ANC]Q  =  calculated ANC from initial  pH and DIC at time
                                of base titration

                    [ANC]c2  =  calculated ANC from air-equilibrated pH and DIC
       [ANC]C (ueq/L)   =
                           DIC
12,011 UH+]2 +
   rvw
+ — - CH+]
                                                   K1K2
                                              x 10C
                 DIC  =  DIC in mg/L (the factor 12,011 converts mg/L  to
                         moles/L)
                  K!  =  4.4463 x 10"7  at 25°C

                  K2  =  4.6881 x 10"11  at 25°C

                  Kw  =  1.01 x 10~14  at 25°C

       [ANC]ci and [ANC]c2 are compared as follows:

       For [ANC]QI £100 ueq/L, the following condition applies:
                            [ANC]Ci - [ANC]C2
                       <15 ueq/L
       For [ANCDci >100 ueq/L,  the following condition  applies:
                           [ANC]C1 - [ANC]C2

                         ([ANC]C1 + [ANC]C2)/2
                     x 100

-------
                                                                Section  4.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page  16  of 27


       If either of the above conditions is not satisfied,  then  the pH and DIG
       values are suspect and must be remeasured.   It is  very  important  that
       the pH and DIG be measured as closely together in  time  as possible.  If
       they are not measured closely in time,  acceptable  agreement between
       [ANC]Q and [ANC]Q2 may not be obtained.  When acceptable values  for
       [ANC]QJ and [ANC]r,2 are obtained, their average is compared to the
       measured ANC as described below.
       For [ANC]r_avg 5.100 ueq/L, then the difference "D" and  the acceptance
       window "w  are:

                     D  =  [ANC]c.avg - ANC, and w =  15 ueq/L

       For [ANC]c-avg >10° Meq/L, then:
                                      - ANC
                     D  =  - -  x  100,  and  w  =   10%
                              [ANC]C-avg

       If |D|  w,  then an analytical  problem  exists in  the pH
       determination, DIG determination, or acid titration (such as titrant
       concentration).  In this case the problem must be identified, and the
       sample must be reanalyzed.

4.9.7  Comparison of Calculated BNC and Measured BNC

       Just as for ANC, pH and DIG values can be used to calculate a BNC
       value.   Since the BNC of a  sample changes with changing DIC, only the
       initial pH and DIC values measured at the beginning of the  base  titra-
       tion are used to calculate  an BNC value.   This calculated BNC is then
       compared to the measured BNC value.   BNC is calculated by:
       [BNC]C (ueq/L)   =
                    DIC   /     [H+]2  -  K,K?     \           Kw
                    _      I 	i  £     \ +  r^j+-i  _   "
                   12,011 UH+]2 +  [H^K! + KLK2 y          [H+]


       is compared to BNC as  described below.

For [BNClc £100 peq/L,  then:

                    D  =   [BNC]C -  BNC,  and w   =  10  ueq/L

For [BNClc >100 peq/L,  then:
x 10
                                                                            ,6

-------
                                                                Section  4.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page  17  of 27


                              [BNC]C - BNC
                        D  =  	 x 100,  and w  =  10%
                                 [BNC]C

       If |D|  £w, then it is valid to assume a carbonate system.   If  D <-w,
       the assumption of a pure carbonate system is not valid,  and the sample
       contains noncarbonate protolytes such as organic species.

       If D >w, then an analytical problem exists  in the pH determination,
       DIG determination, or base titration (such  as titrant concentration).
       In this case the problem must be identified, and the sample must  be
       reanalyzed.
4.9.8  Comparison of Calculated Total Carbonate and Measured Total  Carbonate

       If the  assumption of a carbonate system is  valid, the sum of ANC  plus
       BNC is  equal to the total carbonate.  This  assumption can be checked by
       calculating the total carbonate from the DIC, then comparing the  calcu-
       lated total carbonate to the measured estimate of total  carbonate (the
       sum of  ANC plus BNC).  The total carbonate  is calculated by:

                    GC (umole/L)  =  DIC (mg/L) x  83.26 (umole/mg)

       CQ is compared to (ANC + BNC) as follows:

       For CQ  £100 umole/L, then:

                     D  =  GC - (ANC + BNC), and w  =  10 umole/L

       For Cc  >100 umole/L, then:

                             Cc - (ANC + BNC)
                      D  =   	 x 100, and w  =  10%
                                    CC

       If |D|  £w, the assumption of a carbonate system is valid.   If  D <-w,
       the assumption is not valid, and the sample contains noncarbonate
       protolytes.  If D >w, an analytical problem exists.  It  must be
       identified, and the sample must be reanalyzed.

4.10   Procedure

       An acid titration (section 4.10.1) and a base titration  (section  4.10.2)
       are necessary to determine the BNC and ANC  of a sample.   As part  of each
       titration, the sample pH is determined.  The air-equilibrated  pH  is
       determined in a separate sample portion (section 4.10.3).

-------
                                                                Section 4.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page 18 of 27
4.10.1  Acid Titration

4.10.1.1  Allow a sealed sample (aliquot 5) to reach ambient temperature.

4.10.1.2  Copiously rinse the electrode with deionized water, then immerse in
          10 to 20 ml sample.  Stir for 30 to 60 seconds.

4.10.1.3  Pipet 40.00 ml of sample into a clean, dry titration flask.

4.10.1.4  Add a clean Teflon stir bar and place on a magnetic stirrer.   Stir
          at a medium speed (no visible vortex).

4.10.1.5  Immerse the pH electrode and read pH.  Record pH on Forms 11  and 13
          when the reading stabilizes (1 to 2 minutes).  This is the initial
          measured pH at Vfjtrant = °-

4.10.1.6  Add 0.40 ml 0.1M KC1.  Read and record the pH on Form 13.  This is
          the initial measured pH at V-fjtrant = 0 after addition of KC1  spike.

4.10.1.7  Add increments of 0.01N HC1 as specified in the table below.   Record
          the volume of HC1 added and the pH when a stable reading is obtained.
          Adjust the volume increment of titrant so that readings can be taken
          at pH values of 4.5 and 4.2.  Continue the titration until the pH is
          between 3.3 and 3.5.   Obtain at least six data points that have a pH
          less than 4.
                         PH
                         >9
                     9.0 to 7.0
                     7.0 to 5.5
                     5.5 to 4.5
                     4.5 to 3.75
                         <3.75
Maximum Volume Increment of
      HC1  Titrant (mL)

            0.1
            0.025
            0.1
            0.05
            0.1
            0.3
4.10.2  Base Titration
4.10.2.1  Take a portion of aliquot 5 at this time for DIC determination.   If
          the DIC is not determined immediately, the sample must be kept sealed
          from the atmosphere.  A simple way to do this is to withdraw the
          sample for DIC by using a syringe equipped with a syringe valve.  By
          closing the valve, the sample is sealed from the atmosphere (syringe
          valves that fit standard Luer-Lok syringes are available from most
          chromatography supply companies).

4.10.2.2  Purge the titration vessel with C02-free air, N2, or Ar.

-------
                                                                Section 4.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page 19 of 27


4.10.2.3  Copiously rinse the electrode with deionized water, then immerse in
          10 to 20 ml sample for 30 to 60 seconds.

4.10.2.4  Pipet 40.00 ml sample into the C02-free titration vessel.  Maintain
          a C02-free atmosphere above the sample.  Do not bubble the N2 (or
          other C02-free gas) through the sample.  Add a clean Teflon stir bar
          to the vessel and place it on a magnetic stirrer.  Do not turn
          stirrer on at this point.

4.10.2.5  Immerse the pH electrode, read pH, and record pH on Forms 11 and 13
          when pH stabilizes.  This is the initial measured pH at Vfjtrant
          = 0.

4.10.2.6  Add 0.40 ml 0.10M KC1.  Stir for 10 to 15 seconds.  Read pH, and
          record pH on Form 13.

4.10.2.7  Add 0.025 mL of 0.01N NaOH and begin gentle stirring (no visible
          vortex).  Record the NaOH volume and pH when it stabilizes.  Continue
          the titration by adding increments of NaOH as specified below until
          the pH >11.  Record the volume of NaOH added and the pH after each
          addition.  Obtain at least 10 data points in the pH region 9 to 10.5.
          If the initial sample pH is less than 7, obtain at least 5 data
          points below pH 8.

                                         Maximum Volume Increment of
                          pH                  NaOH Titrant (ml)

                          <5                        0.025
                       5 to 7                       0.050
                       7 to 9                       0.025
                       9 to 10                      0.10
                      10 to 10.5                    0.30
                          >10.5                     1.00

4.10.3  Air-Equilibrated pH Measurement

4.10.3.1  Allow the sealed sample (aliquot 5) to reach ambient temperature.

4.10.3.2  Copiously rinse the electrode with deionized water, then immerse
          in 10 to 20 ml sample.  Stir for 30 to 60 seconds.

4.10.3.3  Pipet 20 to 40 ml sample into a clean, dry titration flask.

4.10.3.4  Add a clean Teflon stir bar and place on a magnetic stirrer.
          Stir at a medium speed.

4.10.3.5  Bubble standard gas containing 300 ppm C02 through the sample
          for 20 minutes.  Measure and record the pH.

-------
                                                                Section 4.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 20 of 27


4.10.3.6  Take a subsample at this time for DIG determination.   The subsample
          must be kept sealed from the atmosphere prior to analysis.  The DIG
          should be measured as soon as possible.

4.11  Calculations

      During the titrations, any substance which reacts with the acid  or base
      is titrated.  However, for calculations,  it is assumed that the  samples
      represent carbonate systems and that the  only reacting species are H+,
      OH~, H2C03, HCO^, and C032".  When use is made of this assumption, the
      two parameters

      "ANC" and "C02-BNC" are calculated.   The  validity of the  assumption is
      checked as described in sections 4.9.6 through 4.9.8.

      The theory behind the calculations is available elsewhere (Kramer, 1982;
      Butler, 1982; Kramer, 1984).  Examples of the calculations are given in
      Appendix C.

4.11.1  Initial Calculations

4.11.1.1  From the calibration curve of measured pH versus calculated  pH (pH*),
          determine pH* for each pH value  obtained during  both  the acid and
          base titrations.  Next, convert  all pH* values to hydrogen ion
          concentrations by using the equation:

                                     [H+]   = 10-PH*

4.11.1.2  Using the acid titration data, calculate the Gran  function Fla for
          each data pair (Va, pH*) in which pH* <4:

                                     Fla  =  (vs + V  ^

             Vs  =  Total initial sample volume (40.00 + 0.400) ml
             Va  =  Cumulative volume of acid titrant added
          Plot Fia versus Va.   The data should be on a straight line with
          the equation:

                                     Fla  =  a + bVa

          Perform a linear regression of Fja on Va to determine the correlation
          coefficient (r) and  the coefficients a and b.   The coefficient r
          should exceed  0.999.  If it does not, examine  the  data to ensure  that
          only data on the linear portion of the plot were used in the regres-
          sion.  If any  outliers are detected, repeat the regression analysis.
          Calculate an initial estimate of the equivalence volume (Vj)  by:

                                     V!  =  -a/b

-------
                                                                Section 4.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 21 of 27
          TABLE 4.1.  LIST OF CALCULATION PROCEDURES FOR COMBINATIONS
                             OF INITIAL Vj AND pH*
Sampl
Initial Vj
<0
>0
>0
e Description
Initial pH*
-
£7.6
>7.6

Calculation
Procedure
A
B
C

Section No.
4.11.2
4.11.3
4.11.4
           NOTE:  For blank analyses, calculate ANC by ANC = Vj Ca/Vsa.
                  Further calculations are not necessary.

          Further calculations are based on this initial  estimate of Vj  and the
          initial sample pH*.  Table 4.1 below lists the  appropriate calcula-
          tion procedure for the various combinations of  Vj and initial  sample
          pH*.

4.11.1.3   Throughout the calculations, there are several  equations and
           constants that are frequently used.  These are  listed in Table  4.2.

4.11.2 Calculation Procedure A (Initial Yj <0)

4.11.2.1   From the base titration data, determine which  data set (V,  pH*)
           has the pH* nearest (but not exceeding) a pH =  8.2.   As an initial
           estimate, set the equivalence volume V? equal  to the volume of  this
           data set.  Next, calculate initial estimates of ANC, BNC, and C by:
                                       ANC  =
                                               Vsa

                  Ca  =  concentration of acid titrant

                 Vsa  =  original  sample volume (acid titration)

                                               V2Cb
                                       BNC  =  -
                                               Vsb

-------
                                                                Section 4.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 22 of 27
          TABLE 4.2.  LIST OF FREQUENTLY USED EQUATIONS AND CONSTANTS
     No.
       Equation
1 Flc = (Vs + V)
" CtCH*]!^ + 2 KjKg) Kw
r H^* ~\ *• 4- r H^" n K 4* n n r H*^* i

                      2c
                          =  (V
V)
                                           C([H+:i2 -
                                        [H+]2 + [H*]Kj
Constants
and
variable
Vs
V
C
[H+]
Kl
K2
Kw
=
Total initial sample volume
Cumulative volume of titrant
Total carbonate expressed in
Hydrogen ion concentration
4.4463 x 10"7 at 25 Q
4.6881 x 10"n at 25 C
1.01 x 10"14 at 25 C
added
moles/L
                  Cfo  =  concentration of base titrant

                 vsb  =  original  sample volume (base titration)

                  C   =  total  carbonate  =  ANC + BNC

4.11.2.2  Calculate the Gran function Fic for the first 7 to 8 points of the
          base titration by using equation 1, Table 4.2.  Plot Fic versus Vf,.
          Perform a linear regression with the points lying on trie linear
          portion of the plot.   Determine the coefficients of the line Fjc =
          a + bV.  The coefficient r should exceed 0.999.  If it  does not,
          examine the plot to ensure that only points on the linear portion
          are used.  From the coefficients, calculate a new estimate of Vj by:

                                       Y!  =  -a/b

          Next, calculate the Gran function F2c (equation 2, Table 4.2) for
          data from the base titration across the current estimate of V2.  (Use
          the first 4 to 6 sets with a volume less than V2 and the first 6 to  8
          sets with a volume greater than V2.)  Plot F2c versus V^.  The data
          should lie on a straight line with the equation F2c = a + bV.  Per-
          form a linear regression of F2c on V^ and determine the coefficients
          of the line.  If r <0.999 reexamine the data to ensure  that only

-------
                                                                Section 4.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 23 of 27


           points on the linear portion were used in the regression.  Calculate
           a new estimate of V2 by:

                                   V2  =  -a/b

4.11.2.3   Calculate new estimates of ANC, BNC, and C by using the new estimates
           of Vi and V2 (an asterisk indicates a new value).
                                              v2cb
                   ANC*  =  - ;   BNC*  =  - ;    C*  =  ANC + BNC
                             Vsb
4.11.2.4   Compare the latest two values for total  carbonate.   If


                                             >0.001
           then calculate a new estimate for C by:

                                   C(new)  =  (C + C*)/2

           Using the new value for C, repeat the calculations in 4.11.2.2
           through 4.11.2.4.  Continue repeating the calculations until  the
           relative difference between C and C* is less than 0.001.

           When the expression is less than 0.001, convert the final  values for
           ANC, BNC, and C to ueq/L by:
                               ANC (peq/L)   =  ANC (eq/L)  x

                               BNC (ueq/L)   =  BNC (eq/L)  x

                                 C (ueq/L)   =  C (eq/L)  x

4.11.3 Calculation Procedure B (Initial  Vi  >0, Initial  pH* £7.6)

4.11.3.1   From the base titration data, determine which data set (V,  pH*)  has
           the pH* nearest but not exceeding 8.2.   As an initial  estimate,
           set the equivalence volume V2 equal to  the volume of this data set.
           Next calculate initial  estimates of ANC, BNC, and C by:
                                              V2Cb
                    ANC  =  -  ;    BNC  =  -  ;    C  =  ANC + BNC
                              sa               Vsb

-------
                                                                Section 4.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 24 of 27
4.11.3.2
4.11.3.3
4.11.3.4
Calculate the Gran function Flc (equation 1) for data sets from the
acid titration with volumes across the current estimate of V^ (use
the first 4 to 6 sets with volumes less than V^ and the first 6 to 8
sets with volumes greater than Vj).  Plot Flc versus Va.  The data
should lie on a line with the equation Fjr = a + bV.  Perform a
linear regression of Fjc on Va and determine the coefficients of the
line.  If r does not exceed 0.999, reexamine the data to ensure that
no outliers were used in the regression.  Calculate a new estimate
for YI by:

                            Vj  =  -a/b

Next, calculate the Gran function ?2c (equation 2)  for data sets
from the base titration with volumes across the current estimate of
V?.  (Use the first 4 to 6 sets with volumes less than V2 and the
first 6 to 8 sets with volumes greater than V2).  Plot F2c ver$us
V(j.  The data should lie on a line with the equation F2C = a + bV.
Perform a linear regression of F2c on vb and determine the coeffi-
cients of the line.  If r does not exceed 0.999, reexamine the data
to ensure that only data on the linear portion were included in the
regression.  Calculate a new estimate for Y2 by:

                            V2  =  -a/b

Calculate new estimates of ANC, BNC, and C using the latest
estimates of Vj and V2.
          ANC*  =
                                        BNC*  =
C*  =  ANC + BNC
                                sa
                                              >0.001
Compare the latest two values for total  carbonate.   If:

                          C - C*

                          C + C*

then calculate a new estimate of C by:

                       C(new)  =  (C +  C*)/2

Using the new value of C, repeat the calculations in 4.11.3.2
through 4.11.3.4.  Continue repeating the calculations until  the
above expression is less than 0.001.

When the expression is less than 0.001,  convert the final  values for
ANC, BNC, and C to ueq/L by:

-------
                                                                Section 4.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 25 of 27


                             ANC (Meq/L)  =  ANC (eq/L)  x 106
                             BNC (Meq/L)  =  BNC (eq/L)  x 106
                               C (ueq/L)  =  C (eq/L)  x  106

4.11.4 Calculation Procedure C (Initial  Vj >0, Initial  pH* >7.6)

4.11.4.1  Obtain an initial  estimate of the equivalence  volume Y2 by following
          the procedure in 4.11.4.1.1 if the initial  sample pH* >8.2.   If the
          initial sample pH* <8.2,  then follow the procedure in "4".11.4.1.2.

          From the acid titration data, determine which  data set (V, pH*) has
          the pH* nearest but not exceeding 8.2.  As  an  initial estimate, set
          the equivalence volume V2 equal  to the volume  of this data set.  Go
          to section 4.11.4.1.3.

          Using data sets from the acid titration with pH* values across a
          pH = 7 (use 4 to 6 sets with a pH* <7 and 4 to 6 sets with a pH* >7),
          calculate the Gran function F2a by:

                                  F2a  =  (Vj - Va) [H+]

          Plot F2a versus Va.  The data should lie on a  straight line with the
          equation F2a = a + bV.  Perform a linear regression of F2a on Va.
          The coefficient r should exceed 0.999.  If  it  does not, reexamine the
          plot to ensure that only data on the linear portion were used in the
          calculation.  Calculate a new estimate for  V2  by:

                                    V2  =  -a/b

          Calculate estimates of ANC, BNC, and C by:

                             vlca               'V2ca
                     ANC  =  	  ;    BNC  =  	  ;   C  =  ANC + BNC
                             Vsa                 Vsa

4.11.4.2  Calculate the Gran function Flc (equation 1)  for data sets from the
          acid titration with volumes across the current estimate of Vj (use
          the first 4 to 6 sets with volumes less than Vj and the first 6 to 8
          sets with volumes greater than Vi).  Plot Fig  versus Va.  The data
          should lie on a straight line with the equation Fjc = a + bVa.  Per-
          form a linear regression of Flc on Va and determine the coefficients
          of the line.  The coefficient r should exceed  0.999.  If it does not,
          reexamine the plot to ensure that only data on the linear portion
          were included in the regression.  Calculate a  new estimate for Vj by:

                                     Vj  =  -a/b

-------
                                                                Section 4.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 26 of 27


           Next, calculate the Gran function F2c (equation 2)  for data sets
           from the acid titration with volumes across the current estimate of
           V2 (use the first 4 to 6 sets with volumes less than V2 and the
           first 6 to 8 sets with volumes greater than V2).   Plot F2c  versus
           Va.  The data should lie on a straight line with  the equation F2c
           = a + bV.  Perform a linear regression of F2c on  Va and determine
           the coefficients of the line.  The coefficient r  should exceed
           0.999.  If it does not, reexamine the plot to ensure that only data
           on the linear portion were included in the regression.  Calculate a
           new estimate of V2 by:

                                       V2  =  -a/b

4.11.4.3   Calculate new estimates of ANC, BNC, and C by using the latest
           estimates of Vj and V2.


                     ANC*  =  —  ;   BNC*  =  —~ ;   C*   =  ANC  + BNC
                               vsa                vsa

4.11.4.4   Compare the latest two values for total  carbonate.   If:


                                              >0.001
           then calculate a new estimate of C by:

                                  C{new)  =  (C +  C*)/2

           Using this new value of C, repeat the calculations in 4.11.4.2
           through 4.11.4.4.  Continue repeating the calculations until  the
           above expression is less than 0.001.

           When the expression is less than 0.001, convert the final  values  for
           ANC, BNC, and C to ueq/L by:
                             ANC (ueq/L)   =  ANC (eq/L)  x
                             BNC (ueq/L)   =  BNC (eq/L)  x  106
                               C (ueq/L)   =  C (eq/L)  x  106
4.12   References
       American Society for Testing and Materials,  1984.   Annual  Book of ASTM
            Standards, Vol. 11.01, Standard Specification for Reagent Water,
            D 1193-77 (reapproved 1983).  ASTM, Philadelphia, Pennsylvania.

-------
                                                         Section 4.0
                                                         Revision 2
                                                         Date:   11/86
                                                         Page 27 of 27
Butler, J. N., 1982.  Carbon Dioxide Equilibria and Their Applications.
     Addison-Wesley Publications, Reading, Massachusetts.

Gran, G., 1952.  Determination of the Equivalence Point in Potentio-
     metric Titrations.  Part II.  Analyst, v. 77, pp.  661-671.

Kramer, J. R., 1982.  ANC and BNC.  Ir±:  R. A. Minear and L.  H.  Keith
     (eds.), Water Analysis, Vol. 1.  Inorganic Species, Part 1.
     Academic Press, Orlando, Florida.

Kramer, J. R., 1984.  Modified Gran Analysis for Acid and Base Titra-
     tions.  Environmental  Geochemistry Report No. 1984-2. McMaster
     University, Hamilton,  Ontario, Canada.

McQuaker, N. R., P. D. Kluckner, and D. K. Sandberg, 1983. Chemical
     Analysis of Acid Precipitation:  pH and BNC Determinations.
     Environ. Sci. Technol., v. 17, n.  7, pp. 431-435.

National Bureau of Standards, 1982.  Simulated Precipitation  Reference
     Materials, IV.  NBSIR 82-2581.  U.S. Department of Commerce -  NBS,
     Washington, D.C.

U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, 1983 (revised).  Methods for
     Chemical Analysis of Water and Wastes, Method 150.1, pH.  EPA-600/
     4-79-020.  U.S. EPA, Cincinnati, Ohio.

-------
                                                                Section 5.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page  1 of 7
5.0  DETERMINATION OF AMMONIUM

5.1  Scope and Application

     This method covers the determination of ammonia in natural  surface waters
     in the range of 0.01 to 2.6 mg/L NH^+.  This range is for photometric
     measurements made at 630 to 660 nm in a 15-mm or 50-mrn tubular flow cell.
     Higher concentrations can be determined by sample dilution.   Approximately
     20 to 60 samples per hour can be analyzed.

5.2  Summary of Method

     Alkaline phenol and hypochlorite react with ammonia to form an amount
     of indophenol blue that is proportional to the ammonium concentration.
     The blue color formed is intensified with sodium nitroprusside (U.S.
     EPA, 1983).

5.3  Interferences

     Calcium and magnesium ions may be present in concentration  sufficient to
     cause precipitation problems during analysis.  A 5 percent  EDTA solution
     is used to prevent the precipitation of calcium and magnesium ions.

     Sample turbidity may interfere with this method.  Turbidity is removed
     by filtration at the field station.  Sample color that absorbs in the
     photometric range used also interferes.

5.4  Safety

     The calibration standards, sample types, and most reagents  used in this
     method pose no hazard to the analyst.  Use protective clothing (lab coat
     and gloves) and safety glasses when preparing reagents.

5.5  Apparatus and Equipment

5.5.1  Technicon AutoAnalyzer Unit (AAI or AAII) consisting of:

5,5.1.1  Sampler.

5.5.1.2  Manifold (AAI) or Analytical Cartridge (AAII).

5.5.1.3  Proportioning pump.

5.5.1.4  Heating bath with double-delay coil (AAI).

5.5.1.5  Colorimeter equipped with 15-mm tubular flow cell and 630- to 660-nm
         filters.

-------
                                                                Section 5.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 2 of 7
5.5.1.6  Recorder.
5.5.1.7  Digital printer for AAII (optional).
5.6  Reagents and Consumable Materials
5.6.1  Water
       Water must meet the specifications for Type I Reagent Water given in
       ASTM D 1193 (ASTM, 1984).
5.6.2  Sulfuric Acid (5N) - Air Scrubber Solution
       Carefully add 139 ml concentrated sulfuric acid to approximately 500 ml
       ammonia-free water.   Cool to room temperature and dilute to 1 L with
       water.
5.6.3  Sodium Phenol ate Solution
       Using a 1-L Erlenmeyer flask, dissolve 83 g phenol in 500 mL water.   In
       small increments, cautiously add with agitation 32 g NaOH.  Periodically
       cool flask under flowing tap water.   When cool, dilute to 1 L with water.
5.6.4  Sodium Hypochlorite Solution
       Dilute 150 ml of a bleach solution containing 5.25 percent NaOCl  (such
       as "Clorox") to 500 ml with water.  Available chlorine level  should
       approximate 2 to 3 percent.  Clorox is a proprietary product, and its
       formulation is subject to change.  The analyst must remain alert to
       detecting any variation in this product significant to its use in this
       procedure.  Because of the instability of this product, storage over an
       extended period should be avoided.
5.6.5  Disodium Ethylenediamine-Tetraacetate (EDTA)  (5 percent w/v)
       Dissolve 50 g EDTA (disodium salt) and approximately six pellets NaOH in
       1 L water.
5.6.6  Sodium Nitroprusside (0.05 percent w/v)
       Dissolve 0.5 g sodium nitroprusside in 1 L deionized water.
5.6.7  NH4+ Stock Standard Solution (1,000 mg/L)
       Dissolve 2.9654 g anhydrous ammonium chloride, NfyCl (dried at 105°C for
       2 hours), in water,  and dilute to 1,000 ml.

-------
                                                                Section 5.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 3 of 7
5.6.8  Standard Solution A (10.00 mg/L NH4+)

       Dilute 10.0 ml NH4+ stock standard solution to 1,000 ml with water.

5.6.9  Standard Solution B (1.000 mg/L NH4+)

       Dilute 10.0 ml standard solution A to 100.0 ml with water.

5.6.10 Using standard solutions A and B, prepare (fresh daily) the following
       standards in 100-mL volumetric flasks:

              NH^ (mg/L)                    mL Standard Solution/100 mL

                                                     Solution B

                 0.01                                    1.0
                 0.02                                    2.0
                 0.05                                    5.0
                 0.10                                   10.0

                                                     Solution A

                 0.20                                    2.0
                 0.50                                    5.0
                 0.80                                    8.0
                 1.00                                   10.0
                 1.50                                   15.0
                 2.00                                   20.0

5.7  Sample Collection, Preservation, and Storage

     Samples are collected, filtered, and preserved (addition of ^$04 until
     pH <2) in the field.  The samples must be stored at 4°C when not in use.

5.8  Calibration and Standardization

     Analyze the series of ammonium standards as described in section 5.10.

     Prepare a calibration curve by plotting the peak height versus standard
     concentration.

5.9  Quality Control

       The required QC is described in section 3.4.

-------
                                                                Section 5.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page 4 of 7
5.10 Procedure

5.10.1 Since the intensity of the color used to quantify the concentration is
       pH-dependent, the acid concentration of the wash water and the standard
       ammonium solutions should approximate that of the samples.  For example,
       if the samples have been preserved with 2 mL concentrated H2S04/L, the
       wash water and standards should also contain 2 ml concentrated H2S04/L.

5.10.2 For a working range of 0.01 to 2.6 mg/L NH4+ (AAI), set up the manifold
       as shown in Figure 5.1.  For a working range of 0.01 to 1.3 mg/L NH4+
       (AAII), set up the manifold as shown in Figure 5.2.  Higher concentra-
       tions may be accommodated by sample dilution.

5.10.3 Allow both colorimeter and recorder to warm up for 30 minutes.  Obtain a
       stable baseline with all reagents by feeding distilled water through
       sample line.

5.10.4 For the AAI system, sample at a rate of 20/hr, 1:1.  For the AAII use a
       60/hr 6:1 cam with a common wash.

5.10.5 Load sampler tray with unknown samples.

5.10.6 Switch sample line from water to sampler and begin analysis.

5.10.7 Dilute and reanalyze samples with an ammonia concentration exceeding the
       calibrated concentration range.

5.11 Calculations

     Compute concentration of samples by comparing sample peak heights with
     calibration curve.   Report results in mg/L NH4 .

5.12 Precision and Accuracy

     In a single laboratory (EMSL-Cincinnati), when use was made of surface-
     water samples at concentrations of 1.41, 0.77, 0.59, and 0.43 mg NH3-N/L,
     the standard deviation was ±0.005 (U.S. EPA, 1983).

     In a single laboratory (EMSL-Cincinnati), when use was made of surface-
     water samples at concentrations of 0.16 and 1.44 mg NH3-N/L, recoveries
     were 107 percent and 99 percent, respectively (U.S. EPA, 1983).  These
     recoveries are statistically significantly different from 100 percent.

-------
                                                                Section 5.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 5 of 7
5.13 References

     American Society for Testing and Materials,  1984.   Annual  Book of ASTM
          Standards, Vol. 11.01, Standard Specification for Reagent Water,
          D 1193-77 (reapproved 1983).  ASTM, Philadelphia, Pennsylvania.

     U.S. Environmental  Protection Agency, 1983 (revised).   Methods for Chemical
          Analysis of Water and Wastes,  Method 350.1,  Ammonia Nitrogen.  EPA-
          600/4-79-020.   U.S.  EPA, Cincinnati, Ohio.

-------
PROPORTIONING
SM» SMALL MIXING CO
LM* LARGE MIXING C
i
HEATING f
BATH37»CV
1
WASI
TOS
IL
OIL
LM
00000000
t
LM
00000000
SM OOOO 1
) r
t
1
H WATER
AMPLER
SM
OOOO





•
(WASTE

r1


















\ 1









PUMP
P B
G G
R R
G G
W W
W W
R R
P P

ml/mln
2.9 WASH
2.0 SAMPLE c
)
SAMPLER
O.8 EOTA 2O/ hr.
2.O AIR*
O.6 PHENOLATE
0.6 HYPOCHLORITE
0.6 NITROPRUSSJOE
?«?
| WASTE
RECORDER
COLORIMETER 5N"H~6Cr 	
15 mm FLOW CELL 2 4
650- 660 nm FILTER
Figure 5.1. Ammonia manifold AAI.
-o o -ya co
to c+ < o
n> (T) — '• r+
o> ~J* o
0 3
01—3
-hi— 01
— . ro •
->J 00 O

-------
WASH WATER
TO SAMPLER
oono
HEATING
BATH
50* C
„
\














W*3 1 b
-<
^ \
»l IHI 1


j
J

RECORDER
*.

1









PROPORTIONING
PUMP
i
G G
0
O
R
0
W
0
R
0
BLACK
0
0
BLUE

o

DIGITAL
PRINTER
nl/mln.
2.0 WASH
O.23 AIR*
0.42 SAMPLE
0.6 EDTA
0.42 PHENOLATE
SAMPLER
60/hr.
61
0
_J

032 HYPOCHLORITE
0.42 NITROPRUSSIDE

.»
e/»Diionm TMQ
niifsu
COLORIMETER
SO mm FLOW  CELL
650-660 nm  FILTER
5N  H2S04
              Figure 5.2.  Ammonia Manifold  AAII.
                              "o o 30 oo
                              &> &> n> n>
                              
                              fl> n> -•• r+
                                .. M _«.
                              •^J  ->. o
                                  O =J
                              O I-1 3
                              -hi—'   in
                                •—. ro •
                              ~J OO   O
                                CT>

-------
                                                                Section 6.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 1 of 6
6.0  DETERMINATION OF CHLORIDE, NITRATE, AND SULFATE BY ION CHROMATOGRAPHY

6.1  Scope and Application

     This method is applicable to the determination of chloride,  nitrate,  and
     sulfate in natural  surface waters by ion chromatography (1C).

     This method is restricted to use by or under the supervision of analysts
     experienced in the  use of ion chromatography and in the interpretation  of
     the resulting ion chromatogram.

6.2  Summary of Method

     Samples are analyzed by 1C.  1C is a liquid chromatographic  technique
     that combines ion exchange chromatography, eluent suppression,  and
     conductimetric detection.

     A filtered sample portion is injected into an ion chromatograph.   The
     sample is pumped through a precolumn, separator column, suppressor
     column, and a conductivity detector.  The precolumn and separator
     column are packed with a low-capacity anion exchange resin.   The  sample
     anions are separated in these two columns with the separation  being
     based on their affinity for the resin exchange sites.

     The suppressor column reduces the conductivity of the eluent to a low
     level and converts  the sample anions to their acid form.  Typical
     reactions in the suppressor column are:

                   Na+ HC03" + R - H    —>   HoC03 + R - Na
                  (high-conductivity eluant)   (Tow conductivity)

                         Na+ A" + R - H  	> HA + R - Na

     Three types of suppressor columns are available:  the packed-bed
     suppressor, the fiber suppressor, and the micromembrane suppressor.  The
     packed-bed suppressor contains a high-capacity cation exchange  resin  in
     the hydrogen form.   It is consumed during analysis and must  be  periodi-
     cally regenerated off-line.  The latter two suppressors are  based on
     cation exchange membranes.  These suppressors are continuously  regene-
     rated throughout the analysis.  Also, their dead volume is substantially
     less than that of a packed-bed suppressor.  For these two reasons, the
     latter two suppressors are prefered.

     The separated anions in their acid form are measured by using  a conduc-
     tivity cell.  Anion identification is based on retention time.  Quanti-
     fication is performed by comparing sample peak heights to a  calibration
     curve generated from known standards (ASTM, 1984a; O'Dell et al., 1984;
     Topol and Ozdemir,  1981).

-------
                                                                Section 6.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 2 of 6
6.3  Interferences

     Interferences can be caused by substances with retention times that are
     similar to and overlap those of the anion of interest.   The stream samples
     are not expected to contain any interfering species.   Large amounts of an
     anion can interfere with the peak resolution of an adjacent anion.  Sample
     dilution or spiking can be used to solve most interference problems.

     The water dip or negative peak that elutes near and can interfere with
     the chloride peak can be eliminated by the addition of  the concentrated
     eluant so that the eluant and sample matrix are similar.

     Method interferences may be caused by contaminants in the reagent water,
     reagents, glassware, and other sample processing apparatus that lead  to
     discrete artifacts or elevated baselines in ion chromatograms.

     Samples that contain particles larger than 0.45 microns and reagent
     solutions that contain particles larger than 0.20 microns require
     filtration to prevent damage to instrument columns and  flow systems.

6.4  Safety

     Normal, accepted laboratory safety practices should be  followed during
     reagent preparation and instrument operation.  The calibration standards,
     samples, and most reagents pose no hazard to the analyst.   Protective
     clothing and safety glasses should be worn when handling concentrated
     sulfuric acid.

6.5  Apparatus and Equipment

6.5.1  Ion Chromatograph

       Analytical system complete with ion chromatograph and all accessories
       (conductivity detector, autosampler, data recording system,  etc.).

6.5.2  Anion Pre- and Separator Columns

       Dionex Series AG-4A and AS-4A are recommended for use with the 2000i ion
       chromatographs.  AG-3 and AS-3 columns are recommended for older ion
       chromatographs.

6.5.3  Suppressor Column

       Dionex AFS fiber suppressor or AMMS membrane suppressor is recommended.

-------
                                                                Section 6.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 3 of 6
6.6  Reagents and Consumable Materials

     Unless stated otherwise, all chemicals must be ACS reagent grade or
     better.  Also, salts used in preparation of standards must be dried at
     105°C for 2 hours and stored in a desiccator.

6.6.1  Deionized Water

       Water must meet the specifications for Type I Reagent Water given in
       ASTM D 1193 (ASTM, 1984b).

6.6.2  Eluant Solution (0.0028M NaHC03/0.0020M Na2C03)

       Dissolve 0.94 g sodium bicarbonate (NaHC03)  and  0.85 g sodium car-
       bonate (Na2C03) in water and dilute to 4 L.   This eluant strength may be
       adjusted for different columns according to the  recommendations provided
       by the manufacturer.

6.6.3  Fiber Suppressor Regenerant (0.025N ^04)

       Add 2.8 ml concentrated sulfuric acid (^$04, Baker Ultrex grade or
       equivalent) to 4 L water.

6.6.4  Stock Standard Solutions

6.6.4.1  Sulfate Stock Standard Solution (1,000 mg/L S042")—Dissolve 1.8141 g
         potassium sulfate (K2S04) in water and dilute  to 1.000 L.

6.6.4.2  Chloride Stock Standard Solution (200 mg/L Cl~)--Dissolve 0.3297 g
         sodium chloride (Nad) in water and dilute to  1.000 L.

6.6.4.3  Nitrate Stock Standard Solution (200 mg/L N03~)—Dissolve 0.3261 g
         potassium nitrate (KN03) in water and dilute to 1.000 L.

6.6.4.4  Fluoride Stock Standard Solution (1,000 mg/L F~)--Dissolve 2.2100  g
         sodium fluoride (NaF) in water and dilute to 1.000 L.

6.6.4.5  Phosphate Stock Standard Solution (1,000 mg/L  P)~Dissolve 4.3937  g
         potassium phosphate (KH2P04) in water and dilute to 1.000 L.

6.6.4.6  Bromide Stock Standard Solution (1,000 mg/L Br~)—Dissolve 1.2877  g
         sodium bromide (NaBr) in water and dilute to 1.000 L.

6.6.4.7  Store stock standards in clean polyethylene bottles (cleaned without
         acid by using procedure in Appendix A) at 4°C.  Prepare monthly.

6.6.5  Mixed Resolution Sample (1 mg/L F~, 2 mg/L Cl~,  2 mg/L N03~, 2 mg/L
       P, 2 mg/L Br", 5 mg/L SO/")

-------
                                                                Section 6.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page 4 of 6
       Prepare by appropriate mixing and dilution of the stock standard
       solutions.

6.7  Sample Collection, Preservation, and Storage

     Samples are collected and filtered in the MPL.  Store samples at 4°C when
     not in use.

6.8  Calibration and Standardization

     Each day (or work shift) for each analyte, analyze a blank and a series
     of standards which bracket the expected analyte concentration range as
     described in section 6.10.  Prepare the standards daily by quantitative
     dilution of the stock standard solutions.  Suggested concentrations for
     the dilute standards are given in Table 6.1.


      TABLE 6.1.  SUGGESTED CONCENTRATION OF DILUTE CALIBRATION STANDARDS

                                     Concentration (mg/L)
     Standard              CV
1
2
3
4
5
6
0
0.020
0.10
0.50
1.00
3.00
0
0.020
0.10
0.50
1.00
3.00
0
0.20
0.50
2.00
5.00
10.00
     Prepare a calibration curve for each analyte by plotting peak height
     versus standard concentration.

6.9  Quality Control

     General QC procedures are described in section 3.4.

6.9.1  Resolution Test

       After calibration, analyze the mixed standard containing fluoride,
       chloride, nitrate, phosphate, bromide, and sulfate.  Resolution between
       adjacent peaks must equal or exceed 60 percent.   If not, replace or
       clean the separator column and repeat calibration.

-------
                                                                Section 6.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 5 of 6
6.10 Procedure
6.10.1 Set up the 1C for operation.  Typical operating conditions for a Dionex
       2010i 1C are given in Table 6.2.  Other conditions may be used depending
       upon the columns and system selected.
                  TABLE 6.2.  TYPICAL 1C OPERATING CONDITIONS
==============================================================================
1C:  Dionex 2010i                       Sample Loop Size:  250 uL
Precolumn:  AG-4A
Separator Column:  AS-4A
Suppressor Column:  AMMS
Eluant:  0.75mM NaHC03/2.0mM Na2C03
Eluant Flow Rate:  2.0 mL/min
Regenerant:  0.025N H2S04
Regenerant Flow Rate:  3 mL/min
  Ion                         Typical Retention Time (min)
  cr                                      1.8
  N03~                                     4.9
  S02~                                    8.1
6.10.2 Adjust detector range to cover the concentration range of samples.
6.10.3 Load injection loop (manually or via an autosampler)  with the sample
       (or standard) to be analyzed.  Load five to ten times the volume
       required to thoroughly flush the sample loop.   Inject the sample.
       Measure and record (manually or with a data system) the peak heights for
       each analyte.
6.10.4 Dilute and reanalyze samples with an analyte concentration exceeding the
       calibrated concentration range.

-------
                                                                Section 6.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 6 of 6
6.11 Calculations

     Compute the sample concentration by comparing the sample peak height with
     the calibration curve.

     Report results in mg/L.

6.12 Precision and Accuracy

     Typical single operator results for surface water analyses are listed in
     Table 6.3 (O'Dell et al.. 1984).


   TABLE 6.3.  SINGLE-OPERATOR ACCURACY AND PRECISION (O'Dell et al . ,  1984)a
Ion
CI-
NQ;
so?"
Spike
(mg/L)
1.0
0.5
10.0
Number of
Replicates
7
7
7
Mean %
Recovery
105
100
112
Standard
Deviation (mg/L)
0.14
0.0058
0.71
aThe conditions used by O'Dell  were slightly different than  those  listed  in
 Table 6.2.  However, the results are typical of what is expected.

6.13 References

     American Society for Testing and Materials, 1984a.   Annual  Book of ASTM
          Standards, Vol. 11.01,  Standard Test Method for Anions in Water by
          Ion Chroma tography, D4327-84.   ASTM, Philadelphia,  Pennsylvania.

     American Society for Testing and Materials, 1984b.   Annual  Book of ASTM
          Standards, Vol. 11.01,  Standard Specification  for  Reagent Water,
          D 1193-77 (reapproved 1983).  ASTM, Philadelphia,  Pennsylvania.

     O'Dell, J. W., J. D. Pfaff,  M. E. Gales, and G.  D.  McKee,  1984.  Technical
          Addition to Methods for the Chemical Analysis  of Water and Wastes,
          Method 300.0, The Determination of Inorganic Anions in Water by Ion
          Chroma tography.  EPA-600/4-85-017.  U.S.  Environmental Protection
          Agency, Cincinnati, Ohio.

     Topol, L. E., and S. Ozdemir,  1981.   Quality Assurance  Handbook for  Air
          Pollution Measurement Systems:   Vol. V.  Manual  for Precipitation
          Measurement Systems,  Part II.   Operations and  Maintenance Manual.
          EPA-600/4-82-042b.  U.S.  Environmental Protection  Agency, Research
          Triangle Park, North Carolina.

-------
                                                                Section  7.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page  1 of 8


7.0  DETERMINATION OF DISSOLVED ORGANIC CARBON AND  DISSOLVED  INORGANIC CARBON

7.1  Scope and Application

     This method is applicable to the determination of DIC and  DOC in natural
     surface waters.

     This method is applicable over the concentration  range 0.1 to 30 mg/L DIC
     or DOC.  The method detection limit is about 0.8  mg/L DOC  and 0.1 mg/L
     DIC, as determined from replicate analyses of  a blank sample.

     The method is written with the assumption that a  Dohrman-Xertex  DC-80
     Analyzer is used.  However, any instrumentation having similar operating
     characteristics may also be used.

7.2  Summary of Method

     Two samples, aliquots 4 and 5, are sent to the lab for analysis.  Aliquot
     4 is filtered and preserved in the field (acidified to pH  <2  with
     It is analyzed for DOC.  Aliquot 5 is an unfiltered sample.   It  is
     filtered and analyzed for DIC.

     DOC is determined (after external sparging to  remove DIC)  by  ultraviolet-
     promoted persulfate oxidation which is followed by IR detection.  DIC is
     determined directly by acidifying to generate  C02 which  is followed by IR
     detection (U.S. EPA, 1983; Xertex-Dohrman, 1984).

7.3  Interferences

     No interferences are known.

7.4  Safety

     The sample types, standards, and most reagents pose no hazard to the
     analyst.  Protective clothing (lab coat) and safety glasses should  be worn
     when preparing reagents and operating the instrument.

7.5  Apparatus and Equipment

7.5.1  Disposable plastic Luer-Lok syringes (for DIC samples) equipped with
       Luer-Lok syringe valves.

7.5.2  Carbon Analyzer

       This method is based on the Dohrman DC-80 Carbon Analyzer equipped with
       a high-sensitivity sampler.  The essential components  of the instrument
       are a sample injection valve, UV-reaction chamber,  IR  detector, and

-------
                                                                Section 7.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page 2 of 8


       integrator.  The injection valve should have a 5- to 7-mL sample loop
       and should permit injection with a standard Luer-Lok syringe.  Other
       instruments having similar performance characteristics may also be used.

7.5.3  Reagent Bottle for Standard Storage

       Heavy-wall borosilicate glass bottle with three two-way valves in the
       cap.  Possible sources are Rainin Instrument Co. (Catalog No. 45-3200)
       or Anspec Co. (Catalog No. H8332).

7.6  Reagents and Consumable Materials

7.6.1  DOC Calibration Stock Solution (2,000 mg/L DOC)

       Dissolve 0.4250 g potassium hydrogen phthalate (KHP, primary standard
       grade, dried at 105°C for 2 hours) in water, add 0.10 ml phosphoric acid
       (ACS reagent grade), and dilute to 100.00 ml with water.  Store in an
       amber bottle at 4°C.  Prepare monthly.

7.6.2  Dilute Daily DOC Calibration Solutions

       Using micropipets or volumetric pi pets, prepare the following calibra-
       tion standards daily.

          a.   0.500 mg/L DOC - dilute 0.125 ml DOC stock solution plus 0.5 mL
               phosphoric acid to 500.00 mL with water.
          b.   1.000 mg/L DOC - dilute 0.250 mL DOC stock solution plus 0.5 mL
               phosphoric acid to 500.00 mL with water.
          c.   5.000 mg/L DOC - dilute 1.250 mL DOC stock solution plus 0.5 mL
               phosphoric acid to 500.00 mL with water.
          d.   10.00 mg/L DOC - dilute 2.500 mL DOC stock solution plus 0.5 mL
               phosphoric acid to 500.00 mL with water.
          e.   30.00 mg/L DOC - dilute 3.750 mL DOC stock solution plus 0.25 mL
               phosphoric acid to 250.00 mL with water.

          Store in amber bottles at 4°C.

7.6.3  DOC QC Stock Solution (1,000 mg/L DOC)

       Dissolve 0.5313 g KHP in water, add 0.25 mL phosphoric acid, then dilute
       to 250.00 mL with water.  Store in an amber bottle at 4°C.  The QC stock
       solution must be prepared by using an independent source of KHP.  Prepare
       monthly.

7.6.4  Dilute Daily DOC QC Solutions

       Prepare the following QC samples daily.

-------
                                                                Section  7.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page  3 of 8


          a.   0.500 mg/L DOC (Detection Limit QC Sample - DL QCCS) - dilute
               0.250 ml QC stock solution plus 0.5 mL phosphoric acid to 500.00
               ml with water.
          b.   10.00 mg/L DOC - dilute 2.500 mL QC stock solution plus 0.25 mL
               phosphoric acid to 250.00 mL with water.
          c.   30.00 mg/L DOC - dilute 3.000 mL QC stock solution plus 0.1 mL
               phosphoric acid to 100.00 mL with water.

          Store in amber bottles at 4°C.

7.6.5  DIC Calibration Stock Solution (2,000 mg/L DIC)

       Dissolve 4.4131 g sodium carbonate (Na£C03, primary standard grade,
       freshly dried at 105°C for 2 hours)  in water and  dilute to 250.00 mL
       with water.  Store in a tightly capped bottle under a C02~free atmos-
       phere.  Prepare weekly.

7.6.6  Dilute DIC Calibration Solutions

       Prepare the following calibration standards daily.

          a.  0.500 mg/L DIC - dilute 0.250 mL DIC stock solution to  1.000 L
              with water.
          b.  1.000 mg/L DIC - dilute 0.250 mL DIC stock solution to  500.00 mL
              with water.
          c.  5.000 mg/L DIC - dilute 1.250 mL DIC stock solution to  500.00 mL
              with water.
          d.  10.00 mg/L DIC - dilute 2.500 mL DIC stock solution to  500.00 mL
              with water.
          f.  30.00 mg/L DIC - dilute 3.750 mL DIC stock solution to  250.00 mL
              with water.

       Store in tightly capped bottles under a C02~free  atmosphere.

7.6.7  DIC QC Stock Solution (1,000 mg/L DIC)

       Dissolve 2.2065 g Na2C03 in water and dilute to 250.00 mL with water.
       Store in a tightly capped bottle under a C02~free atmosphere.  The QC
       stock solution must be prepared with N32C03 from  a  source (bottle, lot,
       supplier)  different from that used to prepare the calibration  solution.

7.6.8  Dilute DIC QC Solutions

       Prepare the following QC samples daily.

          a.  0.500 mg/L DIC (Detection Limit QC Sample  -  DL QCCS) -  dilute
              0.250 mL QC stock solution to 500.00 mL with water.

-------
                                                                Section 7.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 4 of 8


          b.  10.00 mg/L DIG - dilute 2.500 mL QC stock solution to 250.00 ml
              with water.
          c.  30.00 mg/L DIG - dilute 3.000 mL QC stock solution to 100.00 mL
              with water.

7.6.9  Potassium Persulfate Reagent (2 percent w/v)
       Dissolve 20 g potassium per sul fate (I^SgOa, ACS reagent grade or better)
       in water, add 2.0 mL phosphoric acid, then dilute to 1.0 L with water.
       This reagent is used for DOC analyses.

7.6.10 Phosphoric Acid Reagent (5 percent v/v)

       Dilute 50.0 mL concentrated phosphoric acid (ACS reagent grade) to 1.0 L
       with water.  This reagent is used for DIG analyses.

7.6.11 Water

       Water must meet the specifications for Type I  Reagent Water given in
       ASTM D 1193 (ASTM, 1984).

7.7  Sample Collection, Preservation, and Storage

     The sample for DOC analysis (aliquot 4) is collected,  filtered, and
     preserved in the field (pH adjusted to less than 2 with sul f uric acid).
     Store at 4°C when not in use.

     The sample for DIG analysis (aliquot 5) is collected in the  field and is
     not filtered or preserved.  Store at 4°C and minimize  atmospheric
     exposure.

7.8  Calibration and Standardization

7.8.1  DOC Calibration

7.8.1.1  Set-up—Set up the instrument according to the instructions provided by
         the manufacturer.  Adjust all liquid and gas flow  rates.  Turn on UV
         lamp and allow the system to stabilize.  The IR detector must warm up
         for at least 2 hours.  For best results, leave the IR detector on at
         all times.

7.8.1.2  Routine Calibration—For the range of interest (0  to 30  mg/L DOC), the
         instrument is designed to be calibrated with a single 10.00 mg/L DOC
         standard.  The linearity of the calibration  is checked with the QC
         samples.  If acceptable results are not obtained for the QC samples,
         the instrument must be calibrated by using the procedure in section
         7.8.1.3.

-------
                                                                Section  7.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page  5  of 8


         Sparge the 10.00-mg/L calibration standard for 5 to 6 minutes  with
         C02~free gas.

         Following the  instructions in the operating manual, calibrate  the
         instrument by  using three replicate analyses of the 10.00-mg/L  standard.

         Analyze a system blank and a reagent blank.  Both must contain  less
         than 0.1 mg/L  DOC.  If either contains more DOC, then the water is
         contaminated.   In this case, all  standards and reagents must be
         prepared again with DOC-free water, and the instrument must  be
         recalibrated.

         After sparging for 5 to 6 minutes, analyze the 0.500, 10.00,  and 30.00
         mg/L QC samples.   Acceptable results are 0.50 ± 0.10, 10.0 ± 0.5, and
         30.0 ± 1.5 mg/L,  respectively.   If acceptable results are not  obtained
         for all QC samples, the instrument calibration is inadequate (non-
         linear).  In this case, recalibrate the instrument by using  the procedure
         in section 7.8.1.3.

7.8.1.3  Nonroutine Calibration—If the inherent instrument calibration  pro-
         cedure is inadequate (nonlinear over the range of interest),  then the
         instrument must be calibrated manually.  This is done by analyzing a
         series of calibration standards and by generating a calibration curve
         by plotting instrument response versus standard concentration.   Sample
         concentrations are then determined by inverse interpolation.   The
         procedure is outlined in the following sections.

         Sparge the 0.500, 1.000, 5.000, 10.00, and 30.00 mg/L DOC calibration
         standard for 5 to 6 minutes with COg-free gas.

         Erase the instrument calibration (if present).  Analyze each standard
         and record the uncalibrated response.

         Plot the response versus standard concentration.  Draw or calculate
         (using linear  regression) the best calibration curve.

         Analyze a system blank and a reagent blank.  From their response and
         the calibration curve, determine their concentrations.  Both must
         contain less than 0.1 mg/L DOC.  If either contains more than  0.1 mg/L
         DOC, then the  water is contaminated.  In this case, the standards and
         reagents must  be  prepared again by using DOC-free water, and the
         instrument must be recalibrated.

         After sparging for 5 to 6 minutes, analyze the 0.500 and 10.00  mg/L  QC
         samples.  From their response and the calibration curve, determine the
         concentration  of  each QC sample.   Acceptable results are 0.5 ±  0.1 and
         10.0 ± 0.5 mg/L,  respectively.   If unacceptable results are  obtained,

-------
                                                                Section 7.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 6 of 8


           the calibration standards must be prepared again and reanalyzed.
           Acceptable results must be obtained prior to sample analysis.

7.8.2  DIG Calibration

7.8.2.1  Set-up—Set up the instrument according to the instructions provided
         by the manufacturer.  Adjust all liquid and gas flow rates, using 5
         percent phosphoric acid as the reagent.  Do not turn on the UV lamp.
         Allow the system to stabilize.

7.8.2.2  Routine Calibration—The calibration procedure is identical to that
         for DOC (section 7.8.1.2) with the exception that the DIC standards
         are not sparged prior to analysis.

7.8.2.3  Nonroutine Calibration—The nonroutine calibration procedure  is
         identical to that for DOC (section 7.8.1.3) with the exception that
         the DIC standards are not sparged prior to analysis.

7.9  Quality Control

7.9.1    In addition to the QC inherent in the calibration procedures  (section
         7.8), the QC procedures described in section 3.4 must be performed.

7.10  Procedure

7.10.1  DOC Analysis

7.10.1.1  Calibrate the carbon analyzer for DOC.

7.10.1.2  Sparge samples with fX^-free gas for 5 to 6 minutes (sparge  gas
          should have a flow of 100 to 200 cc/min).  Load and analyze  the
          sample as directed by the instrument operating manual.

7.10.2  DIC Analysis

7.10.2.1  Calibrate the carbon analyzer for DIC.

7.10.2.2  Routine Determination

          Rinse a clean syringe with sample.  'Withdraw a fresh sample  portion
          into the syringe.  Attach a syringe filter (0.45 urn)  and simultane-
          ously filter the sample and inject it into the carbon analyzer.
          Analyze as directed by the instrument operating manual.

          For QA reasons, it is very important that the DIC is measured at the
          same time pH is measured (section 4).

-------
                                                                Section  7.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page  7 of 8
7.10.2.3  Air-Equilibrated Determination
          As described in section 4.10.3, equilibrate the sample with 300 ppm
          C02 in air.  Rinse a clean syringe with the air-equilibrated sample.
          Withdraw a fresh portion of the air-equilibrated sample and attach  a
          syringe filter (0.45 urn).   Simultaneously filter and inject the
          sample into the carbon analyzer.  Analyze as directed by the
          instrument operating manual.

          For QA reasons, it is very important that the DIG be measured at the
          same time pH is measured.

7.11  Calculations

      If the routine calibration procedure is satisfactory, the instrument
      outputs the sample results directly in mg/L.   DOC or DIC calculations are
      not necessary.

      If a calibration curve is necessary, determine the sample concentration
      by comparing the sample response  to the calibration curve.  Report
      results as mg/L DOC or DIC.

7.12  Precision and Accuracy

7.12.1  Precision - DOC

        In a single laboratory (MERL-Cincinnati), using raw river water,
        centrifuged river water, drinking water,  and the effluent from a carbon
        column which had concentrations of 3.11,  3.10, 1.79,  and 0.07 mg/L
        total organic carbon respectively, the standard deviations from 10
        replicates were 0.13, 0.03,  0.02, and 0.02 mg/L, respectively (U.S.
        EPA, 1983).

7.12.2  Bias - DOC

        In a single laboratory (MERL-Cincinnati), using potassium hydrogen
        phthalate in distilled water at concentrations between 5.0 and 1.0
        mg/L total organic carbon, recoveries were 80 percent and 91  percent,
        respectively (U.S. EPA, 1983).

7.13  References

      American Society for Testing and  Materials, 1984.  Annual  Book  of ASTM
           Standards, Vol. 11.01, Standard Specification for Reagent  Water,
           D 1193-77 (reapproved 1983).  ASTM, Philadelphia,  Pennsylvania.

-------
                                                          Section 7.0
                                                          Revision 2
                                                          Date:   11/86
                                                          Page 8 of 8


U.S. Environmental  Protection Agency,  1983 (revised).   Methods for
     Chemical Analysis of Water and Wastes,  Method 415.2,  Organic Carbon,
     Total (low level) (UV promoted, persulfate oxidation).   EPA-600/4-
     79-020.  U.S.  EPA, Cincinnati, Ohio.

Xertex-Dohrman Corporation,  1984.   DC-80 Automated Laboratory Total
     Organic Carbon Analyzer Systems Manual, 6th Ed.   Xertex-Dohrman,
     Santa Clara,  California.

-------
                                                                Section 8.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page 1 of 6
8.0  DETERMINATION OF TOTAL DISSOLVED FLUORIDE BY ION-SELECTIVE ELECTRODE

8.1  Scope and Application

     This method is applicable to the determination of total dissolved fluoride
     in natural surface waters, using a fluoride ion-selective electrode (ISE).
     The applicable concentration range is 0.005 to 2 mg/L fluoride (F~).

8.2  Summary of Method

     The total dissolved fluoride in a sample is determined electrometrically by
     using a fluoride ion-selective electrode after addition to the sample of
     a total ionic strength buffer solution (TISAB).  The TISAB adjusts sample
     ionic strength and pH and breaks up fluoride complexes.

     The potential of the fluoride ISE varies logarithmically as a function of
     the fluoride concentration.  A calibration curve is prepared by measuring
     the potential of known fluoride standards (after TISAB addition)  and by
     plotting the potential versus fluoride concentration (on a semi-log scale).
     Sample concentrations are determined by comparing the sample potential to
     the calibration curve.

     This method is based on existing methods (U.S. EPA, 1983; Barnard and
     Nordstrom, 1982; Bauman, 1971; LaZerte, 1984; Kissa, 1983; Warner and
     Bressan, 1973).

8.3  Interferences

     The electrode potential is partially a function of temperature.  As a
     result, standards and samples must be equilibrated to the same temperature
     The sample pH must be in the range 5 to 7 to avoid complexation of fluoride
     by hydronium (pH <5) and hydroxide (pH >7).  The addition of TISAB to
     samples and standards ensures that the pH is maintained in the correct
     range.

     Polyvalent cations may interfere by complexing fluoride,  thereby preventing
     detection by the electrode.  The TISAB solution contains  a decomplexing
     agent to avoid potential interferences from polyvalent cations.
8.4  Safety
     The sample types, calibration standards, and most reagents pose no hazard
     to the analyst.  Protective clothing (lab coat and gloves) and safety
     glasses must be worn when handling concentrated sodium hydroxide.

-------
                                                                Section 8.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page 2 of 6
     Fluoride is ubiquitous.  Good laboratory practices and extra care must be
     used in order to minimize contamination of samples and standards.
8.5  Apparatus and Equipment
8.5.1  Digital electrometer (pH/mV meter) with expanded mV scale capable of
       reading 0.1 mV.
8.5.2  Combination Reference - Fluoride ion selective electrode.
8.5.3  Thermally isolated magnetic stirrer and Teflon-coated stir bar.
8.6  Reagents and Consumable Materials
     Unless otherwise specified, all chemicals must be ACS reagent grade or
     better.  Use only plasticware (cleaned as described in Appendix A)  for
     reagent preparation.
8.6.1  TISAB Solution
       To approximately 500 ml water in a 1-L beaker, add 57 mL glacial  acetic
       acid (Baker Ultrex grade or equivalent), 4 g CDTA*, and 58 g sodium
       chloride (NaCl, ultrapure).  Stir to dissolve, and cool to room tempera-
       ture.  Adjust the pH of the solution to between 5.0 and 5.5 with  5N NaOH
       (about 150 ml will be required).  Transfer the solution to a 1-L  volu-
       metric flask and dilute to the mark with water.  Transfer to a clean
       polyethylene (LPE) bottle.  (Note:  Alternatively, commercially avail-
       able TISAB solution may be used.)
8.6.2  Sodium Hydroxide Solution (5N NaOH)
       Dissolve 200 g NaOH in water, cool, then dilute to 1 L.  Store in a
       tightly sealed LPE bottle.
8.6.3  Fluoride Calibration Solutions
8.6.3.1  Concentrated Fluoride Calibration Stock Solution (1,000 mg/L F~)—
         Dissolve 0.2210 g of sodium fluoride (NaF, ultrapure, dried at  110'C
         for 2 hours and stored in a desiccator) in water and dilute to  100.00
         mL.  Store in a clean LPE bottle.
*l,2-cyclohexylene dinitrilo tetraacetic acid.

-------
                                                                Section 8.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 3 of 6
8.6.3.2  Dilute Fluoride Calibration Stock Solution (10.00 mg/L F")—Dilute
         1.000 mL of the concentrated fluoride calibration stock solution  to
         100.00 mL with water.

8.6.3.3  Dilute Fluoride Working Standards—Using micropipets or volumetric
         pipets, prepare daily a series of dilute working standards  in the
         range 0.0-2 mg/L F" by quantitatively diluting appropriate  volumes of
         the 10.00 mg/L F~ solution and TISAB solution to 50.00 mL.   The
         following series may be used:

          mL of            mL of 10.00         Resulting F~ Concentration  When
          TISAB          mg/L F" Solution         Diluted to 50.00 mL (mg/L)

           5.00                 0.000                        0.0000
           5.00                 0.0500                       0.0100
           5.00                 0.100                        0.0200
           5.00                 0.250                        0.0500
           5.00                 0.500                        0.100
           5.00                 2.50                         0.500
           5.00                10.00                         2.000

8.6.4  Water

       Water must meet the specifications for Type I  Reagent Water given in
       ASTM D 1193 (ASTM, 1984).

8.7  Sample Collection, Preservation, and Storage

     Samples are collected and filtered and are shipped to the lab in LPE
     bottles.  Store at 4°C when not in use.

8.8  Calibration and Standardization

8.8.1  Allow the electrometer to warm up, and ensure  that the fluoride-ISE
       contains adequate internal  filling solution.

8.8.2  With the electrometer set to measure mV, analyze the dilute fluoride
       working standards (in order of increasing concentration, beginning  with
       the blank) by using the procedure described in sections 8.8.2.1 through
       8.8.2.3.

8.8.2.1  Prior to use and between determinations, rinse the electrode with
         water until a potential of at least 200 mV is obtained.  Blot dry to
         avoid carryover.

-------
                                                                Section 8.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page 4 of 6
8.8.2.2  Place 20.00 ml of standard in a clean 30-mL plastic beaker.  Add a
         clean Teflon-coated stir bar, place on a magnetic stirrer,  and stir at
         medium speed.

8.8.2.3  Immerse the electrode in the solution to just above the stir bar and
         observe the potential.  Record the potential when a stable  reading is
         obtained (potential drift less than 0.1 mV/minute).  Record the time
         required to obtain the reading.  (It may take 15 to 30 minutes to
         obtain a stable reading for the low standards.)

8.8.3  Prepare a calibration curve on semi-logarithmic graph paper.   Plot the
       concentration of F~ (in mg/L) on the log axis versus the electrode
       potential on the linear axis.  Determine the slope of the line in the
       linear portion of the plot.  The measured slope should be within ±10
       percent of the theoretical slope (obtained from the electrode manual).
       If it is not, the electrode is not operating properly.  Consult the
       electrode manual for guidance.  (Note:  The calibration curve may be
       nonlinear below 0.05 mg/L.)

8.9  Quality Control

     The required QC procedures are described in section  3.4.

8.10 Procedure

8.10.1 Use only plasticware when performing fluoride determinations.  Clean by
       using the acid-free washing procedure described in Appendix A.

8.10.2 Allow samples and standards to equilibrate at room temperature.

8.10.3 Analyze fluoride standards and prepare calibration curve as described
       in section 8.8.

8.10.4 Prior to use and between determinations, rinse the electrode  with water
       until a potential of at least 200 mV is obtained.   Blot dry to avoid
       carryover.

8.10.5 Place 10.00 ml of sample in a clean 30-mL plastic  beaker.  Add a clean
       Teflon-coated stir bar, place on a magnetic stirrer, and stir at a
       medium speed.  Add 1.00 mL of TISAB to beaker.  Record the reading when
       a stable potential is obtained (drift is less than 0.1 mV/minute).
       Also record the time required to reach the stable  reading.  (It may take
       as much as 15 to 30 minutes.)  This assists the analyst in detecting
       electrode problems.

-------
                                                                Section 8.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 5 of 6
8.10.6 At the end of the day, thoroughly rinse the electrode and store it in
       deionized water.

8.11 Calculations

     Compute the sample concentration by comparing the sample potential  reading
     to the calibration curve.

     Report results in mg/L.

8.12  Precision and Accuracy

      A synthetic sample containing 0.85 mg/L fluoride and no interferences was
      analyzed by 111 analysts; the mean result was 0.84 mg/L and the standard
      deviation was 0.03 mg/L (U.S. EPA, 1983).

      A synthetic sample containing 0.75 mg/L fluoride, 2.5 mg/L polyphosphate,
      and 300 mg/L ANC was analyzed by 111 analysts; the mean result was 0.75
      mg/L fluoride and the standard deviation was 0.036 (U.S.  EPA,  1983).

8.13 References

     American Society for Testing and Materials, 1984.  Annual  Book  of ASTM
          Standards, Vol. 11.01, Standard Specification for Reagent  Water,
          D 1193-77 (reapproved 1983).  ASTM, Philadelphia, Pennsylvania.

     Barnard, W. R., and D. K. Nordstrom, 1982.  Fluoride in Precipitation  - I.
          Methodology with the Fluoride-Selective Electrode.  Atmos.  Environ.,
          v. 16, pp. 99-103.

     Bauman, E. W., 1971.  Sensitivity of the Fluoride-Selective Electrode
          Below the Micromolar Range.  Anal.  Chim. Acta, v. 54,  pp.  189-197.

     Kissa, E., 1983.  Determination of Fluoride at Low Concentrations with the
          Ion-Selective Electrode.  Anal. Chem., v. 55, pp. 1445-1448.

     LaZerte, B. D., 1984.  Forms of Aqueous  Aluminum in BNC Catchments  of
          Central Ontario:  A Methodological  Analysis.  Can. J.  Fish Aquat.
          Sci., v. 41, n. 5, pp. 766-776.

     Warner, T. B., and D. J. Bressan, 1973.   Direct Measurement of  Less Than
          1 Part-Per-Billion Fluoride in Rain, Fog, and Aerosols with an Ion-
          Selective Electrode.  Anal. Chim. Acta, v. 63, pp. 165-173.

-------
                                                           Section 8.0
                                                           Revision 2
                                                           Date:   11/86
                                                           Page  6 of 6
U.S. Environmental  Protection Agency,  1983 (revised).   Methods for
     Chemical  Analysis of Water and Wastes,  Method 340.2,  Fluoride
     (Potentiometric,  Ion Selective Electrode).   EPA-600/4-79-020.  U.S.
     EPA, Cincinnati,  Ohio.

-------
                                                                Section 9.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page 1 of 8
9.0  DETERMINATION OF TOTAL DISSOLVED PHOSPHORUS

9.1  Scope and Application

     This method may be used to determine concentrations of total  dissolved
     phosphorus in natural surface waters in the range from 0.001  to 0.200
     mg/L P.

     Samples preserved with HgCl2 should not be analyzed with this method.

9.2  Summary of Method

     All forms of phosphorus, including organic phosphorus, are converted to
     orthophosphate by an acid-persulfate digestion.

     Orthophosphate ion reacts with ammonium molybdate in acidic solution to
     form phosphomolybdic acid which upon reduction with ascorbic  acid
     produces an intensely colored blue complex.  Antimony potassium tartrate
     is added to increase the rate of reduction (Skougstad et al., 1979;
     Gales et al., 1966; Murphy and Riley, 1962).

9.3  Interferences

     Barium, lead, and silver interfere by forming a precipitate.   There
     is a positive interference from silica when the silica-to-total-
     phosphorus ratio exceeds about 400:1 (Table 9.1).


        TABLE 9.1.  PERCENT RECOVERY OF TOTAL P IN THE PRESENCE OF Si02
                            (Skougstad et al., 1979)
==============================================================================
                                               (mg/L)

Total P mg/L       2015105I
0.200
0.100
0.050
0.010
0.005
0.002
98
103
104
144
160
550
100
—
104
133
140
350
100
—
102
122
120
250
102
—
102
111
120
250
101
103
102
100
100
100
       HgClp-NaCl-preserved samples give inconsistent results and therefore
       should not be used.

-------
                                                                Section 9.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page 2 of 8
9.4  Safety

     The calibration standards, sample types, and most reagents used in this
     method pose no hazard to the analyst.  Use protective clothing (lab
     coat and gloves) and safety glasses when handling concentrated sulfuric
     acid.

     Use proper care when operating the autoclave.  Follow the safety precau-
     tions provided by the manufacturer.

9.5  Apparatus and Equipment

9.5.1  Autoclave.

9.5.2  Technicon AutoAnalyzer II, consisting of sampler,  cartridge manifold,
       proportioning pump, heating bath, colorimeter, voltage stabilizer,
       recorder, and printer.

       With this equipment the following operating conditions have been
       found satisfactory for the range from 0.001 to 0.200 mg/L P:

          Absorption cell	50 mm
          Wavelength		   880 nm
          Cam          	     		 30/h (1:1)
          Heating bath temperature              — 27,s°C.

9.5.3  Glass tubes with plastic caps, disposable:   18 mm by 150 mm.

9.6  Reagents and Consumable Materials

     All  reagents must be ACS reagent grade or equivalent.

9.6.1  Ammonium Molybdate Solution (35.6 g/L)

       Dissolve 40 g ammonium molybdate [(NHA)fiMo709/,-4HoO] in 800 ml water and
       ,...,-,                         *t O  / t*r   £
       dilute to 1 L.

9.6.2  Ascorbic Acid Solution (18 g/L)

       Dissolve 18 g ascorbic acid ^5^04) in 800 ml water and dilute to  1 L.

9.6.3  Antimony Potassium Tartrate Solution (3 g/L)

       Dissolve 3.0 g antimony potassium tartrate [K(SbO)C4H4Og'l/2H20] in 800
       mL water and dilute to 1 L.

9.6.4  Combined Working Reagent

-------
                                                                Section 9.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page 3 of 8
       Combine reagents in the order listed below.  (This reagent is stable for
       about 8 hours.  The stability is increased if kept at 4°C):

                50 mL     Sulfuric acid, 2.45M
                15 mL     Ammonium molybdate solution
                30 ml     Ascorbic acid solution
                 5 ml     Antimony potassium tartrate solution

9.6.5  Phosphate Stock Standard Solution (100 mg/L P)

       Dissolve 0.4394 g potassium acid phosphate (KH2P04, dried for 12 to
       16 hours over concentrated ^$04, sp gr 1.84) in water and dilute to
       1,000 ml.

9.6.6  Phosphate Standard Solution I (10.00 mg/L P)

       Quantitatively dilute 100.0 ml phosphate stock standard solution to
       1,000 ml with water.

9.6.7  Phosphate Standard Solution II (1.000 mg/L P)

       Quantitatively dilute 10.00 mL phosphate stock standard solution to
       1,000 mL with water.

9.6.8  Dilute Phosphate Working Standards

       Prepare a blank and 1,000 mL each of a series of working standards by
       appropriate quantitative dilution of phosphate standard solutions I and
       II.  For example:
          Phosphate standard
            solution II
               (mL)
Phosphate standard
   solution I
      (mL)
   Total P
concentration
  in working
   standard
    (mg/L)
0.0
1.00
5.00
10.00
-
-
_
0.0
-
-
-
5.0
10.0
20.0
0.000
0.001
0.005
0.010
0.050
0.100
0.200

-------
                                                                Section 9.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page 4 of 8
9.6.9  Potassium Persulfate Solution (4 g/L)
       Dissolve 4.0 g potassium persulfate (K2S2Og) in water and dilute to 1 L.
9.6.10 Sulfuric Acid (2.45M)
       Slowly and with constant stirring and cooling, add 136 ml concentrated
       sulfuric acid (sp gr 1.84) to 800 ml water.  Cool  and dilute to 1 L
       with water.
9.6.11 Sulfuric Acid (0.45M)
       Slowly and with constant stirring and cooling, add 25.2 mL concentrated
       sulfuric acid (sp gr 1.84) to 800 mL water.  Cool  and dilute to 1 L
       with water.
9.6.12 Sulfuric Acid-Persulfate Reagent (1+1)
       Mix equal volumes of 0.45M sulfuric acid and potassium persulfate solu-
       tion.
9.6.13 Water Diluent
       Add 1.0 ml Levor IV to 1 L water.
9.6.14 Water
       Water must meet the specifications for Type I Reagent Water given in
       ASTM D 1193 (ASTM, 1984).
9.7  Sample Collection, Preservation, and Storage
     Samples are collected and preserved (addition of H2S04 until the pH <2).
     Store samples at 4°C when not in use.
9.8  Calibration and Standardization
     Analyze the series of total P standards as described in section 9.10.
     Prepare a calibration curve by plotting the peak height versus standard
     concentration.
9.9  Quality Control
     The required QC is described in section 3.4.

-------
                                                                Section 9.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page 5 of 8
9.10 Procedure

9.10.1 It is critical that the colorimeter is optically peaked prior to first
       analysis.

9.10.2 Mix each sample, pi pet a volume of it containing less than 0.002 mg
       total P (10.0 ml maximum) into a disposable glass tube, and adjust the
       volume to 10.0 ml_.

9.10.3 Prepare blank solution and sufficient standards, and adjust the volume
       of each to 10.0 ml.

9.10.4 Add 4.0 ml acid-persulfate reagent to samples, blank, and standards.

9.10.5 Place plastic caps gently on top of tubes but do not push down.  Auto-
       clave for 30 minutes at 1218C and 15 psi pressure.  After the samples
       have cooled, the caps may be pushed down.

9.10.6 Set up manifold (Figure 9.1).

9.10.7 Allow the colorimeter, recorder, and heating bath to warm up for at
       least 30 minutes or until the temperature of the heating bath reaches
       37.5°C.  Zero the recorder baseline while pumping all reagents through
       the system.

9.10.8 Beginning with the most concentrated standard, place a complete set of
       standards in the first positions of the first sample tray, with blank
       solution between each standard.  Fill remainder of each tray alternately
       with unknown samples and blank solution.

9.10.9 Begin analysis.  When the peak from the most concentrated standard
       appears on the recorder, adjust the STD CAL control  until the flat
       portion of the peak reads full scale.  Using the baseline control,
       adjust each blank in the tray to read zero as it is  analyzed.

9.10.10 Dilute and reanalyze samples with a total P concentration exceeding the
        calibrated range.

9.11 Calculations

9.11.1 Compute the concentration of total phosphorus in each sample by compar-
       ing its peak height to the calibration curve.  Report results as mg/L P.

9.12 Precision and Accuracy

     Data for the determination of the precision and accuracy of the method
     are given in Tables 9.1 through 9.4.

-------
                                                              Section 9.0
                                                              Revision 2
                                                              Date:   11/86
                                                              Page 6 of 8
  Coil  No.
157-B273-03
     \
               •0-
).
-03
5-turn coils
oooo>
37.5°C
Colorimeter
880 nm >
50 mm cell /

oooo
faste To s<
V


;

impler 4^.
vash
i receptacle
0.030 in
0.32 mL/min
0.030 in
0.32 mL/min
0.035 in
0.42 mL/min
0.030 in
0.32 mL/min
0.073 in
2.00 mL/min
0.040 in
0.60 mL/min
Air
Water
Sampl e
Combined
reagent
Wash
solution
Waste
                         Sampler 4
                            30/h
                          1/1 cam
Proportioning  pump
                       Recorder
               Figure 9.1.  Total Dissolved Phosphorus Manifold.

-------
                                                                Section 9.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page 7 of 8
       TABLE 9.2.  PRECISION AND ACCURACY OF THE METHOD FOR NATURAL WATER
             SAMPLES (Skougstad et al., 1979).  (All data in mg/L P)


      Sample        n         Mean       Std. Dev.   % Rel. Std. Dev.
4-065070
4-065080
4-066060
10
10
10
0.0347
0.1435
0.0902
0.0012
0.0031
0.0027
3.34
2.16
2.99

           TABLE 9.3.  PRECISION AND ACCURACY OF THE METHOD FOR ANALYST-
        PREPARED STANDARDS (Skougstad et al., 1979).  (All  data in mg/L P)
      Sample	n          Mean       Std.  Dev.    % Rel.  Std.  Dev,
0.040
0.030
0.020
0.004
0.001
9
10
10
9
9
0.0424
0.0322
0.0172
0.0033
0.0013
0.0007
0.0006
0.0004
0.0007
0.0005
1.71
1.96
2.45
21.21
37.5
     It is estimated that the RSD (coefficient of variation) of this method is
     38 percent at 0.001 mg/L, 2.5 percent at 0.020 mg/L,  and 2.2 percent at
     0.144 mg/L.


9.13 References

     American Society for Testing and Materials, 1984.  Annual  Book of ASTM
          Standards, Vol. 11.01, Standard Specification for Reagent Water,
          D 1193-77 (reapproved 1983).  ASTM, Philadelphia, Pennsylvania.

     Gales, M. E., Jr.,  E. C. Julian, and R.  C. Kroner, 1966.  Method for
          Quantitative Determination of Total Phosphorus in Water.   J. Am.
          Water Works Assoc., v. 58, pp. 1363-1368.

     Murphy, J., and J.  P. Riley, 1962.  A Modified Single-Solution Method  for
          the Determination of Phosphate in Natural Waters.  Anal.  Chim.  Acta,
          v.  27, pp. 31-36.

-------
                                                           Section  9.0
                                                           Revision 2
                                                           Date:  11/86
                                                           Page 8 of 8
Skougstad, M.  W.,  M.  J.  Fishman,  L.  C.  Friedman,  D.  E.  Erdman, and  S.  S.
     Duncan (eds.),  1979.   Method 1-4600-78,  Automated  Phosphomolybdate
     Colorimetric  Method for Total  Phosphorus.   In:   Methods  for  Deter-
     mination  of Inorganic Substances  in  Water  ami Fluvial  Sediments:
     Techniques of Water-Resources Investigations  of the  United States
     Geological Survey,  Book 5,  Chapter Al.   U.S.  Government  Printing
     Office, Washington, D.C.

-------
                                                                Section 10.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page 1 of 7
10.0 DETERMINATION OF DISSOLVED SILICA

10.1 Scope and Application

     This method is applicable for the determination of dissolved silica in
     natural surface waters in the concentration range from 0.1 to 10 mg/L.

10.2 Summary of Method

     Silica reacts with molybdate reagent in acid media to form a yellow
     silicomolybdate complex.  This complex is reduced by ascorbic acid
     to form the molybdate blue color.  The silicomolybdate complex may
     form either as an alpha or beta polymorph, or as a mixture of both.
     Because the two polymorphic forms have absorbance maxima at different
     wavelengths, the pH of the mixture is kept below 2.5, which favors forma-
     tion of the beta polymorph (Govett, 1961; Mullen and Riley, 1955;
     Strickland, 1962).

     A 1-hour digestion with l.OM NaOH is required to ensure that all the
     silica is available for reaction with the molybdate reagent.

     The procedure specified utilizes automated technology and is based on
     existing methodology (Skougstad et al., 1979).

10.3 Interferences

     Interference from phosphate, which forms a phosphomolybdate complex, is
     suppressed by the addition of oxalic acid.  Hydrogen sulfide must be
     removed by boiling the acidified sample prior to analysis.  Large
     amounts of iron interfere.  However, neither hydrogen sulfide nor iron
     is expected in appreciable quantities.

10.4 Safety

     The calibration standards, samples, and most reagents used in this
     method pose no hazard to the analyst.  Use protective clothing (lab coat
     and gloves) and safety glasses when handling concentrated sulfuric acid
     and when performing sample digestions.

10.5 Apparatus and Equipment

10.5.1 Technicon AutoAnalyzer II, consisting of sampler, cartridge manifold,
       proportioning pump, colorimeter, voltage stabilizer, recorder, and
       printer.

10.5.2 With this equipment the following operating conditions are recommended:

-------
                                                                Section  10.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page  2 of 7
          Absorption cell  _ _ ................  15  mm
          Wavelength _ 660 nm
          Cam       _ ........      60/hour  (6/1)

10.6 Reagents and Consumable Materials

10.6.1 Ammonium Molybdate  Solution (9.4 g/L)

       Dissolve 10 g ammonium molybdate ((NH4)gMo7024'4H20)  in 0.05M  H2S04 and
       dilute to 1 L with  0.05M ^$04. Filter  and  store  in an amber plastic
       container.

10.6.2 Ascorbic Acid Solution (17.6 g/L)

       Dissolve 17.6 g ascorbic acid (€5^05)  in 500  mL  water containing  50 ml
       acetone.  Dilute to 1 L with water.   Add 0.5 mL Levor IV solution.  The
       solution is stable  for 1 week if stored at  4°C.

10.6.3 Hydrochloric Acid (50 percent v/v)

       Slowly add 500 mL concentrated HC1  to 500 mL water.

10.6.4 Hydrochloric Acid (2  percent v/v)

       Add 10 mL (concentrated)  HC1  to 490 mL  water.

10.6.5 Hydrofluoric Acid (HF, ACS  reagent  grade)

10.6.6 Levor IV Solution

       Technicon No. 21-0332 or equivalent.

10.6.7 Oxalic Acid Solution  (50 g/L)

       Dissolve 50 g oxalic  acid (C2H204'2H20) in  water  and  dilute to 1 L.

10.6.8 Silica Standard Solution (500 mg/L  Si
       Dissolve 2.366 g sodium metasilicate  (Na2Si03'9H20)  in  water and dilute
       to 1.000 L.   The concentration  of  this  solution  must be verified by
       standard gravimetric analysis  (described  in  section  10.8.1).   Store  in a
       plastic bottle.

10.6.9 Silica Working Standards

       Prepare a blank  and 500 mL  each of a  series  of  silica working  standards
       by appropriate quantitative dilution  of the  silica stock standard  solu-
       tion.   The following series is  suggested:

-------
                                                                Section 10.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 3 of 7
               Silica stock standard                Silica concentration in
                   solution (ml)                    working standard (mg/L)

                         0.0                                  0
                         0.200                                0.200
                         0.500                                0.500
                         1.00                                 1.00
                         5.00                                 5.00
                        10.0                                 10.0

10.6.10 Sodium Hydroxide Solution (l.OM NaOH)

        Dissolve 4 g sodium hydroxide (NaOH)  in water and dilute to 1 L.

10.6.11 Sulfuric Acid Solution (0.05M H2S04)  (50 percent v/v H2S04)

        Cautiously add 2.8 ml concentrated sulfuric acid ^SO/^, sp gr 1.84)  to
        water and dilute to 1 L for 0.05M H2S04-  Cautiously and slowly add
        500 ml H2S04 to 500 ml water.  Beware of excessive heat buildup.

10.6.12 Water

        Water must meet the specifications for Type I Reagent Water given in
        ASTM D 1193 (ASTM, 1984).

10.7 Sample Collection. Preservation, and Storage

       Samples are collected and filtered in  the field and then are shipped to
       the lab.  Store at 4°C when not in use.

10.8 Calibration and Standardization

10.8.1 Verify the concentration of the silica stock standard solution by using
       the gravimetric procedure detailed in  section 10.8.1.1 through 10.8.1.7
       (APHA, 1980).

10.8.1.1 Sample Evaporation—Add 5 ml of 50 percent v/v HC1 to 200.0 ml silica
         stock standard.  Evaporate to dryness in a 200-mL platinum evaporating
         dish, in several  portions if necessary, on a water bath or suspended
         on an asbestos ring over a hot plate.  Protect against contamination
         by atmospheric dust.  During evaporation,  add a total of 15 ml 50 per-
         cent HC1 in several portions.  Evaporate sample to dryness and place
         dish with residue in a 110°C oven or over  a hot plate to bake for 30
         minutes.

10.8.1.2 First Filtration—Add 5 ml of 50 percent HC1, warm, and add 50 mL hot

-------
                                                                Section  10.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page 4 of 7
         water.  While hot,  filter sample through  an  ashless  medium-texture
         filter paper, decanting as much liquid as possible.   Wash  dish  and
         residue with hot 2  percent HC1  and  then with a  minimum  volume of
         water until washings are chloride-free.  Save all  washings.  Set
         aside filter paper  with its residue.

10.8.1.3 Second Filtration—Evaporate filtrate and washings from the  above
         operations to dryness in the original  platinum  dish.  Bake residue  in
         a 110°C oven or over a hot plate for  30 minutes.   Repeat steps  in
         section 10.8.1.2.  Use a separate filter  paper  and a  rubber  policeman
         to aid in transferring residue  from dish  to  filter.

10.8.1.4 Ignition—Transfer  the two filter papers  and residues to a covered
         platinum crucible,  dry at 110°C, and  ignite  at  1,200°C  to  constant
         weight.  Avoid mechanical  loss  of residue when  first  charring and
         burning off the paper.  Cool in desiccator,  weigh, and  repeat ignition
         and weighing until  constant weight  is attained.   Record weight  of
         crucible and contents.

10.8.1.5 Volatilization with HF—Thoroughly  moisten weighed residue with water.
         Add 4 drops of 50 percent v/v ^$04 followed by 10 ml concentrated  HF,
         and measure the latter in a plastic graduated cylinder  or  by pouring an
         estimated 10 ml directly from the reagent bottle.  Slowly  evaporate
         to dryness over an  air bath or  hot  plate  in  a hood,  and avoid loss  by
         splattering.  Ignite crucible to constant weight  at  1,200°C.  Record
         weight of crucible  and contents.

10.8.1.6 Blank—Repeat procedures in sections  10.8.1.1 through 10.8.1.5  with a
         blank sample.

10.8.1.7 Calculations

           Perform the following calculations  for  both the standard and  blank
           samples.

           X = weight of crucible plus contents before HF  treatment (mg)
           Y = weight of crucible plus contents after HF treatment  (mg)

           Z = weight of silica in sample (mg)  = X -  Y

           Calculate the silica concentration  in the  stock  standard by:

           mg Si02     Z (standard)  - Z  (Blank) mg

             L                 0.200 L

10.8.2 Analyze the series of silica standards  as described in  section 10.10
       (including digestion).

-------
                                                                Section 10.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 5 of 7


10.8.3 Prepare a calibration curve by plotting the peak height versus  standard
       concentration.

10.9 Quality Control

     The required QC is described in section 3.4.

10.10 Procedure

10.10.1 Set up the AutoAnalyzer manifold (Figure 10.1).

10.10.2 Allow colorimeter and recorder to warm up for at least 30 minutes.
        Zero the recorder baseline while pumping all  reagents through  the
        system.

10.10.3 Add 5.00 ml of l.OM NaOH to 50.00 mL of sample.  Digest for one hour.

10.10.4 Beginning with the most concentrated working  standard, place a complete
        set of standards in the first positions of the first sample tray,
        followed by a blank.  Fill  remainder of each  sample tray with  unknown
        and QC samples.

10.10.5 Begin analysis.  When the peak from the most  concentrated working
        standard appears on the recorder, adjust the  STD CAL control until
        the flat portion of the curve reads full scale.

10.10.6 Dilute and reanalyze any sample with a concentration exceeding the
        calibrated range.

10.11 Calculations

      Compute the silica concentration of each sample by comparing its
      peak height to the calibration curve.  Any baseline drift that may
      occur must be taken into account when computing the height of a
      sample or standard peak.  Report results as mg/L Si03.

10.12 References

      American Public Health Association, American Water Works Association,
           and Water Pollution Control  Foundation, 1980.  Standard Methods for
           the Examination of Water and Wastewater, 15th Ed.  Part 425-Silica.
           APHA, Washington, D.C.

      American Society for Testing and Materials, 1984.  Annual  Book of ASTM
           Standards, Vol. 11.01, Standard Specification for Reagent Water,
           D 1193-77 (reapproved 1983).  ASTM, Philadelphia, Pennsylvania.

-------
                                                          Section 10.0
                                                          Revision 2
                                                          Date:   11/86
                                                          Page 6 of 7
Govett, G.J.S., 1961.  Critical  Factors in the Colorimetric  Determination
     of Silica.  Anal.  Chim.  Acta,  v.  25,  pp.  69-80.

Mullen, J. B., and J. P.  Riley,  1955.   The Colorimetric Determination  of
     Silica with Special  Reference  to  Sea  and  Natural  Waters.   Anal.
     Chim.  Acta, v. 12,  pp.  162-176.

Skougstad, M. W., M. J. Fishman,  L. C. Friedman,  D.  E.  Erdman,  and S.  S.
     Duncan (eds.), 1979.  Method 1-2700-78, Automated Molybdate Blue
     Colorimetric Method  for  Dissolved Silica.  In:   Methods for Determi-
     nation of Inorganic  Substances in Water and  Fluvial  Sediments:
     Techniques of Water-Resources  Investigations of the United States
     Geological Survey, Book  5,  Chapter Al. U.S. Government Printing
     Office, Washington,  D.C.

Strickland, J.D.H., 1962.  The Preparation and Properties of Silicomo-
     lybdic Acid; I.  The Properties of Alpha  Silicomolybdic Acid.  J.
     Am.  Chem. Soc., v.  74,  pp.  852-857.

-------
                                                                Section  10.0
                                                                Revision  2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page 7 of 7
                20-turn coil
22-turn coil
I
J
                  OXPCOCDOOCD
        Colorimeter
        660 nm
        15-mm cell
            -0-
Waste
To sampler 4
  wash
receptacle
                                              0.030 in
                        0.32 ml/mm

                        0.035 in
                                              0.42 mL/min

                                              0.025 in
                                              0.23 mL/min
                        0.030 in
                        0.32 mL/min

                        0.035 in
0.42 mL/min

0.073 in
                        2TODmL7min

                        0.045 in
                                              0.80  mL/min
                                    Air
                         Molybdate
                         Reagent
                                    Samp! e
                         Oxalic
                         Acid
                                                          Ascorbic
                                                          Acid
Water
                         Waste
                                              Proportioning  pump
                    Recorder
                        Sampler 4
                         60/hour

                         6/1 cam
                         Figure 10.1.   Silica manifold.

-------
                                                                Section 11.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page 1 of 4


11.0  DETERMINATION OF SPECIFIC CONDUCTANCE

11.1  Scope and Application

      This method is applicable to natural surface waters of low ionic
      strength.

      The majority of streams sampled for the NSWS have a specific conduc-
      tance in the range 10 to 100 uS/cm.

11.2  Summary of Method

      The specific conductance in samples is measured by using a conductance
      meter and conductivity cell.  The meter and cell  are calibrated by using
      potassium chloride standards of known specific conductance (U.S. EPA,
      1983).

      Samples are preferably analyzed at 25°C.  If they cannot be analyzed at
      25°C, temperature corrections are made and results are reported at
      25°C.

11.3  Interferences

      Temperature variations represent the major source of potential error
      in specific conductance determinations.  To minimize this error,
      calibration standards and samples must be measured at the same
      temperature.

      Natural  surface waters contain substances (humic  and fulvic acids,
      suspended solids, etc.) which may build up on the conductivity cell.
      Such a buildup interferes with the operation of the cell and must be
      removed periodically by following the recommendations of the cell
      manufacturer.

11.4  Safety

      The calibration standards and sample types pose no hazard to the
      analyst.

11.5  Apparatus and Equipment

11.5.1  Specific Conductance Meter

11.5.1.1  Digital meter with the following minimum specifications:

          Range:  0.1 to 1,000 uS/cm
          Readability:   0.1 uS/cm
          Maximum Error:  1% of reading
          Maximum Imprecision:  1% of reading

-------
                                                                Section 11.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 2 of 4
11.5.2  Conductivity Cell
        High quality glass cell with a cell  constant of 1.0 or 0.1.   Cells
        containing platinized electrodes are recommended.

11.5.3  Thermometer

        NBS-traceable thermometer with a range of 0 to 40°C and divisions of
        0.1°C.

11.6  Reagents and Consumable Materials

11.6.1  Potassium Chloride Stock Calibration Solution (0.01000M KC1)

        Dissolve 0.7456 g potassium chloride (KC1, ultrapure,  freshly dried for
        two hours at 105°C and stored in a desiccator) in  water and  dilute to
        1.000 L.  Store in a tightly sealed LPE container.

11.6.2  Potassium Chloride Calibration Solution (0.001000M KC1)

        Dilute 10.00 ml KC1  stock calibration solution to  100.00 ml  with water.
        This solution has a theoretical specific conductance of 147.0 uS/cm at
        25°C.

11.6.3  Potassium Chloride QC Solution (0.000500M KC1)

        Dilute 5.00 ml 0.0100M KC1  solution (independent of the KC1  stock
        calibration solution) to 100.00 ml with water.  This solution has a
        theoretical specific conductance of 73.9 uS/cm at  25°C.

11.6.4  Water

        Water must meet the specifications for Type I Reagent Water  given in
        ASTM D 1193 (ASTM, 1984).

11.7  Sample Collection, Preservation, and Storage

      The samples are collected in  the field and are shipped to the  lab  in
      LPE bottles without treatment.  Store at 4°C when not in use.

11.8  Calibration and Standardization

11.8.1  Measure and record the specific conductance of the KC1  calibration
        solution as described in section 11.10.

11.8.2  Calculate the corrected cell constant, Kc, by using the following
        equation:

-------
                                                                Section 11.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page 3 of 4


                 147.0 uS/cm
          Kc  =  	
                    KClm

          KClm  =  measured specific conductance for the KC1 calibration
                   solution.

        The corrected cell constant, Kc, includes the calculation for the
        cell constant and the temperature correction to 25°C.

11.9  Quality Control

      The required QC procedures are described in section 3.4.

11.10  Procedure

11.10.1  Follow the instructions provided by the manufacturer for the operation
         of the meter and cell.

11.10.2  Allow the samples and calibration standard to equilibrate to room
         temperature.

11.10.3  Measure the sample temperature.  If different from the standard
         temperature, allow more time for equilibration.

11.10.4  Rinse the cell  thoroughly with water.

11.10.5  Rinse the cell  with a portion of the sample to be measured.  Immerse
         the electrode in a fresh portion of sample and measure its specific
         conductance.

11.10.6  Rinse the cell  thoroughly with water after use.  Store in water.

11.10.7  If the readings become erratic, the cell may be dirty or need
         replatinizing.   Consult the operating manual which is provided by the
         manufacturer for guidance.

11.11  Calculations

       Calculate the corrected specific conductance (Sc) for each sample
       using the following equation:

               Sc  =  (Kc) (Sn.)

               Kc  =  corrected cell constant

               S,,,  =  measured specific conductance

-------
                                                                Section  11.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page  4 of 4
       Report the results as specific conductance,  uS/cm at  25°C.

11.12  Precision and Accuracy

       Forty-one analysts in 17 laboratories  analyzed  6  synthetic  samples
       containing increments of inorganic  salts,  with  the following  results
       (U.S. EPA, 1983):
            Increment,  as
         Specific Conductance
               (uS/cm)

                100
                106
                808
                848
              1,640
              1,710
  Precision,  as
Standard Deviation
     (uS/cm)

      7.55
      8.14
     66.1
     79.6
    106
    119
     Acccuracy as
Bias U)    Bias (us/cm)
 -2.02
 -0.76
 -3.63
 -4.54
 -5.36
 -5.08
 -2.0
 -0.8
-29.3
-38.5
-87.9
-86.9
       In a single laboratory (EMSL-Cincinnati)  using  surface-water  samples
       with an average conductivity of 536  uS/cm at 25°C,  the  standard
       deviation was 6 uS/cm (U.S.  EPA, 1983).
11.13  References
       American Society for Testing  and  Materials,  1984.   Annual  Book of ASTM
            Standards,  Vol. 11.01,  Standard  Specification  for  Reagent Water,
            D 1193-77 (reapproved 1983).   ASTM,  Philadelphia,  Pennsylvania.

       U.S.  Environmental  Protection Agency,  1983  (revised).   Methods for
            Chemical  Analysis of Water and Wastes,  Method  120.1,  Conductance.
            EPA-600/4-79-020.  U.S.  EPA,  Cincinnati,  Ohio.

-------
                                                                Section 12.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 1 of 23


12.0  DETERMINATION OF METALS (Al, Ca, Fe, K, Mg, Mn, Na)
      BY ATOMIC ABSORPTION SPECTROSCOPY

12.1  Scope and Application

      Metals in solution may be readily determined by atomic absorption spectro-
      scopy.  The method is simple, rapid, and applicable to the determination
      of Al, Ca, Fe, K, Mg, Mn, and Na in natural surface waters.

      Detection limits, sensitivity, and optimum ranges of the metals  vary with
      the makes and models of atomic absorption spectrophotometers.  The data
      listed in Table 12.1, however, provide some indication of the  actual con-
      centration ranges measurable by direct aspiration (flame) and  furnace
      techniques.  In the majority of instances, the concentration range shown
      in the table for analysis by direct aspiration may be extended much lower
      with scale expansion and, conversely, may be extended upward by  using a
      less sensitive wavelength or by rotating the burner head.  Detection
      limits by direct aspiration may also be extended through concentration of
      the sample and through solvent extraction techniques.  Lower concentrations
      may also be determined by using the furnace techniques.  The concentration
      ranges given in Table 12.1 are somewhat dependent on equipment such as
      the type of spectrophotometer and furnace accessory, the energy  source,
      and the degree of electrical expansion of the output signal.  When he is
      using furnace techniques, however, the analyst should be cautioned that
      chemical reactions may occur at elevated temperatures, which may result
      in either suppression or enhancement of the signal from the element being
      analyzed.  To ensure valid data, the analyst must examine each matrix for
      interference effects (matrix spike analysis) and, if detected, must
      analyze the samples by the method of standard additions.

12.2  Summary of Method

      In direct aspiration atomic absorption spectroscopy, a sample  is aspirated
      and atomized in a flame.  A light beam from a hollow cathode lamp, whose
      cathode is made of the element to be determined, is directed through the
      flame into a monochromator and onto a detector that measures the amount
      of light absorbed.  Absorption depends upon the presence of free unexcited
      ground state atoms in the flame.  Since the wavelength of the  light beam
      is characteristic of only the metal being determined, the light  energy
      absorbed by the flame is a measure of the concentration of that  metal in
      the sample.  This principle is the basis of atomic absorption  spectroscopy.

      When use is made of the furnace technique in conjunction with  an atomic
      absorption spectrophotometer, a representative aliquot of a sample is
      placed in the graphite tube in the furnace, is evaporated to dryness, is
      charred, and is atomized.  As a greater percentage of available  analyte

-------
                                                                Section 12.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page 2 of 23
              TABLE 12.1.  ATOMIC ABSORPTION CONCENTRATION RANGES3
                               Flame
                                               Furnace^5*0

Metal
Detection
Limit
(mg/L)
Sensi-
tivity
(mg/L)
Optimum
Concentration
Range
(mg/L)
Detection
Limit
(ug/D
Optimum
Concentration
Range
(ug/L)
Alumi num
Calcium
Iron
Magnesium
Manganese
Potassium
Sodi urn
0.1
0.01
0.03
0.001
0.01
0.01
0.002
1
0.08
0.12
0.007
0.05
0.04
0.015
5
0.2
0.3
0.02
0.
0,
.1
,1
0.03  -
50
7
5
0.5
3
2
1
3       20   -  200

1       5-100

0.2     1    -   30
aThe concentrations shown are obtainable with any satisfactory atomic absorp-
  tion spectrophotometer.
bFor furnace sensitivity values, consult instrument operating manual.
°The listed furnace values are those expected when using a 20-uL
  injection and normal gas flow, except in the case of arsenic and selenium
  where gas interrupt is used.
     atoms are vaporized and dissociated for absorption in the tube than in the
     flame, the use of small sample volumes or detection of low concentrations
     of elements is possible.  The principle is essentially the same as with
     direct aspiration atomic absorption except a furnace, rather than a
     flame, is used to atomize the sample.   Radiation from a given excited
     element is passed through the vapor containing ground state atoms of
     that element.  The intensity of the transmitted radiation decreases in
     proportion to the amount of the ground state element in the vapor.

     The metal atoms to be measured are placed in the beam of radiation by
     increasing the temperature of the furnace and thereby cause the injected
     specimen to be volatilized.  A monochromator isolates the characteris-
     tic radiation from the hollow cathode  lamp, and a photosensitive device
     measures the attenuated transmitted radiation.

     Dissolved metals (Ca, Fe, K, Mg, Mn, and Na) are determined in a
     filtered sample (aliquot 1) by flame atomic absorption spectroscopy
     (U.S. EPA, 1983).

-------
                                                                Section  12.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page  3 of 23


     Total Al is determined in an unfiltered sample (aliquot 7)  after  digestion
     by graphite furnace atomic absorption spectroscopy (U.S.  EPA,  1983).

     Total extractable Al  is determined in a sample that has been treated
     with 8-hydroxyquinoline and has been extracted into MIBK (aliquot 2) by
     graphite furnace atomic absorption spectroscopy (Barnes,  1975; May
     et al., 1979; Driscoll, 1984).

12.3 Definitions

     Optimum Concentration Range

     This is a range, defined by limits expressed in concentration, below
     which scale expansion must be used and above which curve correction
     should be considered. This range will vary with the sensitivity  of  the
     instrument and with the operating conditions employed.

     Sensitivity

     Sensitivity is the concentration in milligrams of metal per liter that
     produces an absorption of 1 percent.

     Dissolved Metals

     Dissolved metals are those constituents (metals)  which  can  pass  through
     a 0.45-um membrane filter.

     Total Metals

     The concentration of metals is  determined on an unfiltered  sample
     following vigorous digestion.

12.4  Interferences

12.4.1  Direct Aspiration

12.4.1.1  The most troublesome type  of interference in atomic absorption
          spectrophotometry is usually termed "chemical" and is  caused by lack
          of absorption of atoms bound in molecular combination  in  the flame.
          This phenomenon can occur  when the flame is  not sufficiently hot to
          dissociate the molecule, as in the case of phosphate interference
          with magnesium,  or because the dissociated atom is immediately
          oxidized to a compound that will not dissociate further at  the
          temperature of the flame.   The addition of lanthanum will overcome
          the phosphate interference in the magnesium  and calcium determina-
          tions.  Similarly, silica  interference in the determination  of
          manganese can be eliminated by the addition  of calcium.

-------
                                                                Section 12.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 4 of 23


12.4.1.2  Chemical  interferences may also be eliminated by separating  the metal
          from the interfering material.   While complexing agents  are  primarily
          employed to increase the sensitivity of the analysis,  they may also
          be used to eliminate or reduce  interferences.

12.4.1.3  lonization interferences occur  when the flame temperature  is suffici-
          ently high to generate the removal of an electron from a neutral
          atom, giving a positively charged ion.   This type of interference can
          generally be controlled by the  addition, to both standard  and sample
          solutions, of a large excess of an easily ionized element.

12.4.1.4  Although quite rare, spectral  interference can occur when  an absorb-
          ing wavelength of an element present in the sample but not being
          determined falls within the width of the absorption line of  the
          element of interest.  The results of the determination will  then be
          erroneously high because of the contribution of the interfering ele-
          ment to the atomic absorption  signal.  Also, interference  can occur
          when resonant energy from another element in a multi-element lamp or
          when a metal impurity in the lamp cathode falls within the bandpass
          of the slit setting with that metal  being present in the sample.
          This type of interference may  sometimes be reduced by narrowing the
          slit width.

12.4.2  Flameless Atomization

12.4.2.1  Although the problem of oxide  formation is greatly reduced with
          furnace procedures because atomization  occurs in an inert  atmosphere,
          the technique is still  subject  to chemical  and matrix interferences.
          The composition of the sample matrix can have a major  effect on the
          analysis.  It is this effect which must be determined and  taken into
          consideration in the analysis of each different matrix encountered.
          To verify the absence of matrix or chemical  interference,  a  matrix
          spike sample is analyzed by using the following procedure.  Withdraw
          from the sample two equal  aliquots.   To one of the aliquots, add a
          known amount of analyte and dilute both aliquots to the  same predeter-
          mined volume.  (The dilution volume  should be based on the analysis  of
          the undiluted sample.  Preferably, the  dilution should be  1:4 while
          keeping in mind the optimum concentration range of the analysis.
          Under no circumstances should the dilution be less than  1:1).  The
          diluted aliquots should then be analyzed, and the unspiked results
          which are multiplied by the dilution factor should be  compared to the
          original  determination.  Agreement of the results (within  ±10 percent)
          indicates the absence of interference.   Comparison of  the  actual •
          signal from the spike to the expected response from the  analyte in an
          aqueous standard helps confirm  the finding from the dilution analysis.
          Those samples which indicate the presence of interference  must be
          analyzed by the method of standard additions.

-------
                                                                Section 12.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 5 of 23


12.4.2.2  Gases generated in the furnace during atomization may have molecular
          absorption bands encompassing the analytical  wavelength.   When this
          occurs, either the use of background correction or choosing an alter-
          nate wavelength outside the absorption band should eliminate this
          interference.  Background correction can also compensate  for
          nonspecific broad-band absorption interference.

12.4.2.3  Interference from a smoke-producing sample matrix can sometimes be
          reduced by extending the charring time at a higher temperature or by
          utilizing an ashing cycle in the presence of  air.  Care must be
          taken, however, to prevent loss of the element being analyzed.

12.4.2.4  The chemical environment of the furnace may cause certain elements to
          form carbides at high temperatures.  This problem is greatly reduced,
          and the sensitivity is increased with the use of pyrolytically coated
          graphite.

12.5  Safety

      The calibration standards, sample types, and most reagents pose no
      hazard to the analyst.  Use protective clothing (lab coat and gloves)
      and safety glasses when preparing reagents, especially when concent-
      rated acids and bases are used.  The use of concentrated hydrochloric
      acid, ammonium hydroxide solutions, and MIBK should be restricted to a
      hood.

      Follow the safety precautions provided by the manufacturer when operating
      the atomic absorption spectrophotometers.

      Follow good laboratory practices when handling compressed gases.

12.6  Apparatus and Equipment

12.6.1  Atomic Absorption Spectrophotometer

        The Spectrophotometer used shall be a single- or dual-channel, single-
        or double-beam instrument having a grating monochromator, photomulti-
        plier detector, adjustable slits, a wavelength  range of 190 to 800 nm,
        and provisions for interfacing with a strip chart recorder.

12.6.2  Burner

        The burner recommended by the particular instrument manufacturer should
        be used.  For certain elements, the nitrous oxide burner is required.

-------
                                                                Section 12.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page 6 of 23
12.6.3  Hollow Cathode Lamps
        Single element lamps are preferred, but multi-element lamps may be
        used.  Electrodeless discharge lamps may also be used when available.

12.6.4  Graphite Furnace

        Any furnace device capable of reaching the specified temperatures is
        satisfactory.

12.6.5  Strip Chart Recorder

        A recorder is strongly recommended for furnace work so that there will
        be a permanent record and so that any problems with the analysis such
        as drift, incomplete atotnization, losses during charring,  changes in
        sensitivity, etc., can be easily recognized.

12.7  Reagents and Consumable Materials

12.7.1  General  reagents used in each metal determination are listed in this
        section.  Reagents specific to particular metal  determinations are
        listed in the particular procedure description for that metal.

12.7.2  Concentrated Hydrochloric Acid (12M HC1)

        Ultrapure grade (Baker Instra-Analyzed or equivalent) is required.

12.7.3  HC1 (1 percent v/v)

        Add 5 mL concentrated HC1 to 495 ml water.

12.7.4  Nitric Acid (0.5% v/v HN03 - Ultrapure grade, Baker Instra-Analyzed or
        equivalent).

        Carefully dilute HN03 in water in the ratio of 0.5 to 100.

12.7.5  Stock Standard Metal  Solutions

        Prepare as directed  in the individual metal  procedures.  Commercially
        available stock standard solutions may also be used.

12.7.6  Dilute Calibration Standards

        Prepare a series of  standards of the metal by dilution of  the appro-
        priate stock metal solution to cover the concentration range desired.

-------
                                                                Section  12.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 7  of 23
12.7.7  Fuel and Oxidant

        Commercial grade acetylene is generally acceptable.   Air may be
        supplied from a compressed air line, a laboratory compressor, or  from a
        cylinder of compressed air.  Reagent grade nitrous oxide is also
        required for certain determinations.  Standard,  commercially available
        argon and nitrogen are required for furnace work.

12.7.8  Water

        Water must meet the specifications for Type I Reagent Water given in
        ASTM D 1193 (ASTM, 1984).

12.8  Sample Collection, Preservation, and Storage

      Samples are collected and processed in the field.   The sample for dissolved
      metals (aliquot 1) is filtered through a 0.45-um membrane filter and is
      then preserved by acidifying to a pH <2 with nitric acid.  The sample for
      total Al analysis (aliquot 7) is preserved by acidifying to a pH <2 with
      nitric acid.  The sample for total  extractable Al  (aliquot 2) is prepared
      by mixing a portion of sample with 8-hydroxyquinoline  followed by extrac-
      tion with MIBK.

      After processing, the samples are shipped to the analytical laboratory.
      For aliquot 2 samples, it is the MIBK layer from the extraction that is
      shipped.

12.9  Calibration and Standardization

12.9.1  The calibration procedure  varies slightly with the various atomic
        absorption instruments.

12.9.2  For each analyte, calibrate the atomic absorption instrument by analyz-
        ing a calibration blank and a series of standards and by following the
        instructions in the instrument operating manual.

12.9.3  The concentration of standards should bracket the expected sample
        concentration.   However, the linear range of the instrument should not
        be exceeded.

12.9.4  Method of Standard Additions

        When indicated  by the matrix spike analysis, the analytes must be
        quantified by the method of standard additions.   In  this method,  equal
        volumes of sample are added to a deionized water blank and to three
        standards containing different known amounts of  the  test element.  The
        volume of the blank and of each standard must be the same.  The

-------
                                                                Section 12.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page 8 of 23
        absorbance of each solution is determined and is then plotted on the
        vertical axis of a graph with the concentrations of the known standards
        plotted on the horizontal  axis.  When the resulting line is extrapolated
        to zero absorbance, the point of intersection of the abscissa is the
        concentration of the unknown.  The abscissa on the left of the ordinate
        is scaled the same as on the right side but in the opposite direction
        from the ordinate.  An example of a plot so obtained is shown in Figure
        12.1.  The method of standard additions can be very useful; however,
        for the results to be valid, the following limitations must be taken
        into consideration:

          « The absorbance plot of sample and standards must be linear over the
            concentration range of concern.  For best results, the slope of the
            plot should be nearly the same as the slope of the aqueous standard
            curve.  If the slope is significantly different (more than 20 per-
            cent), caution should be exercised.

          ° The effect of the interference should not vary as the ratio of
            analyte concentration to sample matrix changes, and the standard
            addition should respond in a similar manner as the analyte.

          o The determination must be free of spectral interference and
            must be corrected for nonspecific background interference.

12.10  Quality Control

       The required QC procedures are described in section 3.4.

12.11  Procedure

12.11.1  General procedures for flame and furnace atomic absorption analysis
         are given in sections 12.11.2 and 12.11.3.  Detailed procedures for
         determining Al, Ca, Fe, K, Mg, Mn, and Na are .given in sections
         12.11.4 through 12.11.11.

12.11.2  Flame Atomic Absorption Spectroscopy

         Differences among the various makes and models of satisfactory atomic
         absorption spectrophotometers prevent the formulation of detailed
         instructions applicable to every instrument.  The analyst should
         follow the operating instructions of the manufacturer for his parti-
         cular instrument.  In general, after choosing the proper hollow cathode
         lamp for the analysis, the lamp should be allowed to warm up for a
         minimum of 15 minutes unless operated in a double-beam mode.  During
         this period, align the instrument, position the monochromator at the
         correct wavelength, select the proper monochromator slit width, and
         adjust the hollow cathode current according to the recommendation
         provided by the manufacturer.  Subsequently, light the flame and

-------
                                                               Section 12.0
                                                               Revision 2
                                                               Date:  11/86
                                                               Page 9 of 23
  Zero
Absorbance
    Sample
Addn 0
No Addn
Addn of 50%
of Expected
Amount
Wdn 2
Addn of 100%
of Expected
Amount
Addn
Addn of 150%
of Expected
Amount
                     Figure 12.1.   Standard  Addition  Plot.

-------
                                                                Section 12.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 10 of 23
         regulate the flow of fuel  and oxidant,  adjust the burner and nebulizer
         flow rate for maximum percent absorption and stability,  and balance
         the photometer.  Run a series of standards of the element under analysis
         and calibrate the instrument.  Aspirate the samples and  determine the
         concentrations either directly (if the  instrument reads  directly in
         concentration units) or from the calibration curve.

12.11.3  Furnace Atomic Absorption  Spectroscopy

         Furnace devices (flameless atomization) are a most useful  means of
         extending detection limits.  Because of differences among various
         makes and models of satisfactory instruments, no detailed operating
         instuctions can be given for each instrument.  Instead,  the analyst
         should follow the instructions provided by the manufacturer of  his
         particular instrument and  should use as a guide the temperature
         settings and other instrument conditions listed in sections 12.11.4
         through 12.11.11 (which are the recommended ones for the Perkin-Elmer
         HGA-2100).  In addition, the following  points may be helpful.

12.11.3.1  With flameless atomization, background correction becomes of  high
           importance especially below 350 nm.   This is because certain
           samples, when atomized,  may absorb or scatter light from the  hollow
           cathode lamp.  These effects can be caused by the presence of
           gaseous molecular species, salt particles, or smoke in the sample
           beam.  If no correction  is made, sample absorbance will  be greater
           than it should be, and the analytical result will  be erroneously
           high.

12.11.3.2  If during atomization all the analyte is not volatilized and  removed
           from the furnace, memory effects will occur.  This condition  is
           dependent on several factors such as  the volatility of the element
           and its chemical form, whether pyrolytic graphite is used, the rate
           of atomization, and furnace design.   If this situation is detected
           through blank burns, the tube should  be cleaned by operating  the
           furnace at full power for the required time period at  regular inter-
           vals in the analytical scheme.

12.11.3.3  Some of the smaller size furnace devices, or newer furnaces equipped
           with feedback temperature control  (Instrumentation Laboratories
           MODEL 555, Perkin-Elmer  MODELS HGA 2200 and HGA 76B, and Varian
           MODEL CRA-90) employing  faster rates  of atomization, can be operated
           when making use of lower atomization  temperatures for  shorter time
           periods than those listed in this manual.

12.11.3.4  Although prior digestion of the sample in many cases is not required
           provided that a representative aliquot of sample can be pipeted into
           the furnace, it provides for a more uniform matrix and possibly
           lessens matrix effects.

-------
                                                                Section 12.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 11 of 23
12.11.3.5  Inject a measured microliter aliquot of sample into the furnace and
           atomize.  If the concentration found is greater than the highest
           standard, the sample should be diluted in the same acid matrix and
           should be reanalyzed.  The use of multiple injections can improve
           accuracy and can help detect furnace pipetting errors.

12.11.4 Procedure for Determination of Total Aluminum

12.11.4.1  Summary—A portion of sample is digested, and digestate is analyzed
           for Al by furnace atomic absorption spectroscopy (U.S.  EPA,  1983).

12.11.4.2  Preparation of Aluminum Standard Solutions

             Aluminum stock solution (1000 mg/L Al)—Carefully weigh 1.000 gram
             aluminum metal (analytical reagent grade).   Add 15 ml concentrated
             HC1 and 5 ml concentrated HN03 to the metal, cover the beaker, and
             warm gently.  When metal is completely dissolved, transfer solu-
             tion quantitatively to a 1-L volumetric flask and bring to volume
             with water.  Alternatively, a commercially  available, certified Al
             standard may be used.

             Prepare dilutions of the stock solution to  be used as calibration
             standards at the time of analysis.  These solutions are also to be
             used for "standard additions."

             The calibration standard should be prepared in 0.5 percent (v/v)
             HN03.

12.11.4.3  Sample Preparation—The sample must be digested prior to analysis.
           Because of the low concentrations of analyte  expected,  contamination
           from atmospheric sources can be a major problem.  To avoid contami-
           nation, all preparations must be performed in a laminar flow hood.

           Quantitatively transfer a 50.00 ml aliquot of the well-mixed sample
           to a Griffin beaker.  Add 3.0 ml of concentrated nitric acid.  Place
           the beaker on a hot plate and cautiously evaporate to near dryness,
           making certain that the sample does not boil.  (DO NOT BAKE.)  Allow
           the beaker to cool, then again add 3.0 ml of  concentrated nitric
           acid.  Cover the beaker with a watch glass and return to the hot
           plate.  Increase the temperature of the hot plate until a gentle
           reflux action occurs.  Continue refluxing, adding acid as necessary,
           until the digestion is complete (indicated by a light-colored
           residue or no change in appearance with continued refluxing).  When
           complete, evaporate to near dryness.  Allow to cool.  Add 0.5 ml of
           50 percent nitric acid and warm slightly to dissolve any precipitate
           or residue resulting from evaporation.  Wash  down the beaker walls
           and watch glass with water.  Quantitatively filter the sample (to
           remove silicates and other insoluble materials) and adjust to 50.00
           mL.  The sample is now ready for analysis.

-------
                                                                Section  12.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page  12  of  23
12.11.4.4  Suggested Instrument Conditions (General)

           Drying time and temperature--30 seconds  at 125°C.

           Ashing time and temperature—30 seconds  at 1,300°C.

           Atomizing time and temperature—lO seconds at 2,700°C.

           Purge gas atmosphere—Argon.

           Wavelength--309.3 nm.

           Other operating conditions should be set as specified by  the
           particular instrument  manufacturer.

12.11.4.5  Analysis Procedure

           Calibrate the instrument as directed by  the instrument  manufacturer.

           Analyze the samples (including  required  QC samples).

           If a sample concentration exceeds the linear range, dilute  (with
           acidic media) and reanalyze.

           Report results as mg/L Al.

12.11.4.6  Notes

           The above instrument conditions are  for  a  Perkin-Elmer  HGA-2100 and
           are based on the use of a 20 uL injection, continuous-flow  purge
           gas, and nonpyrolytic  graphite.

           Background correction  may be required if the sample contains  a high
           level of dissolved solids.

           It has been reported that chloride ion and that  nitrogen  used as  a
           purge gas suppress the aluminum signal.   Therefore, the use of
           halide acids and nitrogen as a  purge gas should  be avoided.

           The ashing temperature can  be increased  to 1,500 to 1,700°C by
           adding 30 ug magnesium nitrate  (Mg(N03)2)  (Manning et al.,  1982).

           If blanks indicate that sample  contamination is  occuring, the use of
           Teflon labware is recommended.

12.11.5  Procedure for Determination of Total  Extractable Aluminum

-------
                                                                Section 12.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page 13 of 23
12.11.5.1  Summary— Samples for extractable  aluminum  are  prepared in the field
           and are obtained as the 8-hydroxyquinoline complex  in MIBK.  The
           MIBK solution is analyzed  for  aluminum  by  graphite  furnace atomic
           absorption (GFAA)  (Barnes,  1975;  May  et al . , 1979;  Driscoll, 1984).

12.11.5.2  Preparation of Reagents

           Glacial  acetic acid (HOAc,  18M) --Baker  Ultrex  grade or equivalent.

           Ammonium hydroxide (NHflOH,  5M) — Baker Ultrex grade  or equivalent.
           Sodium acetate solution  (NaOAc,  1.0M)~Dissolve 8.2 g NaOAc (Alfa
           Ultrapure grade or  equivalent)  in  100  ml water.

           Methyl  isobutyl  ketone  (MIBK)--HPLC  grade  or equivalent.

           Phenol  red indicator solution  (0.04  percent w/v) — ACS reagent grade.

           Hydrochloric acid  (HC1,  12M)--Baker  Ultrex grade or equivalent.

           2.5 M HC1— Dilute  208 ml of  12  M HC1 to 1.0 L.

           NH//NH3 buffer—Add 56  ml glacial acetic  acid to 75 ml of 5M NH4OH
           dilute to 250 ml.   Adjust pH to 8.3  by using NH4OH or HOAc.

           8-hydroxyquinoline  solution  (10 g/L)--Dissolve 5 grams of 8-hydroxy-
           quinoline (99 plus  percent purity) in  12.5 ml HOAc, then dilute to
           500 ml.

           8-hydroxyquinoline  sodium acetate  reagent— Mix, in order, 10 ml
           l.OM NaOAc, 50 ml  water, and 10 mL hydroxyquinoline solution.  This
           reagent must be prepared daily.

12.11.5.3  Preparation of Aluminum  Standard Solutions

           Aluminum stock solution — Prepare as  described in section 12.11.4.2.1,

           Dilute calibration  standards— Daily, quantitatively dilute the Al
           stock solution to  prepare a  series of  calibration standards over
           the range 0 to 0.1  mg/L  Al .  A  blank must  be prepared.  Prior to
           analysis, the blank, standards  (and  any QC samples) must be
           extracted.

             Pipet 25.00 ml of a calibration  standard (or calibration blank or
             QC sample) into  a clean 50-mL  separatory funnel (or a clean 50-mL
             disposable centrifuge  tube with  cap).

-------
                                                                Section 12.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page 14 of 23
             Add 2 to 3 drops phenol  red  indicator  and  5.00 ml 8-hydroxy-
             quinoline NaOAc  reagent.   Swirl  to  mix.
             Rapidly adjust the pH to  8 by  dropwise additions of 5M N^OH until
             the solution turns red.   Immediately add 2.0 ml NH4+/NH3 buffer
             and 10 ml MIBK.   Cap and  shake vigorously  for 7 to 10 seconds
             with a rapid,  end-to-end  motion.  Be careful of pressure buildup.
             Allow the phases to separate (10 to 15 seconds) and isolate the
             MIBK layer.   If  an emulsion  forms,  separation can be hastened by
             centrifugation.   Keep the MIBK layer tightly capped to prevent
             evaporation.
12.11.5.4  Suggested Instrument Conditions  (General)
           Drying cycle—Ramp 10 seconds, hold 10 seconds.
           Drying temperature—100°C.
           Ashing cycle—Ramp 5 seconds,  hold 20 seconds.
           Ashing temperature--!,500°C.
           Atomization cycle—Hold 5  seconds  (no ramp,  max. power heating).
           Atomi zati on temperature—2,500°C.
           Purge gas—Argon at 20 cc/minute.
           Lamp—Al  HC1  at  25 mA.
           Wavelength—309.3.
           Graphite tube—Nonpyrolytic.
           Sample size—25  uL.
           These operating  conditions  are for a  Perkin-Elmer 5000 with a
           HGA-500 graphite furnace and AS-40 autosampler.
12.11.5.5  Analysis Procedure
           Calibrate the  instrument as directed  by  the  instrument manufacturer.
           Analyze the samples (including required  QC samples).
           If a sample concentration  exceeds  the linear range, dilute with MIBK
           and reanalyze.

-------
                                                                Section  12.0
                                                                Revision  2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page  15  of 23
           Report results as mg/L Al.

12.11.5.6  Note - By using the same  volumes for  standards  as  for  samples,
           concentration factors are taken into  account.

12.11.6  Procedure for Determination of Dissolved  Calcium

12.11.6.1  Summary--The samples (filtered and  preserved  in the  field) are
           analyzed by flame atomic  absorption spectroscopy for Ca  (U.S. EPA,
           1983).

12.11.6.2  Preparation of Reagents

           Lanthanum chloride matrix modifier  solution—Dissolve  29  g La203,
           slowly and in small portions,  in 250  ml concentrated HC1  (Caution:
           Reaction is violent) and  dilute to  500  ml  with  water.

12.11.6.3  Preparation of Calcium Standard Solutions

           Calcium stock solution (500 mg/L Ca)--Suspend 1.250  g  CaC03
           (analytical reagent grade,  dried at 180°C  for 1 hour before  weighing)
           in water and dissolve cautiously with a minimum of dilute HC1.
           Dilute to 1,000 mL with water.

           Dilute calibration standards—Daily,  quantitatively  prepare  a series
           of dilute Ca standards from the calcium stock solution to span the
           desired concentration range.

12.11.6.4  Suggested Instrumental  Conditions (General)

           Calcium hollow cathode lamp;  wavelength, 422.7  nm; fuel,  acetylene;
           oxidant, air; type of flame,  reducing.

12.11.6.5  Analysis Procedure

           To each 10.0 mL volume of dilute calibration  standard, blank, and
           sample add 1.00 mL LaCl3  solution (e.g., add  2.0 mL  Lads solution
           to 20.0 mL sample).

           Calibrate the instrument  as directed  by the manufacturer.

           Analyze the samples.

           Dilute and reanalyze any  samples with a concentration  exceeding the
           calibrated range.

           Report results as mg/L Ca.

-------
                                                                Section 12.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 16 of 23
12.11.6.6  Notes

           Phosphate, sulfate, and aluminum interfere but are masked by the
           addition of lanthanum.  Because low calcium values result if the pH
           of the sample is above 7, both standards and samples are prepared
           in dilute acid solution.  Concentrations of magnesium greater than
           1,000 mg/L also cause low calcium values.  Concentrations of up to
           500 mg/L each of sodium, potassium, and nitrate cause no
           interference.

           Anionic chemical interferences can be expected if lanthanum is not
           used in samples and standards.

           The nitrous oxide-acetylene flame will  provide two to five times
           greater sensitivity and freedom from chemical  interferences.
           lonization interferences should be controlled  by adding a large
           amount of alkali to the sample and standards.   The analysis appears
           to be free from chemical suppressions in the nitrous oxide-acetylene
           flame.

           The 239.9 nm line may also be used.  This line has a relative
           sensitivity of 120.

12.11.6.7  Precision and Accuracy

           In a single laboratory (EMSL-Cincinnati), when use was made of
           distilled water spiked at concentrations of 9.0 and 36 mg Ca/L, the
           standard deviations were ±0.3 and ±0.6, respectively.  Recoveries at
           both these levels were 99 percent.

12.11.7  Procedure for Determination of Dissolved Iron

12.11.7.1  Summary—The samples (filtered and preserved in the field) are
           analyzed by flame atomic absorption spectroscopy (U.S. EPA, 1983).

12.11.7.2  Preparation of Iron Standard Solutions

           Fe stock solution (1,000 mg/L Fe)—Carefully weigh 1.000 g pure iron
           wire (analytical reagent grade) and dissolve in 5 mL concentrated
           HN03, warming if necessary.  When iron is completely dissolved,
           bring volume of solution to 1 L with water.

           Dilute calibration standards—Daily, quantitatively prepare a series
           of calibration standards spanning the desired  concentration range.
           Match the acid content of the standards to that of the samples
           (ca. 0.1 percent (v/v)

-------
                                                                Section  12.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 17  of  23
12.11.7.3  Suggested Instrumental  Conditions (General)

           Iron hollow cathode lamp;  wavelength,  248.3  nm;  fuel,  acetylene;
           oxidant, air; type of flame, oxidizing.

12.11.7.4  Analysis Procedure

           Calibrate the instrument as directed by  the  instrument manufacturer.

           Analyze the samples.

           Dilute and reanalyze any samples with concentrations exceeding the
           calibrated range.

           Report results in mg/L Fe.

12.11.7.5  Notes

           The following lines may also be used:  248.8 nm,  relative  sensi-
           tivity 2; 271.9 nm, relative sensitivity 4;  302.1 nm,  relative
           sensitivity 5; 252.7 nm, relative sensitivity 6;  372.0 nm,  relative
           sensitivity 10.

12.11.7.6  Precision and Accuracy

           An interlaboratory study on trace metal  analyses  by atomic  absorption
           was conducted by the Quality Assurance and Laboratory Evaluation
           Branch of EMSL-Cincinnati.  Six synthetic concentrates containing
           varying levels of aluminum, cadmium, chromium, copper, iron,
           manganese, lead, and zinc  were added to  natural water samples. The
           statistical  results for iron were as follows:
Number
Of Labs
82
85
78
79
57
54
True Value
(ug/L)
840
700
350
438
24
10
Mean Value
(M9/D
855
680
348
435
58
48
Standard
Deviation
(U9/D
173
178
131
183
69
69
Accuracy as
% Bias
1.8
-2.8
-0.5
-0.7
141
382
12.11.8  Procedure for Determination of Dissolved Magnesium

12.11.8.1  Summary—The samples (filtered and preserved in the field)  are
           analyzed by flame atomic  absorption spectroscopy for Mg.

-------
                                                                Section  12.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page  18  of  23
12.11.8.2  Preparation of Reagents

           Lanthanum chloride  solution — Dissolve  29  g  l^C^,  slowly  and  in
                                                           ,  s
           small  portion's, in 250 ml concentrated HC1  (Caution:  Reaction  is
           violent) and dilute to 500 ml with water.

12.11.8.3  Preparation of Magnesium Standard Solutions

           Stock  solution (500 mg/L Mg)--Dissolve 0.829  g  magnesium  oxide, MgO
           (analytical reagent grade), in 10 ml of HN03  and dilute to  1 L with
           water .

           Dilute  calibration standards— Daily, quantitatively  prepare from  the
           Mg stock solution a series of Mg standards  that spans  the desired
           concentration range.

12.11.8.4  Suggested Instrumental  Conditions (General)

           Magnesium hollow cathode lamp; wavelength,  285.2 nm;  fuel,  acetylene;
           oxidant, air; type of flame,  oxidizing.

12.11.8.5  Analysis Procedure

           To each 10.0 ml dilute calibration standard,  blank,  and sample, add
           1.00 ml LaCl3 solution (e.g., add 2.0 ml LaCl3  solution to  20.0 ml
           sample) .

           Calibrate the instrument as directed by the" manufacturer.

           Analyze the samples.

           Dilute  and reanalyze  any samples with a concentration  exceeding the
           linear  range.

           Report  results as mg/L Mg.

12.11.8.6  Notes

           The interference caused by aluminum at concentrations  greater  than
           2 mg/L  is masked by addition  of lanthanum.  Sodium,  potassium, and
           calcium cause no interference at concentrations less  than 400  mg/L.

           The line at 202.5 nm may also be used.  This  line  has  a relative
           sensitivity of 25.

           To cover the range of magnesium values normally observed  in surface
           waters  (0.1 to 20 mg/L), it is suggested that either  the  202.5 nm

-------
                                                                Section  12.0
                                                                Revision  2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page  19  of  23
           line be used or the burner head be rotated.   A 90°  rotation  of  the
           burner head will  produce approximately one-eighth the  normal
           sensitivity.

12.11.8.7  Precision and Accuracy

           In a single laboratory (EMSL-Cincinnati),  when use  is  made of
           distilled water spiked at concentrations  of  2.1 and 8.2  mg/L Mg,  the
           standard deviations were ±0.1 and  ±0.2, respectively.   Recoveries at
           both of these levels were 100 percent.

12.11.9  Procedure for Determination of Dissolved Manganese

12.11.9.1  Summary—The samples (filtered and preserved in the field) are
           analyzed by flame atomic absorption spectroscopy for Mn  (U.S. EPA,
           1983).

12.11.9.2  Preparation of Manganese Standard  Solutions

           Mn stock solution (1,000 mg/L Mn)--Carefully weigh  1.000 g manganese
           metal  (analytical reagent grade) and dissolve in 10 ml of HN03.
           When metal  is completely dissolved, dilute solution to 1 liter  with
           1 percent (v/v) HC1.

           Dilute calibration standards—Daily, quantitatively prepare  a series
           of calibration standards spanning  the desired concentration  range.
           Match the acid content of the standards to that of  the samples
           (ca.  0.1 percent (v/v)  HN03).

12.11.9.3  Instrumental Conditions  (General)

           Manganese hollow cathode lamp; wavelength, 279.5 nm; fuel, acetylene;
           oxidant, air; type of flame, oxidizing.

12.11.9.4  Analysis Procedure

           Calibrate the instrument as directed by the  manufacturer.

           Analyze the samples.

           Dilute and reanalyze any samples with a concentration  exeeding  the
           calibrated range.

           Report results as mg/L Mn.

12.11.9.5  Notes

-------
                                                                Section  12.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 20  of  23
           The line at 403.1 nm may also be used.   This line  has a  relative
           sensitivity of 10.

12.11.9.6  Precision and Accuracy

           An interlaboratory study on trace metal  analyses by  atomic  absorption
           was conducted by the Quality Assurance  and Laboratory Evaluation
           Branch of EMSL-Cincinnati.   Six synthetic concentrates containing
           varying levels of aluminum, cadmium,  chromium,  copper, iron,
           manganese, lead, and zinc were added  to natural  water samples.  The
           statistical results for manganese were  as follows:

                                                      Standard      Accuracy
          Number     True Value      Mean Value        Deviation       as
          of Labs      (ug/D          (ug/L)           (ug/L)        %  Bias

            77           426             432            70           1.5
            78           469             474            97           1.2
            71            84              86            26           2.1
            70           106             104            31         -2.1
            55            11              21            27         93
            55            17              21            20         22

12.11.10  Procedure for Determination  of Dissolved Potassium

12.11.10.1  Summary—The samples (filtered and preserved in the field) are
            analyzed by flame atomic absorption  spectrpscopy  for K  (U.S. EPA,
            1983).

12.11.10.2  Preparation of Potassium Standard  Solutions

            Potassium stock solution (100 mg/L K)—Dissolve 0.1907  g KC1
            (analytical reagent grade, dried at  110°C)  in  water and bring
            volume of solution to 1 L.

            Dilute calibration standards—Daily, quantitatively prepare a
            series of calibration standards spanning the desired concentration
            range.  Match the acid content of  the  standards to  that of the
            samples (ca.  0.1 percent (v/v)  HN03).

12.11.10.3  Suggested Instrumental  Conditions  (General)

            Potassium hollow cathode lamp;  wavelength,  766.5  nm; fuel,
            acetylene; oxidant, air; type of flame, slightly  oxidizing.

12.11.10.4  Analysis Procedure

            Calibrate the instrument as directed by the manufacturer.

-------
                                                                Section  12.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 21  of  23
            Analyze the samples.

            Dilute and reanalyze any sample with a concentration exceeding  the
            calibrated range.

            Report results as mg/L K.

12.11.10.5  Notes

            In air-acetylene or other  high-temperature flames (>2,800°C),
            potassium can experience partial  ionization which indirectly
            affects absorption sensitivity.  The presence of other alkali  salts
            in the sample can reduce this ionization and thereby enhance
            analytical results.  The ionization suppress!ve  effect of sodium is
            small if the ratio of Na to K is under 10.  Any  enhancement which is
            due to sodium can be stabilized by adding excess sodium (1,000
            ug/mL) to both sample and  standard solutions.  If more stringent
            control of ionization is required, the addition  of cesium should be
            considered.  Reagent blanks should be analyzed to correct for
            potassium impurities in the buffer stock.

            The 404.4-nm line may also be used.  This line has a relative
            sensitivity of 500.

            To cover the range of potassium values normally  observed in surface
            waters (0.1 to 20 mg/L), it is suggested that the burner head be
            rotated.  A 90° rotation of the burner head provides approximately
            one-eighth the normal sensitivity.

12.11.10.6  Precision and Accuracy

            In a single laboratory (EMSL-Cincinnati), when use was made of
            distilled water samples spiked at concentrations  of 1.6 and 6.3
            mg/L K, the standard deviations were ±0.2 and ±0.5, respectively.
            Recoveries at these levels were 103 percent and  102 percent,
            respectively.

12.11.11  Procedure for Determination  of Dissolved Sodium

12.11.11.1  Summary—The samples (filtered and preserved in  the field)  are  ana-
            lyzed by flame atomic absorption spectroscopy for Na (U.S.  EPA,
            1983).

12.11.11.2  Preparation of Sodium Standard Solutions

            Sodium stock solution (1,000 mg/L Na)—Dissolve  2.542 g NaCl
            (analytical reagent grade, dried at 140°C) in water and bring the
            volume of the solution to  1 L.

-------
                                                                Section 12.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page 22 of 23
            Dilute calibration standards—Daily, quantitatively prepare a
            series of calibration standards spanning the desired concentration
            range.  Match the acid content of the standards to that of the
            samples (ca. 0.1 percent (v/v) HN03).

12.11.11.3  Suggested Instrumental Conditions (General)

            Sodium hollow cathode lamp; wavelength, 589.6 nm; fuel, acetylene;
            oxidant, air; type of flame, oxidizing.

12.11.11.4  Analysis Procedure

            Calibrate the instrument as directed by the manufacturer.

            Analyze the samples.

            Dilute and reanalyze  any samples with a concentration exceeding the
            calibrated range.

            Report results as mg/L Na.

12.11.11.5  Notes

            The 330.2 nm resonance line of sodium, which has a relative
            sensitivity of 185, provides a convenient way to avoid the need to
            dilute more concentrated solutions of sodium.

            Low-temperature flames increase sensitivity by reducing the extent
            of ionization of this easily ionized metal.  lonization may also be
            controlled by adding  potassium (1,000 mg/L) to both standards and
            samples.

12.11.11.6  Precision and Accuracy

            In a single laboratory (EMSL-Cincinnati), when use is made of
            distilled water samples spiked at levels of 8.2 and 52 mg/L Na, the
            standard deviations were ±0.1 and ±0.8, respectively.  Recoveries
            at these levels were  102 percent and 100 percent.

12.12  Calculations

       Generally, instruments are calibrated to output sample results
       directly in concentration  units.  If they do not, then a manual cali-
       bration curve must be prepared,  and sample concentrations must  be
       determined by comparing the sample signal to the calibrated curve.

       If dilutions were performed, the appropriate factor must be applied to
       sample values.

-------
                                                                Section  12.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page  23  of  23
       Report results as mg/L for each analyte.

12.13  References

       American Society for Testing and Materials,  1984.   Annual  Book  of  ASTM
            Standards, Vol. 11.01, Standard Specification  for  Reagent  Water,
            D 1193-77 (reapproved 1983).   ASTM,  Philadelphia,  Pennsylvania.

       Barnes, R. B., 1975.  The Determination of Specific Forms  of Aluminum
            in Natural Water.  Chem.  Geol., v. 15,  pp.  177-191.

       Driscoll,  C.  T., 1984.  A Procedure  for the  Fractionation  of Aqueous
            Aluminum in Dilute Acidic Waters.   Int.  J.  Environ. Anal.  Chem.,
            v. 16, pp. 267-283.

       Manning, D. C., W. Slavin, and 6.  R. Carnick, 1982.  Investigation of
            Aluminum Interferences Using  the Stabilized Temperature Platform
            Furnace.  Spectrochim. Acta,  Part B, v.  37b, n.  4,  pp.  331-341.

       May,  H. M., P. A. Helmke, and  M. L.  Jackson,  1979.   Determination  of
            Mononuclear Dissolved Aluminum  in Near-Neutral Waters.   Chem.
            Geol., v. 24, pp. 259-269.

       U.S.  Environmental Protection  Agency, 1983 (revised).   Methods  for
            Chemical Analysis of Water and  Wastes,  Method  200.0,  Atomic Absorp-
            tion  Methods.  EPA 600/4-79-020.  U.S.  EPA, Cincinnati, Ohio.

-------
                                                                Section 13.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 1 of 10
13.0  DETERMINATION OF DISSOLVED METALS (Ca, Fe, Mg,  and Mn)  BY INDUCTIVELY
      COUPLED PLASMA EMISSION SPECTROSCOPY

13.1  Scope and Application

      This method is applicable to the determination  of dissolved Ca,  Fe,
      Mg, and Mn in natural surface waters.

      Table 13.1 lists the recommended wavelengths and typical  estimated
      instrumental  detection limits using conventional pneumatic nebulization
      for the specified elements.  Actual working detection limits are
      sample-dependent, and as the sample matrix varies, these  concentrations
      may also vary.

      Because of the differences among makes and models of satisfactory
      instruments,  no detailed instrumental  operating instructions can be
      provided.  Instead,  the analyst is referred to  the instructions
      provided by the manufacturer of the particular  instrument.

13.2  Summary of Method

      The method describes a technique for the simultaneous or  sequential
      determination of Ca, Fe, Mg, and Mn in samples  collected  for the
      NSWS.  The method is based on the measurement of atomic emission by
      optical spectroscopy.  Samples are nebulized to produce an aerosol.
      The aerosol is transported by an argon carrier  stream to  an inductively
      coupled argon plasma (ICP) which is produced by a radio frequency (RF)
      generator.  In the plasma (which is at a temperature of 6,000 to
      10,000°K), the analytes in the aerosol are atomized, ionized, and
      excited.  The excited ions and atoms emit light at their  characteristic
      wavelengths.   The spectra from all analytes are dispersed by a grating
      spectrometer, and the intensities of the lines  are monitored by  photo-
      multiplier tubes.  The photocurrents from the photomultiplier tubes  are
      processed by  a computer system.  The signal is  proportional to the
      analyte concentration and is calibrated by analyzing a series of stand-
      ards (U.S. EPA, 1983; Fassel, 1982).

      A background  correction technique is required to compensate for  vari-
      able background contribution to the determination of trace elements.
      Background must be measured adjacent to analyte lines during sample
      analysis.  The position selected for the background intensity measure-
      ment, on either or both sides of the analytical line, will be deter-
      mined by the  complexity of the spectrum adjacent to the analyte  line.
      The position  used must be free of spectral interference and must
      reflect the same change in background  intensity as occurs at the
      analyte wavelength measured.  Generally, each instrument  has different
      background handling  capabilities.  The instrument operating manual
      should be consulted  for guidance.

-------
                                                                Section 13.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 2 of 10
              TABLE 13.1.  RECOMMENDED WAVELENGTHS3 AND ESTIMATED
                         INSTRUMENTAL DETECTION LIMITS
============================================================================:


Element               Wavelength (nm)      Estimated detection limit (ug/L)b
Calcium
Iron
Magnesium
Manganese
317.933
259.940
279.079
257.610
10
7
30
2
aThe wavelengths listed are recommended because of their sensitivity and over-
 all acceptance.  Other wavelengths may be substituted if they can provide the
 needed sensitivity and are treated with the same corrective techniques for
 spectral  interference (EPA 1979).
bThe estimated instrumental detection limits as shown are taken from Fassel,
 1982.  They are given as a guide for an instrumental limit.  The actual method
 detection limits are sample-dependent and may vary as the sample matrix
 varies.


        The possibility of additional interferences named in 13.3.1 should also
        be recognized, and appropriate corrections should be made.

13.3  Interferences

      Several types of interference effects may contribute to inaccuracies in
      the  determination of trace elements.  They are summarized in sections
      13.3.1 through 13.3.1.3.

13.3.1  Spectral interferences  can  be categorized as (1)  overlap of a
        spectral line from another  element; (2) unresolved overlap of mole-
        cular band spectra; (3)  background contribution from continuous or
        recombination phenomena; and (4) background contribution from stray
        light from the line emission of high-concentration elements.   The
        first of these effects  can  be compensated by utilizing a computer
        correction of the raw data, which would require the monitoring and
        measurement of the interfering element.  The second effect may require
        selection of an alternate wavelength.   The third and fourth effects can
        usually be compensated  by a background correction adjacent to the
        analyte line.  In addition, users of simultaneous multi-element
        instrumentation must assume the responsibility of verifying the absence
        of spectral interference from an element that could occur in a sample
        but for which there is  no channel in the instrument array.  Listed in

-------
                                                                Section 13.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 3 of 10
        Table 13.2 are some interference effects for the recommended wave-
        lengths given in Table 13.1.  The interference information is
        expressed as analyte concentration eqivalents (i.e.,  false analyte
        concentrations)  arising from 100 mg/L of the interfering element.
        The values in the table are only approximate and should be used as  a
        guide for determining potential interferences.  Actual  values must  be
        determined for each analytical  system when necessary.

        Only those interferents listed were investigated.   The  blank spaces
        in Table 13.2 indicate that measurable interferences  were not
        observed for the interferent concentrations listed in Table 13.3.
        Generally, interferences were discernible if they produced peaks or
        background shifts corresponding to 2 to 5 percent of  the peaks gene-
        rated by the analyte concentrations (also listed in Table 13.3).

13.3.2  Physical interferences are generally considered to be effects associ-
        ated with the sample nebulization and transport processes.  Changes
        in viscosity and surface tension can cause significant  inaccuracies,
        especially in samples that contain high dissolved solids or acid
        concentrations.   The use of a peristaltic pump may lessen these
        interferences.  If these types of interferences are operative, they
        must be reduced  by dilution of the sample or utilization of standard
        addition techniques.

        High dissolved solids may also cause salt buildup at  the tip of the
        nebulizer.  This affects aerosol flow rate and causes instrumental
        drift.   Wetting  the argon prior to nebulization, the  use of a tip
        washer, or sample dilution have been used to control  this problem.

        It has been reported that better control of the argon flow rate
        improves instrument performance.  This is accomplished  with the use
        of mass flow controllers.

13.3.3  Chemical interferences are characterized by molecular compound
        formation, ionization effects,  and solute vaporization  effects.
        Normally these effects are negligible with the ICP technique.  If
        observed, they can be minimized by careful selection  of operating
        conditions (i.e., incident power, observation position,  and so
        forth), by buffering of the sample, by matrix matching,  and by stan-
        dard addition procedures.  These types of interferences can be highly
        dependent on matrix type and on the specific analyte  element.

13.3.4  Whenever a new or unusual sample matrix is encountered,  a series of
        tests should be  performed prior to reporting concentration data for
        analyte elements.  These tests, as outlined in 13.3.4.1  through
        13.3.4.4, will ensure that neither positive nor negative interference
        effects are operative on any of the analyte elements, which would
        distort the accuracy of the reported values.

-------
                   TABLE 13.2.  ANALYTE CONCENTRATION  EQUIVALENTS (mg/L) ARISING FROM

                                     INTERFERENTS  AT THE 100 mg/L LEVEL




Analyte     Wavelength,         '        	Interferent	

               (nm)                                         '

	             Al      Ca      Cr     Cu     Fe      Mg      Mn       Ni       Ti      V


Calcium       317.933     —      —     0.08    —    0.01    0.01    0.04      --      0.03    0.03


Iron          259.940     --      —      —     —     —      —     0.12


Magnesium     279.079     --     0.02    0.11    --    0.13     —     0.25      —      0.07    0.12


Manganese     257.610    0.005   ~     0.01    —    0.002   0.002
                                                                                                         •o o po co
                                                                                                         Oi fa ft) n>
                                                                                                         ua «-*• < o
                                                                                                         -P»   -•• o
                                                                                                             o 3
                                                                                                         O I— 3
                                                                                                         -hi—1   I—1
                                                                                                           •^.ro co
                                                                                                         H- oo
                                                                                                         o    o

-------
                                                                Section  13.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page  5  of 10
       TABLE 13.3.  INTERFERENT AND ANALYTE ELEMENTAL CONCENTRATIONS USED
                   FOR INTERFERENCE MEASUREMENTS IN TABLE 13.2
           Analytes  (mg/L)	Interferents   (mg/L)
Ca
Fe
Mg
Mn






1
1
1
1






Al
Ca
Cr
Cu
Fe
Mg
Nn
Ni
Ti
V
1,000
1,000
200
200
1,000
1,000
200
200
200
200
13.3.4.1  Serial Dilution—If the analyte concentration is  sufficiently  high
          (minimally a factor of 10 above the instrumental  detection  limit
          after dilution),  an analysis of a dilution  should agree  within 5
          percent of the original  determination (or within  some  acceptable
          control limit that has been established for that  matrix).   If  not,  a
          chemical  or physical  interference effect should be suspected.

13.3.4.2  Spiked Addition—The recovery of a spiked addition added at a  minimum
          level of 10X the  instrumental  detection limit (maximum 100X) to the
          original  determination should be recovered  to within 90  to  110
          percent or within the established control limit for that matrix.  If
          not,  a matrix effect should be suspected.   The use of  a  standard
          addition  analysis procedure can usually compensate for this effect.

CAUTION:  The standard addition technique does not detect coincident  spectral
          overlap.   If overlap is suspected,  use  of computerized compensation,
          an alternate wavelength, or comparison  with an alternate method is
          recommended.

13.3.4.3  Comparison with Alternate Method of Analysis—When a new sample
          matrix is being investigated,  a comparison  test may be performed  with
          other analytical  techniques, such as atomic absorption spectrometry
          or other  approved methodology.

13.3.4.4  Wavelength Scanning of Analyte Line Region—If the appropriate equip-
          ment  is available,  wavelength  scanning  can  be performed  to  detect
          potential spectral  interferences.

-------
                                                                Section  13.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page  6  of 10
13.4  Safety

      Generally, the calibration standards,  sample types,  and most reagents
      pose no hazard to the analyst.   Protective clothing  (lab coats  and
      gloves) and safety glasses should be worn when handling concentrated
      acids.

      Follow the instrument safety recommendations provided by the manufacturer
      for the operation of the ICP.

      The toxicity or carcinogenicity of each reagent used in this method has
      not been precisely defined.   Each chemical compound  should be treated
      as a potential health hazard.   From this viewpoint,  exposure to these
      chemicals must be reduced to the lowest possible level  by whatever
      means available.   The laboratory is responsible for  maintaining a
      current awareness file of OSHA  regulations regarding the safe handling
      of the chemicals  specified in this method.  A reference file of
      material data handling sheets should also be made available to  all
      personnel involved in the chemical analysis.  Additional references to
      laboratory safety are available and have been identified (NIOSH,  1977;
      OSHA, 1976; ACS,  1979) for the  information of the analyst.

13.5  Apparatus and Equipment

      Inductively Coupled Plasma-Atomic Emission Spectrometer

      Computer-controlled ICP emission spectrometer with background correc-
      tion capability shall be used.

13.6  Reagents and Consumable Materials

13.6.1  Acids used in the preparation of standards and for sample processing
        must be ultra-high purity grade or equivalent (e.g.,  Baker Ultrex grade
        or SeaStar Ultrapure grade).

13.6.1.1  Hydrochloric  Acid, concentrated (sp gr 1.19)

13.6.1.2  Hydrochloric  Acid (50 percent v/v)—Add 500 ml concentrated HC1 to
          400 ml water  and dilute  to  1 L.

13.6.1.3  Nitric Acid,  concentrated (sp gr 1.41)

13.6.1.4  Nitric Acid (50 percent v/v)--Add  500 ml concentrated HN03  to 400 ml
          water and dilute to 1 L.

-------
                                                                Section  13.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 7 of 10
13.6.2  Water

        Water must meet the specifications for Type I  Reagent Water given in
        ASTM D 1193 (ASTM, 1984).

13.6.3  Standard Stock Solutions

        Solutions may be purchased or prepared from ultra-high purity g^ade
        chemicals or metals.  All  salts must be dried  for 1 hour at 105 C
        unless otherwise specified.

CAUTION:  Many metal salts are extremely toxic and may be fatal  if swallowed.
          Wash hands thoroughly after handling.
13.6.3.1  Calcium Stock Standard Solution (100 mg/D— Suspend 0.2498 g
          (dried at 180°C for 1 hour before weighing)  in water and dissolve
          cautiously with a minimum amount of 50 percent HN03.  Add 10.0 mL
          concentrated HN03 and dilute to 1,000 mL with water.
13.6.3.2  Iron Stock Standard Solution (100 mg/L)~Dissolve 0.1430 g Fe203  in  a
          warm mixture of 20 mL 50 percent HC1  and 2 mL concentrated HN03-
          Cool, add an additional  5 mL concentrated HN03,  and dilute to 1,000
          mL with water.

13.6.3.3  Magnesium Stock Standard Solution (100 mg/L)— Dissolve 0.1658 g MgO
          in a minimum amount of 50 percent HN03.  Add 10.0 mL concentrated
          HN03 and dilute to 1,000 mL with water.

13.6.3.4  Manganese Stock Standard Solution (100 mg/D— Dissolve 0.1000 g of
          manganese metal in an acid mixture consisting of 10 mL concentrated
          HC1 and 1 mL concentrated HN03,  and dilute to 1,000 mL with water.

13.7  Sample Handling, Preservation, and Storage
                 i
      For the determination of trace elements,  contamination and loss are of
      prime concern.  Dust in the laboratory environment,  impurities in
      reagents, and impurities on laboratory apparatus which the sample con-
      tacts are all sources of potential contamination.  Sample containers
      can introduce either positive or negative errors in  the measurement of
      trace elements by (a) contributing contaminants through leaching or
      surface desorption and (b) by depleting concentrations through adsorp-
      tion.  Thus the collection and treatment of the sample prior to analysis
      requires particular attention.  Labware should be thoroughly washed as
      described in Appendix A.

      Samples are collected and processed  in the field.  A portion (aliquot 3)
      of each sample is filtered and acidified (0.1-mL increments) with nitric
      acid until  the pH <2.  The processed samples are then sent to the lab and
      are analyzed (as is) for dissolved metal  (Ca, Fe, Mg, Mn) content.

-------
                                                                Section 13.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 8 of 10
13.8  Calibration and Standardization

      Prepare a calibration blank and a series of dilute calibration stan-
      dards from the stock solutions to span the expected sample concentra-
      tion range.  Match the acid content of the standards to that of the
      samples (written on the sample label, ca. 0.2 percent).  A multi-
      element standard may be prepared.

      The calibration procedure varies with the various ICPES instruments.
      Calibrate the ICPES for each analyte following the instrument opera-
      ting conditions.

13.9  Quality Control

      The required QC procedures are described in section 3.4.

13.10 Procedure

13.10.1 Set up instrument as recommended by the manufacturer or as experience
        dictates.  The instrument must be allowed to become thermally stable
        before beginning (10 to 30 minutes).

13.10.2 Profile and calibrate instrument according to the recommended procedures
        provided by the instrument manufacturer.  Flush the system with the
        calibration blank between each standard.  (The use of the average
        intensity of multiple exposures for both standardization and sample
        analysis has been found to reduce random error.)

13.10.3 Begin sample analysis by flushing the system with the calibration blank
        solution between each sample.  Remember to analyze required QC samples.

13.10.4  Dilute and reanalyze any samples with a concentration exceeding the
         calibration range.

13.11 Calculations

      Generally, instruments are calibrated to output sample results directly
      in concentration units.  If not, then a manual calibration curve must
      be prepared, and sample concentrations must be determined by comparing
      the sample signal  to the calibrated curve.

      If dilutions were performed, the appropriate factor must be applied to
      sample values.

      Report results as mg/L for each analyte.

-------
                  TABLE 13.4.   INDUCTIVELY COUPLED PLASMA PRECISION  AND ACCURACY DATA^


Element
Mn
Fe

True
Value
(ug/D
350
600
Sampl e 1
Mean
Reported
Value
(ng/L)
345
594

Mean
ZRSD
2.7
3.0

True
Value
(ug/D
15
20
Sampl e 2
Mean
Reported
Value
(ug/D
15
19

Mean
SRSD
6.7
15

True
Value
(ug/D
100
180
Sample 3
Mean
Reported
Value
(ug/L)
99
178

Mean
%RSD
3.3
6.0
aNot all elements were analyzed  by all laboratories.
 Ca and Mg  were not determined.
                                                                                                         -O O 73 C/>
                                                                                                         O> fa fD fD
                                                                                                          -•• rt
                                                                                                           .. in -i.
                                                                                                         to   -•• O
                                                                                                             O 3
                                                                                                         01—3
                                                                                                           00
                                                                                                            . ro

-------
                                                                Section 13.0
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 10 of 10
13.12 Precision and Accuracy

      In an EPA round-robin phase 1 study,  seven laboratories applied the ICP
      technique to acid-distilled water matrices that had been dosed with
      various metal concentrates.  Table 13.4 lists the true value,  the mean
      reported value, and the mean %RSD (U.S. EPA,  1983).

13.13 References

      American Chemical  Society,  1979.   Safety in Academic Laboratories,
           3rd ed.  Committee on  Chemical  Safety, ACS,  Washington,  D.C.

      American Society for Testing and  Materials, 1984.   Annual  Book of ASTM
           Standards, Vol. 11.01, Standard  Specification for Reagent Water,
           D 1193-77 (reapproved  1983).  ASTM, Philadelphia, Pennsylvania.

      Department of Health, Education,  and  Welfare, 1977.  Carcinogens -
           Working with  Carcinogens.   No. 77-206.  DHEW, Public  Health Service,
           Center for Disease Control,  National  Institute for Occupational
           Safety and Health, Cincinnati, Ohio.

      Fassel, V.  A., 1982.  Analytical  Spectroscopy with Inductively Coupled
           Plasmas - Present Status and Future Prospects.  In:  Recent Advances
           in Analytical  Spectroscopy.   Pergamon Press,  OxfoFd and  New York.

      Occupational Safety and Health  Administration,  1976.  OSHA Safety and
           Health Standards, General  Industry.  OSHA 2.206 (29 CFR 1910).   OSHA.

      U.S.  Environmental  Protection Agency,  1979.  Inductively Coupled Plasma  -
           Atomic Emission Spectroscopy - Prominent Lines.  EPA-600/4-79-017.
           U.S. EPA, Cincinnati,  Ohio.

      U.S.  Environmental  Protection Agency,  1983 (revised).   Methods for  Chemi-
           cal  Analysis  of Water  and  Wastes,  Method 200.7, Inductively Coupled
           Plasma-Atomic Emission Spectrometric  Method  for the Trace Element
           Analysis of Water and  Wastes.  EPA-600/4-79-020.   U.S. EPA,
           Cincinnati, Ohio.

-------
                                                                Appendix  A
                                                                Revision  2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page  1  of 2
                                   APPENDIX A

                            CLEANING OF PLASTICWARE
A-1.0  SAMPLE CONTAINERS

       A laboratory supplies clean plastic sample containers  (cubitainers,
       Nalgene bottles, centrifuge tubes)  to the field  stations.  The  containers
       are composed of amber, high-density linear polyethylene, and are  of  the
       wide-mouth design.  Each stream sample requires  one  4-L cubitainer,  one
       500-mL capacity bottle,  two 250-mL  capacity bottles, three 125-mL
       capacity bottles, one 50-mL graduated centrifuge tube  with cap, and  one
       10-mL polypropylene test tube with  cap.   An equipment  list is  given  in
       Table 2.1

A-l.l  Cleaning of Plasticware

       Plasticware, in keeping  with its use, is cleaned by  either an  acid
       leaching procedure or water leaching procedure.   Each  is described
       below.

A-l.1.1  Cleaning Procedure 1 (Acid Leaching)

         All plasticware (with  the exceptions in the  next paragraph)  is  rinsed
         three times with deionized water, three times  with 3N HNO? (prepared
         from Baker Instra-Analyzed HNO^ or equivalent),  and  six  times with
         deionized water.  It is then filled with deionized water and is allowed
         to stand for 48 hours.  Next, it  is emptied,  is  dried in a laminar-flow
         hood delivering Class  100 air (when dry containers are necessary),  and
         is placed in clean plastic bags (bottles are  capped  first).

A-l.l.2  Cleaning Procedure 2 (DI Water Leaching)

         Plasticware to be used for pH, BNC, ANC, and  anion determinations  is
         rinsed three times with deionized water, is  filled with  deionized
         water, is allowed to stand for 48 hours, and  is  then emptied and
         sealed in clean plastic bags.

A-1.1.3  Quality Control

         After the initial cleaning, 5 percent of the  containers  are  checked to
         ensure that rinsing has been adequate.  The  check  is made by first
         adding 500 mL (or maximum amount) deionized  water  to a clean con-
         tainer, sealing the container with a cap or  parafilm, and slowly
         rotating it so that the water touches all  surfaces.  The specific
         conductance of the water is then  measured.   It must  be less  than 1

-------
                                                         Appendix A
                                                         Revision 2
                                                         Date:   11/86
                                                         Page 2 of 2
  MS/cm.  If any of the containers fail  the check,  all  of the containers
  are rerinsed, and 5 percent are retested.

NOTE:  The deionized water used in cleaning the plasticware must meet or
       exceed specifications for ASTM Type I reagent grade Water.

-------
LAB NAME
                                  BATCH  ID
 NATIONAL SURFACE HATER SURVEY
            FORM 11

 SUMMARY OF  SAMPLE RESULTS

	   LAB MANAGER'S SIGNATURE
                                                                                                         Page 1 of 2
SAM-
PLE
ID:
01
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
ALIQUOT ID
1
Ca
mg/L








































Hg
mg/L








































K
ng/L








































Na
ng/L








































Mn
mg/L








































Fe
mg/L








































2
Extr.
Al
mg/L








































3
C1
mg/L








































SO,
mg/L








































mg/L








































S10?
mg/L








































ISE
Total F
mg/L








































                                                                                                                                 CD
                                                                                                                                         tO
                                                                                                                                             O 73
                                                                                                                                                n>
 NOTE:   Approved Data Qualifiers and instructions for their use are listed  in Table 3.10.
                                                   NSWS  Form  11
                                                                                             • • (/)  3
                                                                                                -•• Q.
                                                                                                O  -••
                                                                                             I— 3  X
                                                                                          (-• OO
                                                                                                                                                ro oo

-------
LAB NAME
                                BATCH ID
 NATIONAL SURFACE WATER SURVEY
           FORM 11

   SUMMARY OF SAMPLE RESULTS

	   LAB MANAGER'S SIGNATURE
                                                                                         Page 2 of 2
SAM-
PLE
ID:
01
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
ALIQUOT 10
4
DOC
mg/L








































NH,
mg/L








































5
Measured
Eq.
PH








































ANC
Inlt. pH








































BNC
Inlt. PH





























'










BNC
ueq/L








































ANC
ueq/L








































COND.
liS/cm








































Eq.
DIC
mg/L








































Inlt.
DIC
mg/L








































6
Total
P
mg/L








































7
Total
A1
mg/L








































 NOTE:  Approved Data Qualifiers and Instructions for their use are listed In Table 3.10.
                                NSWS Form 11  (Continued)
                                                                                       O 50 J>
                                                                                       (U 0> TD
                                                                                       c* < T3
                                                                                       n> — *• CD
                                                                                       • • «/>  3
                                                                                          -•• Q.
                                                                                          o  ->•
                                                                                                                                oo
                                                                                                                                      co

-------
                                                                    Appendix  B
                                                                    Revision  2
                                                                    Date:   11/86
                                                                    Page 3  of 16
Lab Name
NATIONAL SURFACE WATER SURVEY
          Form 13

    ANC AND BNC RESULTS

     Batch ID
Sample ID_
Lab Manager's Signature Analyst
]
I
I
(
(
]
RESULTS
~ANC] = ueg/L
)ATA
:* « eo/L
* = eq/L
DATE STANDARDIZED
DATE STANDARDIZED
NITIAL SAMPLE VOLUME
ACID
VOLUME HC1
(mL)
0.00
0.00 (with KC1)
































TITRATION
MEASURED
PH'


































CALCULATED
PH



































mL
BLANK ANC
BASE TITRATION
VOLUME NaOH
(mL)
0.00
0.00 (with KC1)






•

























MEASURED
PH'


































CALCULATED
PH



































                                 NSWS Form 13

-------
                         NATIONAL SURFACE WATER SURVEY
                                    Form 14*

                                QC DATA FOR ANC
                                AND BNC ANALYSES
            Appendix B
            Revision 2
            Date:   11/86
            Page 4 of 16
LAB NAME
BATCH ID
LAB MANAGER'S SIGNATURE
SAMPLE
ID
01
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
ANC
[jeq/L






























C02-BNC
[jeq/L






























CALCULATED ANC
RESULT






























DIFFERENCE0






























ZDb






























*Form not required in data package but recommended for internal  QC requirements.

Difference = Calculated ANC-Measured ANC

bRefer to Section 4.0.
                                 NSWS Form 14*

-------
                                           NATIONAL SURFACE HATER SURVEY
                                                      For* 15*
LAB NAME
       CONDUCTIVITY


BATCH 10
LAB MANAGER'S SIGNATURE

Sample
ID
01
02
03
04
OS
06
07
OB
09
io
11
1Z
13
IT
^5^
IF
f J
18
19
Zd
Zl
22
23
Z4
Z5
Z6
27
ZH
Z9
30
SPECIFIC CONDUCTANCE
(uS/ci»)
Calculated






























Measured






























ID**






























CAlCULflllD CONDUCTANCE FOR EACH ION pS/Cfl
HCOJ






























Ca+2

























•




co3-z






























ci-






























Hg*2






























N03-






























K*






























Na*






























S04'2






























NH4*






























H*






























OH"






























3.5XI03 1.9ZXIO
    Specific Conductance Factors of Ions
    t(pS/on at 25'C) per iiigA]       0.71S
 2.60   2.82   2.14   3.82  1.15  1.84  2.13  1.54
      (per    (per
4.13 mole/I) mole/I)
*  For* not required 1n data package but reconmended for Internal  QC requirements
-o o TO y>
to o> n> ~o
ua «-•• < -o
m m -*• n
   .. Crt 3
tn    -••ex
      o -••
O I-1 3 X
** * Conductance Difference «
                                Calculated Cond.-Measured Cond.
                    x 100
                                                                                                                                    ro oo
                                                                                                                                > OO
                                    Measured Conductance


                                                     NSWS  Form  15

-------
                                                                           Appendix  B
                                                                           Revision  2
                                                                           Date:   11/86
                                                                           Page  6 of 16
LAB NAME
  NATIONAL SURFACE HATER SURVEY
            Form 16*

 ANION-CATION BALANCE CALCULATION

	 BATCH ID 	 LAB MANAGERS SIGNATURE

Sample
ID
01
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
X Ion
Difference **






























Factor to Convert
mg/L to ueq/L
Ions - (ueq/L)
Ca+2






























49.9
cr






























28.2
Mq+2






























82.3
N03~






























16.1
K*






























25.6
Na*






























43.5
V






















-







20.8
F-






























52.6
NH>,*






























55.4
ANC































H****































  *  Form not required 1n data package but recommended for Internal  QC requirements

                        ANC -i- E  Anions - £ Cations  (except H+)
 ** % Ion  Difference
*** [H+]  =  (10-P") x 106
                          Z Anions + E Cation + ANC  +  2[H*]
                                  x 100
                                     NSWS  Form  16

-------
                                                                Appendix B
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page 7 of 16
                         NATIONAL SURFACE WATER SURVEY
                                    Form 17                       Page 1 of 1

                               1C RESOLUTION TEST
LAB NAME

BATCH ID
LAB MANAGER'S SIGNATURE
1C Resolution Test

1C Make and Model:_

Date:
Concentration:  S042~ 	ug/mL, N03	ug/mL

Column Back Pressure (at max. of stroke): 	psi

Flow Rate: 	  mL/min

Column Model:                            Date of Purchase:
Column Manufacturer:

Column Serial No:
Is precolumn in system   	Yes    	No

(a) 	cm    (b) 	cm

Percentage Resolution:  100 x (1-a/b) 	
The resolution must be greater than 60 percent


Test Chromatogram:
                                  NSWS Form 17

-------
                                                                Appendix B
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page   8 of  16
LAB NAME
        NATIONAL SURFACE WATER SURVEY
                  Form 18

             QUALITY ASSURANCE
             (DETECTION LIMITS)

                        BATCH ID
LAB MANAGER'S SIGNATURE
Parameter
Units
                    Instrumental
Contract Required     Detection    Date Determined
 Detection  Limit        Limit       (DD  MMM  YY)
Ca mg/L
Mg mg/L
K mg/L
Na mg/L
Mn mg/L
Fe mg/L
Total Extr actable
Al mg/L
Cl mg/L
S04 mg/L
N03 mg/L
Si 02 mg/L
Total dissolved
F mg/L
NH4 mg/L
DOC mg/L
Specific
Conductance pS/cm
DIC mg/L
Total dissolved
P mg/L
Total Al mg/L
0.01
0.01
0.01
0.01
0.01
0.01
0.005
0.01
0.05
0.005
0.05
0,005
0.005
0.01
0.1
*
0.05
0.002
0.005









,

















-








*Report the Y,  which must not exceed 0.9  pS/cm, of six (6)  nonconsecutive blanks.
Note 1:  Indicate instrument for which  IDL applies by using the  following code
         letters - F (furnace AA),  P (ICP), L (Flame AA).   Place the code
         letter after the IDL value reported.
                             NSWS  Form 18

-------
                                              NATIONAL  SURFACE MATER SURVEY
                                                         FORM 19
Page 1 of 2
LAB NAME
                                  BATCH ID
                                               SAMPLE  HOLDING TIME SUMMARY

                                                          LAB MANAGER'S SIGNATURE
DATE* SAMPLED
                                  DATE RECEIVED
Parameter
Holding
Tine
Holding Time
Plus
Date Sampled
Saaple ID:
01
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
IS
16
17
18
19
20
21
ZZ
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37 .
38
39
40
Ca
28

"9
28


















































































K
28










































Ma
28

Date*








































Mn
28










































Fe
28

Total
Extr. Al
7

Cl
28

so4
28

Analyzed**
































































































































































NO
7

S102
28

I5E
Total r
28


























































































































                                                                                                                                              -O O 73 J>
                                                                                                                                              CD O>  "O
                                                                                                                                              to c+ < T3
                                        to 3
                                        -"• O.
                                        O -••
                                        3 X
                                                                                                                                              1C

                                                                                                                                              O
  •Report these dates as Julian dates (I.e..  March  26, 1984 • 4086).
 **If parameter was reanalyzed because of QA probi ens, report the last date analyzed.
                                  i—1 oo
                                  en cr>
                                                                                                                                                   . PO O3
                                                    NSWS Form  19

-------
LAB NAME
DATE* SAMPLED
      NATIONAL SURFACE HATER SURVEY
               FORM 19

       SAMPLE HOLDING TINE SUMMARY

BATCH ID 	   LAB MANAGER1S SIGNATURE

DATE RECEIVED
                                                                                                  Page 2 of 2
Parameter
Holding
Time
Holding Time
Plus
Date Sampled
Sample ID:
01
oz
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
ZO
21
ZZ
23
24
25
Z6
Z7
29
Z9
30
31
3Z
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
DOC
14

NH4
28

Eq. pH
14 _,

BNC
14

AMC
14

Specific
Conductance
14

Eq. DIC
14

Inlt. DIC
14

Total P
28

Total Al
28

Date* Analyzed**
















































































































































































































































































































































































































 •Report these dates as Julian dates (I.e.. March 26.  1984 • 4086).
**If parameter was reanalyzed because of QA problems,  report the last date  analyzed.


                                  NSWS  Form  19  (Continued)
                                                                                                   -O O 30 J>
                                                                                                   O> O» ft> T3
                                                                                                  U3 <-»• < -O
                                                                                                   O> 
                                                                                                      • • in 3
                                                                                                   I-.    -.. O.
                                                                                                   O    O ->•
                                                                                                      K- 3 X
                                                                                                   O I—
                                                                                                   -h ~-- ro CD
                                                                                                      CD
                                                                                                   !-• CT>

-------
                                           NATIONAL SURFACE  WATER SURVEY
                                                      FORM 20
                                                                   Page 1  of 2
LAB NAME
BATCH ID
BLANKS AND QCCS

             LAB MANAGER'S  SIGNATURE
Parameter
Calibration
Blank
Reagent Blank
DL (Theoretical
QCCS (Measured
Low QCCS
True Value
Low QCCS Upper
Control Limit
Low QCCS Lower
Control Limit
Initial
Continuing
Continuing
Continuing
Continuing
Continuing
Final
High QCCS
True Value
High QCCS Upper
Control Unit
High QCCS Lower
Control Limit
Initial
Continuing
Continuing
Continuing
Continuing
Continuing
Final
ALIQUOT ID
1
Ca
mg/L

N






















Mg
mg/L

N






















K
mg/L

N






















Na
mg/L

N






















Mn
mg/L

N






















Fe
mg/L

N






















2
Total
Extr.Al
mg/L

N






















3
Cl
mg/L

N
N
N




















SOa
mg/L

N
N
N




















NO?
mg/L

N
N
N




















S102
mg/L


N
N




















ISE
Total F
mg/L

N
N
N




















Note:  Approved Data Qualifiers  and instruction for their use are listed  in Table 3.10.


                                                     NSWS Form  20
                                                                                        -O O 73 3>
                                                                                        (U ft) CD "O
                                                                                        to rt- < -o
                                                                                        fo n -•• n>
                                                                                           • • «/) 3
                                                                                        !_•    -i. Q.
                                                                                        (-*    O -••
                                                                                           !-• 3 X
                                                                                        O H-"
                                                                                        -h-».ro DO
                                                                                           CO
                                                                                        >- 0»
                                                                                        cr>

-------
                            NATIONAL SURFACE WATER SURVEY
                                       FORM 20
                                                  Page 2 of 2
LAB NAME
BATCH ID
BLANKS AND QCCS


             LAB MANAGER'S SIGNATURE
Parameter
Calibration
Blank
Reagent Blank
DL theoretical
QCCS measured
Low QCCS
True Value
Low QCCS Upper
Control Limit
Low QCCS Lower
Control Limit
Initial
Continuing
Continuing
Continuing
Continuing
Continuing
Final
High QCCS
True Value
High QCCS Upper
Control Limit
High QCCS Lower
Control Limit
Initial
Continuing
Continuing
Continuing
Continuing
Continuing
Final

4
DOC
mg/L

N
N
N




















NH4
mg/L

N
N
N




















ALIQUOT ID

Measured
Eq
pH
N
N
N
N




















ANC
PH
N
N
N
N




















BNC
PH
N
N
N
N




















5
Cond.
uS/cm

N
N
N




















Eq.
DIC
mg/L

N
N
N




















Init.
DIC
mg/L

N
N
N





















6
Total
P
mg/L

N




•


















7
Total
Al
mg/L
























Note:  Approved Data Qualifiers and Instruction for their use are listed in Table 3.10.


                              NSWS Form 20  (Continued)
                                                                                    -O O 70 3>
                                                                                    O> D» (0 T3
                                                                                    to c+ < -o
                                                                                    fl>  —•• fD
                                                                                       • • l/> =3
                                                                                    !_.   -•• O.
                                                                                    ro   o -••
                                                                                       (-- 3 X
                                                                                    O t-1
                                                                                    -h --^ro oo
                                                                                       CO

-------
LAB HAKE
                                  BATCH ID
NATIONAL SURFACE WATER SURVEY
           FORM 21*

       DILUTION FACTORS

              LAB MANAGER'S SIGNATURE
                                                                                                           Page 1  of  2
SAM-
PLE
ID:
01
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
in
11
1Z
13
14
1ft
16
17
18
19
20
ZI
22
23
Z4
25
26
Z7
28
29
30'
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
ALIQUOT ID
1
Ca
ng/L








































"9
ng/L








































K
»g/L








































Na
ng/L








































Mn
ng/L








































Fe
ng/L








































z
Total
Extr. A1
ng/L








































3
Cl
mg/L








































S04
ng/L








































K0?
ng/L








































S102
•g/C








































ISE
Total f
mg/L








































 *Fomrnot required In the data package but recoaaended for QA purposes.
 NOTE:   Indicate samples ran on higher concentration range by using a check mark  for each parameter.



                                                 NSWS  Form  21
                                                                                                                                              -O O 70 >
                                                                                                                                              P> O» n> T3
                                                                                                                                              U3 c+ < T3
                                                                                                                                              (D (T) — '• CT>
                                                                                                  OJ    O  -"•
                                                                                                      t— 3  X
                                                                                                  O  •-'
                                                                                                  -h ~^ ro CD
                                                                                                      en
                                                                                                  I-* CTl

-------
                                            NATIONAL SURFACE HATER  SURVEY
                                                      FORM 21*
                                           Page 2 of 2
LAB NAME
                                 BATCH 10
 DILUTIONS FACTORS

	   LAB MANAGER'S SIGNATURE
SAM-
PLE
ID:
01
OZ
03
04
OS
06
01
08
09
ID
11
12
13
14
IS
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
ALIQUOT ID
4
DOC
mg/L








































NH4
mg/L








































5
Measufe'3
Eq.
PH








































ANC
In1t. pH








































BNC
Inlt. pH








































CO;
BNC
peq/L








































ANC
peq/L








































COND.
pS/crn








































Eq.
DIC
mg/L








































imt.
DIC
mg/L








































6
Total
P
mg/L








































7
Total
Al
mg/L








































 •Form not required In the data package but recommended for QA purposes.
 NflTE:   Indicate samples  ran on higher concentration range by using a check mark for each parameter.
                                   NSWS  Form  21  (Continued)
                                                                                    -o o 73 :>
                                                                                    Q> O> ft) T3
                                                                                     (D —'• fD
                                                                                       •• t/> 3
                                                                                    !_.    _J. Q-
                                                                                    *»    O -••
                                                                                       »-• =J X
                                                                                    O I-1
                                                                                    -h—- r\> DO
                                                                                       CX5
                                                                                    h^ CTi

-------
                                            NATIONAL SUFACE WATER SURVEY
                                                      Form 22
                                                                Page 1 of I
                                                     DUPLICATES
LAB NAME
BATCH ID
LAB MANAGER'S SIGNATURE
Parameter
Duplicate
Sample ID
Sample Result
Duplicate
Result
% RSD
Second Duplicate
Sample ID
Sample Result
Duplicate
Result
% RSD
Third Duplicate
Sanple ID
Sample Result
Duplicate
Result
% RSD
ALIQUOT ID
1
Ca
mg/L












Mg
mg/L












K
mg/L












Na
mg/L












Mn
mg/L












Fe
mg/L












2
Total
Extr.Al
mg/L












3
Cl
mg/L












SO,
mg/L












NO?
mg/L












S10?
mg/L












ISE
Total F
mg/L












Note:  Approved Data Qualifiers and  Instructions for their use are listed 1n Table 3.10.
                                                 NSWS Form  22
                                                                                    -O O 33 3»
                                                                                    O> 0> fl> "O
                                                                                    tn ft < T3
                                                                                    n> rt> — '• 
                                                                                       • • l/> 3
                                                                                    !_   -4. CX
                                                                                    VI   O -••
                                                                                       !-• 3 X
                                                                                                                            CO
                                                                                                                               ro oo
                                                                                                                          cn

-------
LAB NAME
NATIONAL SURFACE  WATER  SURVEY
           Form 22

         DUPLICATES^


          BATCH ID
                                                                                 Page 2 of 2
LAB MANAGER'S SIGNATURE
Parameter
Duplicate
Sample ID
Sample Result
Duplicate
Result
% RSD*
Second
Duplicate
Sample ID
Sample Result
Duplicate
Result
% RSD*
Third Duplicate
Sample ID
Sample Result
Duplicate
Result
% RSD*
ALIQUOT ID
4
DOC
mg/L












NH4
mg/L













Measured
Eq.
PH












ANC
Initial
PH












BNC
Initial
PH












5
C02
BNC
ueq/L












ANC
ueq/L












Cond.
uS/cm












Eq.
DIC
mg/L












Init.
DIC
mg/L












6
Total
P
mg/L












7
Total
A1
mg/L












                                                                                                                "O O 30 3>
                                                                                                                O» O> CO T3
                                                                                                               to r+ < -o
*Report absolute difference  rather than RSD for pH determinations.
Note:  Approved Data Qualifiers and Instructions for their use are listed in 3.10.


                                 NSWS Form 22  (Continued)
                                                  cn

                                                  O I-1
                                                                                       oo
                                                                                          in 3
                                                                                          _1. Q.
                                                                                          o -••
                                                                                            X

                                                                                          ro CD

-------
                                                                Appendix C
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 1 of 24
                                   APPENDIX C

                     EXAMPLES OF CALCULATIONS REQUIRED FOR
                           ANC AND BNC DETERMINATIONS
C-1.0  HC1 STANDARDIZATION (SECTION 4.8.1)

       1.00 mL of a 0.01038N Na2C03 plus 40.00 mL C02~free deionized water
       is titrated with HC1  titrant.  The titration data are given below.

       mL HC1
       added	p_H

        0.00      10.23
        0.100       9.83
        0.200       9.70
        0.300       9.54

        0.400       9.28
        0.500       8.65
        0.600       7.20
        0.700       6.71
           is calculated for the data sets (V, pH) with pH 4-7 by using the
       equation

                               V,C    /    [HT]K!  + 2 K, K2    \    KW
mL HC1
added
0.800
0.900
1.000
1.100
1.200
1.300
1.400
1.500

PH
6.37
6.03
5.59
4.91
4.48
4.26
4.11
4.00
mL HC1
added
1.700
1.900
2.100
2.300
2.500




PH
3.84
3.72
3.63
3.56
3.49



          lb       s        (vs + v)   \[H+]2 + [H*]^ + K! K2
       where
            Vs  =  initial  sample volume = 41.0 mL
             V  =  volume of HC1  added.
             C  =  1.266 x 10"4  =  (N Na2C03)/(2 x 41)

            ..,  =  4.4463 x lO'J,
            Ko  =  4.6881 x 10'11
            C,  =  1.01 x 10'14

-------
                                                            Appendix C
                                                            Revision 2
                                                            Date:   11/86
                                                            Page 2 of 24
   The (V, Fj^) values are tabulated below.

                V       Flb (x 10"3)           V         Flb (x 10"3)

              0.700        3.57              1.100          -0.34
              0.800        2.59              1.200          -1.33
              0.900        1.60              1.300          -2.28
              1.000        0.64              1.400          -3.26
                                             1.500          -4.23

The plot of Flb versus V is shown in Figure  C-l.  The data lie on a
straight line and are analyzed by linear regression to obtain the coeffi
cients of the line:

                              Flb  =  a + bV

from the regression,

r  =  1.0000
a  =  0.01038 ± 0.00001
b  =  -0.009747 ± 0.000012

Then V]^  =  -a/b  =  1.065 ml

and
             N Na2C03 V0     (0.01038)  (1.00)
    Nun   =  -  =  - -    =  0.009743  eq/L
     HU          V                1.065
    vo

-------
                                                       Appendix C
                                                       Revision 2
                                                       Date:   11/86
                                                       Page 3 of 24
-5J
  Figure C-l.  Plot of F^ versus V for HC1  standardization.

-------
                                                               Appendix C
                                                               Revision 2
                                                               Date:  11/86
                                                               Page 4 of 24


C-2.0  NaOH STANDARDIZATION (SECTION  4.8.2)

C-2.1  Initial  NaOH Standardization with  KHP  (Section 4.8.2.1)

       5.00 ml  of 9.793 x 10~4 N  KHP  plus 20.0 ml  COp-free deionized water
       are titrated with approximately  0.01N  NaOH.  The titration data and
       appropriate Gran function  values are given  in the table below.

          Volume NaOH
              (ml)                      pH                F3b(x 10'3)

             0.000                    4.59
             0.050                    4.78
             0.100                    4.97                 3.90
             0.150                    5.14                 3.39
             0.200                    5.31                 2.86
             0.250                    5.48                 2.34
             0.300                    5.66                 1.82
             0.350                    5.87                 1.29
             0.400                    6.14                 0.79
             0.450                    6.66                 0.26
             0.500                    8.99                -0.25
             0.700                    9.95                -2.29
             0.900                  10.23                -4.40
             1.100                  10.39
             1.300                  10.51

       The Gran function F3b  is calculated for data with pH 5-10.  F3b is
       culated  by
       F3b  =  (V +  Vs)
                             vs  c           ([H]K  + 2[H])                 KW
                           (Vs  +  V)
        V  =  Volume  NaOH  added
       Vs  =  Initial  sample  volume  =  25.00 mL
        C  =  N KHP/5   =   1.9586  x  10'4
     [H+]  =  10-PH
       K,  =  1.3 x 10~3
       Ko  =  3.9 x 10'6
       Kw  =  1.01 x  10"14

           versus V is plotted in Figure  C-2.  The data lie on a straight line
          i the equation F3 = a + bV.  The coefficients are calculated by using
       linear regression.  From the  regression,

       r  =  1.0000
       a  =  0.004931  ± 0.000008
       b  =  -0.01036  ± 0.00002

-------
                                                              Appendix  C
                                                              Revision  2
                                                              Date:   11/86
                                                              Page  5  of 24
Figure C-2.  Plot of F^b versus V for initial  NaOH standardization with KHP,

-------
                                                               Appendix C
                                                               Revision 2
                                                               Date:  11/86
                                                               Page 6 of 24
       From this Y3 and N^gH are  calculated  by

                           V3 =  -a/b  =  0.4761 ml

                                     NKHP  x VKHP
                           NNaOH  =   	  =  0.01028 eq/L
                                          V3

C-2.2  Standardization Check (Section 4.8.2.2)

       0.500 ml of 0.00921N NaOH plus 25.0 ml C02-free deionized water is
       titrated with 0.0101N HC1 (standardized with  Na^O^).  The titration
       data and appropriate Gran function  values are given in the table below.

          Volume HC1
              (ml)                     pH                 F, (x 10~3)
              0.000                   10.29
              0.100                   10.15
              0.200                   10.03                 2.75
              0.250                   9.91                 2.09
              0.300                   9.78                 1.55
              0.350                   9.60                 1.03
              0.400                   9.34                 0.57
              0.450                   8.39                 0.064
              0.500                   4.76                -0.45
              0.550                   4.44                -0.94
              0.600                   4.26                -1.43
              0.650                   4.12                -1.98
              0.700                   4.04                -2.39
              0.800                   3.88

       The Gran function  Fj  is  determined  for data in the pH range 4-10.  Fj is
       calculated  by:

                           F,   =   (V + Vc)   [— - [H+]
   c  =
[H*J  =
                =  volume  of  HC1  added
                =  initial  sample volume = 25.5 ml
                   10-PH
            Kw  =   1.0  x  10~14

       Fi  versus V is plotted in  Figure C-3.  The data are on a straight line
       with the equation  Fj  = a + bV.  The coefficients, determined by linear
       regression, are

       r  =   0.9994
       a  =   0.00465 ± 0.00005
       b  =  -0.01016 ± 0.0001

-------
                                                           Appendix C
                                                           Revision 2
                                                           Date:   11/86
                                                           Page 7  of 24
             2-
             1-
       co
        b
             -1
            •2
            -3 J
                         0.2       0.4  \     0.6        0.8

                                                 V
Figure C-3.  Plot of Fi versus V for standardization  check-titration
                         of NaOH with HC1.

-------
                                                                Appendix C
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page 8 of 24
     From these values, Vj^ and NHC-| are calculated by

                        YX = -a/b = 0.4577
                                 NNaOH x vNaOH
                        NHC1  =  -  = 0.01006
     Comparing this value for N^ci  with the previously determined value of
         » "the % difference is
     % difference in N    values  =
                                     0.01006 - 0.0101
x 100  = 0.4%
                                          0.0101

     This % difference is acceptable since it is less than 5%.

C-2.3  Routine NaOH Standardization with Standardized HC1  (Section 4.8.2.3)

       1.000 ml of an approximately 0.01N NaOH solution plus 25.00 ml of CO?-
       free deionized water is titrated with 0.009830N HC1.   The titration data
       are given below.

                                                              ml HC1
                                                              added	pH
                                                               1.200      3.78
                                                               1.400      3.62
ml HC1
added
0.00
0.200
0.400
0.600
0.650
0.700
pH
10.44
10.30
10.13
9.71
9.51
9.19
ml HC1
added
0.750
0.800
0.850
0.900
1.000
1.100
pH
5.35
4.65
4.37
4.22
4.02
3.88
       Fj is calculated for each data pair (V, pH)  with a pH 4-10 by using the
       equation
                        Fl
       where
             Vs  =  initial  sample volume = 26.00 ml
              V  =  volume of HC1  added.
           [H+]  =  10-PH
             Kw  =  1.0 x 10"14

       The new data pairs (V, Fj)  are tabulated below.

-------
                                                           Appendix C
                                                           Revision 2
                                                           Date:   11/86
                                                           Page 9 of 24


                     (x 10~3)             V              Fi  (x 10"3)
  0.400              3.56               0.850               -1.14
  0.600              1.36               0.900               -1.62
  0.650              0.86               1.000               -2.58
  0.700              0.41               1.100               -3.57
  0.750             -0.12
  0.800             -0.60
A plot of Fi versus V is shown in Figure C-4.  The data sets corresponding
to volumes from V = 0.40 to V = 1.10 lie on a straight line with the
equation

                                F! = a + bV

The coefficients are obtained by linear regression.  The results are

r  =  0.9996
a  =  0.007488 ± 0.00008
b  = -0.0101 ± 0.0001

From these results,

Y!  =  -a/b = 0.741

                         NHC1 x vl     (0.009830)  (0.741)
                           VNaOH             1-000
                                                           =  0-00728

-------
         4 -,
         3 -
         2 -
         1 -
    CO
     I
     O
        -1 -
       -2 -
        -3 -
       .4 J
               0.4
0.6
                                                         Appendix  C
                                                         Revision  2
                                                         Date:   11/86
                                                         Page 10 of  24
Figure C-4.  Plot of ?i versus V for routine  NaOH  standardization.

-------
                                                                Appendix  C
                                                                Revision  2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 11 of 24
C-3.0  ELECTRODE CALIBRATION (SECTION 4.8.3)
       This section describes the electrode calibration procedure.   The tables
       below (A and B)  tabulate both the titration data (V and pH),  the calcu-
       lated pH values  (pH*), and the coefficients for the line pH = a  + b  pH*,

                                TABLE A.  ACID TITRATION
Vs = 50.50
Volume HC1
(mL)
0.000
0.025
0.050
0.100
0.150
0.200
0.250
0.300
0.350
0.400
mL 1

PH
5.87
5.25
4.97
4.68
4.51
4.38
4.29
4.22
4.15
4.10
YHC1 = 0.00983

pH*
___
5.31
5.01
4.71
4.54
4.41
4.31
4.24
4.17
4.11

Volume HC1
(mL)
0.450
0.500
0.600
0.800
1.000
1.200
1.500
1.700
2.000



PH
4.05
4.00
3.92
3.80
3.71
3.64
3.55
3.50
3.43



pH*
4.06
4.02
3.94
3.81
3.72
3.64
3.55
3.50
3.43

       r = 1.00      a = 0.10 ± 0.01       b  =  0.971  ± 0.002
                                 TABLE B.   BASE TITRATION
Vs = 40.4
Volume HC1
(mL)
0.000
0.050
0.200
0.300
0.400
0.500
0.600
mL NNa0n = 0.00804

PH
6.66
9.03
9.55
9.66
9.75
9.90
10.00

pH*
— — —
9.00
9.60
9.77
9.90
9.99
10.07
Volume HC1
(mL)
0.820
0.940
1.080
1.200
1.300
1.400
1.500

PH
10.18
10.25
10.31
10.36
10.40
10.43
10.47

pH*
10.20
10.26
10.32
10.37
10.40
10.43
10.46
       r = 0.99    a = 0.08 ± 0.27      b  =  0.99  ± 0.03

-------
                                                         Appendix  C
                                                         Revision  2
                                                         Date:   11/86
                                                         Page  12 of  24
The data in Tables A and B are plotted in Figure C-5.   Except for two
points in the base titration (at V = 0.3 and 0.4),  the data lie on a
straight line.  (The lines calculated for each titration are essentially
coincident as indicated by their coefficients.)   Excluding these two
points, the data are fit to the line with the equation pH = a + b pH*.
The coefficients of the line (obtained by linear regression) are

r = 1.0000
a = -0.014 ± 0.0011
b = 0.999  ± 0.002

-------
                                                          Appendix  C
                                                          Revision  2
                                                          Date:   11/86
                                                          Page 13 of  24
x
CL
                                  pH'
    Figure  C-5.  Plot of pH versus pH* for electrode calibration.

-------
                                                                Appendix C
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page  14 of 24
C-4.0  BLANK ANALYSIS - ANC DETERMINATION  (SECTION  4.9.2)

       This section describes the determination  of  ANC  in  a  blank  solution.
       The blank is prepared by adding  0.40 mL of 0.10M Nad to 40.00 mL
       deionized water.  It is titrated with 0.00983N HC1.   The titration data
       are given below (both measured and  calculated pH* values are included).
Volume HC1
(mL)
0.000
0.080
0.120
0.200
0.300
0.400
PH
5.84
4.69
4.52
4.31
4.14
4.01
pH* Fj
5.85
4.70
4.53
4.32 0.00194
4.14 0.00295
4.02 0.00390
Volume HC1
(mL)
0.500
0.600
1.700
1.000
1.200
1.500
PH
3.91
3.84
3.77
3.62
3.55
3.45
pH*
3.91
3.84
3.77
3.62
3.55
3.45
Fl
0.00503
0.00593
0.00698
0.00993
0.0117
0.0149
       The Gran function   i
       less than 4.5,  and th
                         = (Vs + V)  [HT])  is calculated for  pH*  value
                     e values are included in the table.
Fi versus V is plotted in Figure C-6.   The data are  linear  and  fit  the
line FI = a + bV by using linear regression.   The resulting coefficients
are:

r = 0.9998
a = (-0.70 ± 5.6) x 10~5
b = 0.00989 ± 0.00007

From this,
             Vj = -a/b = 7.05 x 10"4 mL

             r   ,     ViCHCl
             [ANC]  =


             V0  =  blank volume = 40.4 mL

This value for [ANC] is acceptable.
                                     =   1.7  x  ID'7  —  =  0.17 ueq/L

-------
                                                         Appendix C
                                                         Revision 2
                                                         Date:  11/86
                                                         Page 15 of 24
                  0.4     0.6     0.8     1.0     1.2     1.4
Figure C-6.  Plot of Fj  versus  V for ANC determination of blank.

-------
                                                                Appendix C
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page 16 of 24
C-5.0  SAMPLE ANALYSIS

C-5.1  Titration Data

       A sample was titrated as described in section 4.10.  The titration data
       are given below.  Also included are values for the calculated pH (pH*).
Acid Titration

Vsa = 40.00 mL
    = 0.00983 eq/L

   i         PH
Base Titration

Vsb = 40.00 mL
Cb = 0.00702 eq/L

  Vb         PH
                         Vsalt - °-40 mL


                        pH*             \
                                vsalt = °-40 mL


                               PH*             Vb
                                                           PH
PH
           pH*
0.000
0.040
0.080
0.120
0.140
0.160
0.260
0.280
0.380
5.10
4.89
4.71
4.56
4.50
4.44
4.24
4.21
4.08
5.11
4.90
4.72
4.57
4.51
4.44
4.24
4.21
4.08
0.460
0.550
0.650
0.750
0.900
1.100
1.400
1.700

3.99
3.91
3.84
3.77
3.69
3.61
3.50
3.42

3.99
3.91
3.84
3.77
3.69
3.61
3.50
3.42

                                                               pH*
0.00
0.015
0.030
0.050
0.080
0.120
0.160
0.200
0.240
0.280
0.320
0.340
0.360
5.08
5.13
5.26
5.35
5.57
5.78
6.06
6.30
6.65
6.98
7.29
7.46
7.62
5.09
5.14
5.27
5.36
5.58
5.79
6.07
6.31
6.66
7.00
7.31
7.48
7.64
0.425
0.470
0.500
0.540
0.560
0.600
0.660
0.700
0.780
0.900
1.000
1.100
1.405
8.30
8.66
8.85
9.01
9.10
9.21
9.35
9.44
9.57
9.72
9.83
9.92
10.12
8.32
8.68
8.87
9.03
9.12
9.23
9.37
9.47
9.60
9.75
9.86
9.95
10.15

-------
                                                                Appendix C
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 17 of 24
                    PH
pH*
PH
pH*
0
0

.380
.400

Initial
7
8

.83
.03

Estimate of V
7
8

j (
.85
.05

Section
1
2
2
4.11.1)
.700
.200
.500

10
10
10

.26
.43
.51

10
10
10

.29
.43
.54

       The Gran function Fja is calculated for each data pair from the acid
       titration with a pH* <4.  The values are given in the table below.
Va
0.460
0.550
0.650
0.750
Fla(xlO-3)*
4.18
5.04
5.93
6.99
va
0.900
1.100
1.400
1.700
Fla(xl(T3)*
8.43
10.2
13.2
16.0
*F1a = (V. + V.) [H+]
la as
           versus Va is plotted in Figure C-7.  A regression of F^a on Va is
       performed to fit the data to the line Fja = a + bV.   The resulting
       coefficients are:

            r = 0.9999
            a = -0.00014 ± 0.000031
            b = 0.00948 ± 0.000038

       From this, the initial  estimate of Vj is calculated  by

                                Vj = -a/b = 0.0148 ml

       Since Vj >0 and the initial sample pH* <7.6, calculation procedure B
       (Section 4.11.3) is used to determine tTTe ANC and BNC of the sample.

C-5.3  Initial  Estimates of V9> ANC, BNC, and C (Section 4.11.3.1)

       From the base titration data, V£ is estimated to be  0.40 ml  (the first
       point with a pH* <8.2).  Now that initial estimates  of Vi  and ^2 nave
       been obtained, esTimates of ANC, BNC, and C can be calculated.
                                      Vl C
                                                       c
                                            = 3.6 x 10~6 eq/L

-------
                                                                Appendix C
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:  11/86
                                                                Page 18 of 24
    16-
    14-
    12-
«?  10-
 o
 T-
 _»<
 CD
    6-
    4-
   - 2-
            0.2    0.4    0.6     0.8     1.0     1.2

                                     Va
1.4     1.6     1.8
               Figure C-7.  Plot of Fja  versus Va for initial
                            determination  of Vj.

-------
                                                                Appendix  C
                                                                Revision  2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 19 of 24
                                          = 7.02 x 10-5 eq/L
                                      s

                                C = ANC + BNC = 7.38 x 1Q-5  eq/L
C-5.4  Refined Estimates of Vi  and V?

       The Gran function Flc (Equation 1 in 4.11.1.3)  is calculated for acid
       titration data with volumes across the current  estimate of Vj.   The
       values are given below.
F(xl(T4)
 lc
                                                       F(xlO-4)
                                                        lc
0.000
0.040
0.080
0.120
0.140
-1.68
-4.10
-7.05
-10.4
-12.1
0.160
0.260
0.280
0.380

-14.4
-23.2
-24.9
-33.8

Flc versus Va is plotted in Figure C-8.
performed.  The regression results are

     r = 0.999
     a = -0.00006 ± 0.00003
     b = -0.00864 ± 0.00016
                       A regression  of
                                                                    on  Va  is
       A new estimate of Vj  is
                                Vj  =  -a/b  =  -0.007  ml
       Next the Gran function  F?c  (Equation  2,  section  4.11.1.3)  is  calculated
       from data sets from the base titration with volumes  across the  current
       estimate of ^2-   The values  are  given below.
     For(x  10~4)
                                                    F?r(x 10'4)
                                                            2c
0.340
0.360
0.380
0.400
0.425
1.99
1.28
.555
-0.031
-.868
0.470
0.500
0.540
0.560
0.600
-2.60
-4.14
-6.03
-7.43
-9.55

-------
                              Va
                                                   Appendix C
                                                   Revision 2
                                                   Date:  11/86
                                                   Page 20 of 24
•0.04  0  0.04
0.12     0.20     0.28     0.36     0.44
  i     i    i     I    i    i     i    i    I
    -5-

   -10-


   -15-

   -20'

   -25-

   -30-

   -35-
 Figure C-8.  Plot of  FIC versus Va for YI  determination.

-------
                                                                Appendix C
                                                                Revision 2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 21 of 24

           versus V|) is plotted in Figure C-9.  A regression of ?2c on vb 1S
       performed.  (Data with Vb >0.5 are not used in the regression.)  The
       regression results are

                              r = 0.999
                              a = 0.00138 ± 0.00003
                              b = -0.00348 ± 0.00007

       A new estimate of V2 1S

                              V2 = -a/b = 0.397 mL

C-5.5  New Estimates of ANC, BNC, and C

       From the new estimates of Vj and V£, new estimates of ANC, BNC, and C
       are calculated.
                                     Vi Ca
                              ANC* = 	 = -1.7 x lO'6 eq/L
                                      Vsa

                                     V2 Cb
                              BNC* = 	 = 6.97 x ID'5 eq/L
                                      Vsb

                              C* = ANC + BNC = 6.80 x 10"5 eq/L

C-5.6  Comparison of Latest Two Estimates of Total Carbonate

                               C - C*

                               C + C*

       Since C and C* do not agree, a new C is calculated from their average:

                              C(new) = (C + C*)/2 = 7.09 x 10'5 eq/L

       The calculations in 5.4 and 5.6 are repeated until successive iterations
       yield total carbonate values which meet the above criteria.   The results
       from each iteration (including those already given) are given below.
= 0.041 >0.001
ANC BNC C
Iteration V^mL) V?(mL) (ueq/L) (ueq/L) (ueq/L)
1
2
3
4
5
0.0148
-0.007
-0.0070
-0.0076
-0.0077
0.400
0.397
0.397
0.397
0.396
3.6
-1.7
rl.7
-1.9
-1.9
70.2
69.7
69.7
69.7
69.5
73.8
68.0
68.0
67.8
67.6
C - C*
C + C*
—
0.042
0.021
0.012
0.007
New C
(ueq/D





_
70.9
69.4
68.6
-
       The final  values for ANC and BNC are reported on Form 11.

-------
                                                    Appendix C
                                                    Revision 2
                                                    Date:  11/86
                                                    Page 22 of 24


«•
1
o
^
o
eg
u.





3-i
2-
1-
0-
-1-
-2-
-3-
-4-
-5-
-6-
-7-
-8-
-9-
1 n.

*V Vb
0.30 \0.40 0.50 0.60 0.70
_xrx i ^ i i i
X
•

•
•

•
Figure C-9.  Plot of F2c versus Vjj for V2 determination.

-------
                                                                Appendix  C
                                                                Revision  2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 23 of  24


C-6.0  QUALITY CONTROL CALCULATIONS

       Examples of the QC calculations are described in this  section.

C-6.1  Comparison of Calculated ANC and Measured  ANC (Section 4.9.6)

       For the sample analyzed in section C-5,  the following  data  were
       obtained.

                    initial  pH = 5.09            air-equilibrated  pH =  5.06
                    DIC = 0.59 mg/L              air-equilibrated  DIC = 0.36

       From these data, the  calculated ANC values are computed by  using the
       equation:
             [ANC]C  =
                          DIC       [H]K! + 2Kj K2    \    KW
- [H+] x 106
                        .12011

       The results are:

                  [ANC] C1 = -5.7 ueq/L           [ANC]C2 = -7.3  ueq/L

       Then:

                       |[ANC]C1 - [ANC]C2|  = 1.6 Meq/L <15 ueq/L

       Since [ANC]ci and [ANC]c2 are *n agreement,  their average  value  is  used
       for comparison to the measured value.

               [ANC]c.avg  = -6.5 ueq/L                ANC = -1.9  ueq/L

                      D =  |ANCC - ANC| = 4.6 peq/L  <15 peq/L

       The calculated and  measured ANC values agree,  and this backs up  the
       assumption of a carbonate system.

C-6.2  Comparison of Calculated and Measured BNC (Section 4.9.7)

       For the sample analyzed in section C-5, the  following data were
       obtained.

                       initial pH = 5.09

                              DIC = 0.59 mg/L

                              BNC = 69.0 ueq/L

-------
                                                                Appendix  C
                                                                Revision  2
                                                                Date:   11/86
                                                                Page 24 of  24


            From these data,  the BNC is computed by using the  equation:

                        '  DIC /    [H+]2 - K,  K2     \           Kw
             [BNCL  =   	  	    L   *     *•  ril+n      W
                        [12011 \CH+]  + CF

       The result is:

             [BNC]C  =  54.8  ueq/L

       This value is compared to the measured value.

             D  =  [BNC]C  - BNC  = -14.2 ueq/L < -10 ueq/L

       Although borderline, this value of D is  indicative of other protolytes
       in the system which are contributing to  the  measured  BNC.   This  might be
       expected since the  sample also contains  3.2  mg/L  DOC.

C-6.3  Comparison of Calculated  Total  Carbonate and Measured Total  Carbonate
       (Section 4.9.8)

       For the sample analyzed in section C-5,  the  following data  were
       obtained.

                    initial pH = 5.09    BNC =  69.0 ueq/L =  69.0 umole/L
                    DIC =  0.59 mg/L      ANC =  -1.9 ueq/L =  -1.9 umole/L

       From the DIC value, the total  carbonate  is calculated.

             Cc = 83.26 x  DIC =  49.1 umole/L

       This calculated value  is  then compared to the measured  value.

             D = Cc - (ANC +  BNC) = -18.0 umole/L < -10  umole/L

       Although borderline, this value of D is  indicative of other protolytes
       in the system.  This might be expected since the  sample also contains
       3.2 mg/L DOC.  Notice  that the same  conclusion was reached  in the  BNC
       comparison.

       In general, noncarbonate  protolytes  are  significant (i.e.,  contribute
       significantly to the total protolyte concentration) when  they are
       indicated by one (or both) of the individual comparisons  (ANC and  BNC
       comparisons) and the total carbonate comparison.

-------